Division 19.10 — RESIDENTIAL ZONING DISTRICTS

Article 3 — SITE PLANNING AND GENERAL DEVELOPMENT STANDARDS

Novato Zoning Code · 2026-06 edition · ingested 2026-07-06 · Novato

DIVISION 19.20 - GENERAL PROPERTY DEVELOPMENT AND USE STANDARDS

19.20.010 - Purpose of Division.

This Division expands upon the standards of Article 2 (Zoning Districts, Allowable Land Uses, and ZoneSpecific Standards) by addressing the details of site planning and project design. These standards are intended to ensure that all development:

A.

Produces an environment of stable and desirable character;

B.

Is compatible with existing and future development; and

C.

Protects the use and enjoyment of neighboring properties, consistent with the General Plan.

(Ord. No. 1576, § 2 (Exh. A, amd.), 10-23-2012)

19.20.020 - Applicability.

The provisions of this Division apply to all proposed development and new land uses, as follows:

A.

The standards of this Article (Article 3) shall be applied in combination with the standards for each zoning district in Article 2 (Zoning Districts, Allowable Land Uses, and Zone-Specific Standards). If there is a conflict between the standards of Article 2 and Article 3, the standards of Article 3 shall override, except where otherwise specified in Article 2.

B.

All new or modified structures and uses shall comply with all applicable provisions of this Division, except as specified in Division 19.52 (Nonconforming Uses, Structures, and Parcels).

C.

In cases where a proposed development site is subject to an approved Master Plan and/or Precise Development Plan, the standards of the approved plan shall override the standards of this Article.

(Ord. No. 1576, § 2 (Exh. A, amd.), 10-23-2012)

19.20.030 - Access.

Access shall be provided in compliance with this Section, and as required by the development standards in Municipal Code Chapter 5.

A.

Access to Streets. Every structure shall be constructed upon, or moved to, a legally recorded parcel with a permanent means of legal access to a public street.

B.

General Access Requirement. All structures shall be properly located to ensure safe and convenient access for servicing, fire protection, and required parking.

C.

Parking Access. Parking spaces and lots shall be provided access in compliance with Division 19.30 (Parking and Loading).

(Ord. No. 1576, § 2 (Exh. A, amd.), 10-23-2012)

19.20.040 - Fences, Walls, and Hedges.

A.

Applicability.

1.

All Fences, Walls, and Hedges. The provisions of this Division apply to all fences, walls, and hedges, unless otherwise stated.

2.

Fences and Walls in the Flood Hazard (F3) Overlay District. All fences and walls in the F3 overlay district shall require a Building Permit, and shall comply with all requirements of the F3 overlay district in addition to the requirements of this Section.

3.

Exemptions. These regulations do not apply to fences or walls required by regulations of a State or Federal agency, or by the City for reasons of public safety, or to retaining walls which are regulated by Section 19.20.100 (Setback Requirements and Exceptions).

B.

Height Limitations. Fences, walls, and hedges shall comply with the height limitations shown in Table 3-1. See also Figure 3-2. (See 19.20.040.D.1 below).

TABLE 3-1

MAXIMUM HEIGHT OF FENCES, WALLS, AND HEDGES

Location Maximum Height (1)

Within front yard setback 3 ft. within 15 ft. of the back of sidewalk, or the back
of curb, if there is no sidewalk, or the edge of the
improved roadway if there is no sidewalk or curb; 6
ft. elsewhere within front setback. See also Section
19.20.070.D (Sight Visibility Area Required).
Within side and rear yard setbacks 6 ft. (2) (3)
Within street side setback 6 ft. see also Section 19.20.070.D (Sight Visibility
Area Required) and Section 19.20.040.D. (Specifc
Fencing and Wall requirements.)
At intersections of alleys, streets, and driveways
within sight visibility areas.
3 ft. and also see Section 19.20.070.D (Sight Visibility
Area Required)
Outside of a required setback As determined by the height limit for structures within
the applicable zoning district.
Within a zone where no setback is required 8 ft.

Notes:

(1)

Additional height may be authorized through Design Review approval (Section 19.42.030).

(2)

Fences and walls may be allowed up to 8 feet in height within 3 feet of side or rear property line when the portions of the fence above six feet are of an open design (e.g., lattice, wrought iron or grille work that will allow visibility through 50% of the material).

(3)

Solid fences and walls set back greater than 3 feet from side or rear property line may be allowed up to 8 feet in height.

C.

Measurement of Fence and Wall Height.

1.

Fence height shall be measured as the vertical distance between the finished grade at the base of the fence and the top edge of the fence material.

2.

The height of fencing atop a wall shall be measured from the base of the wall.

In cases where finished grade differs from one side of the fence to the other (as on a slope or retaining wall), the height shall be measured from the side with the lowest natural grade. See Figure 3-1. Where fences are arranged or terraced on a slope with a minimum of 2 feet (measured horizontally) between each fence or each fence and retaining wall, to allow for landscaping, each fence height shall be measured in accordance with C.1 above.

==> picture [168 x 136] intentionally omitted <==

D.

Specific Fencing and Wall Requirements.

1.

Fences Abutting Right-of-Way.

a.

Fences in rear or side yard areas that abut a public right-of-way and exceed 3 feet in height shall provide a minimum setback of 10 feet from the edge of right-of-way, except where a minimum 10-foot landscape parkway is provided within the right-of-way.

b.

Perimeter fences and walls with a height greater than six feet and greater than 50 feet in length, adjoining a public right-of-way, shall require Design Review in accordance with Section 19.42.030.

2.

Fencing Between Different Land Uses. Fencing between different land uses shall be provided in compliance with Section 19.20.090 (Screening).

3.

Swimming Pools, Spas, and Similar Features. Swimming pools/spas and other similar water features shall be fenced in compliance with Section 4-3 of the Municipal Code.

4.

Outdoor Equipment, Storage, and Work Areas. Screening of outdoor uses and equipment shall be provided in compliance with Section 19.20.090 (Screening).

Temporary Fencing. Temporary fencing may be necessary to protect archaeological or historic resources, trees, or other similar sensitive features during site preparation and construction. This fencing shall be approved by the Director.

==> picture [530 x 275] intentionally omitted <==

(Ord. No. 1576, § 2 (Exh. A, amd.), 10-23-2012)

19.20.050 - Grading.

This Section establishes land Use Permit and application requirements for grading (e.g., filling, excavating, leveling, or stockpiling of earth, rock, sand, gravel, or similar materials).

A.

Use Permit Required. Use Permit approval (see Section 19.42.050), in addition to a required grading permit, shall be required before any grading or stockpiling of materials is commenced on any site, except that a Use Permit shall not be required if one or more of the following conditions apply:

1.

Grading involves the movement of less than 200 cubic yards of materials, is not related to previous grading on the property, regardless of previous amounts, does not involve hauling, either to or from the site, and is not in the F-3 Overlay District;

2.

A grading plan has been reviewed and approved by the appropriate City officials as an element of an approved Building Permit;

A grading plan has been reviewed and approved by the appropriate City officials as an element of an approved land Use Permit/entitlement or Tentative Map;

4.

The Director determines that the grading is minor and will clearly cause no adverse environmental impacts;

5.

No wetland is affected; or

6.

The grading operation is necessary to protect the public health, safety, and welfare in the event of emergency or disaster. In permitting a grading operation to proceed under this exception, the City Manager, or his/her designee, may impose and require compliance with those conditions which are reasonable under the circumstances.

B.

Application Requirements. A Use Permit application for grading shall include all information required by Section 19.40.040 (Application Preparation and Filing), and any additional information and materials required by the City Engineer and described in the Department handout approved by the Director. Applicants may also be required to submit information prepared by, or approved by a licensed civil engineer or geologist.

(Ord. No. 1576, § 2 (Exh. A, amd.), 10-23-2012)

19.20.060 - Reserved.

19.20.070 - Height Limits and Exceptions.

A.

Maximum Height of Structures. Except where a Master Plan or Precise Development Plan establishes a specific height limit, the height of structures shall not exceed the more restrictive of the following, as applicable:

1.

The height limit established by the applicable zoning district in Article 2 (Zoning Districts, Allowable Land Uses, and Zone-Specific Standards);

2.

The height restrictions provided for structures on sloping sites by Division 19.26 (Hillside and Ridgeline Protection); and

3.

The height limits established for fences and walls by Section 19.20.040 (Fences, Walls, and Hedges).

B.

Height Measurement. The maximum allowable height shall be measured as the vertical distance from finished grade at the base of the structure to an imaginary plane located the allowed number of feet above and parallel to the finished grade at any point. See Figure 3-3. Finish grade shall be established in a manner consistent with parcels in the vicinity as determined by the Director, and shall not be artificially raised to gain additional building height.

==> picture [290 x 126] intentionally omitted <==

C.

Exceptions to Height Limits. The following structures and structural features may exceed the height limits of this Zoning Ordinance as noted:

1.

Chimneys, cupolas, decorative or false gables, monuments, spires, theater scenery lofts, vents, mechanical equipment screening (not exceeding 10 percent of roof area) and similar structures, may exceed the height limit of the applicable zoning district by a maximum of 8 feet, except where a greater height is authorized in compliance with following Subsection C.2 through Design Review approval.

2.

The height limits of Article 2 may be increased by a maximum of 20 percent through Design Review approval in accordance with Section 19.42.030 (except for the Downtown Core).

3.

Within the Downtown Core Business or Retail Districts, the height limit may be increased by 30 percent up to a maximum height of 45 feet for the habitable floor area (excluding the roof) through Design Review approval, where one of the following criteria is met:

a.

Housing is incorporated in a mixed-use project.

b.

Existing or adjacent building exceeds the height limit.

c.

Unique nature of a proposed use requires a higher height limit.

d.

Proposed building or addition provides exceptional architectural design quality through articulation in the building facade, roof and window design, or other architectural treatment, (i.e., public outdoor spaces and extensive landscaping).

4.

Telecommunications facilities, including antennas, poles, towers, and necessary mechanical appurtenances, may be authorized to exceed the height limit established for the applicable zoning district, in compliance with Division 19.38 (Wireless Communication Facilities).

D.

Sight Visibility Area Required. On properties within or adjacent to residentially zoned districts, property improvements, including structures, landscaping, materials, vehicles or any type of screening shall be designed, placed or maintained to provide a sight visibility area for all types of traffic, including but not limited to vehicles, pedestrians and bicycles. Structures, landscaping, materials, vehicles or any type of screening shall not be located in a manner which adversely affects the required sight visibility area for any public roadway, private roadway, alley, driveway, or pedestrian or vehicular access point. Landscaping in all zoning districts shall also comply with the requirements of Municipal Code Section 17-3.8 (Trees and Shrubs - Obstructing Visibility).

1.

Measurement of Sight Visibility Area. A sight visibility area is measured as follows, and may include private property and/or public right-of-way.

a.

Corner Lots. The sight visibility area shall be defined as a triangle formed by measuring 50 feet from the extension of the front and side property lines and connecting the lines across the property. See Figure 3-4A.

==> picture [314 x 201] intentionally omitted <==

b.

At Alleys, Driveways, and Other Vehicular or Pedestrian Access Points. The sight visibility area shall be defined as the triangle(s) formed by measuring 15 feet extending outward from both sides of the edge of the driveway,

path or easement along the street property line and extending 15 feet from the property line along each side of the alley, driveway or path and connecting the lines across the property. See Figure 3-4B.

c.

Additional Driveway Visibility Requirements. Driveways and adjacent yard areas shall be designed, constructed and maintained to provide a sight visibility area so that the driver of a passenger vehicle backing out of any driveway has an unobstructed view of the first 100 feet along the nearest traffic lane from either direction and has not encroached on any sidewalk, pedestrian path, equestrian path, bike path or street pavement.

==> picture [174 x 186] intentionally omitted <==

2.

Additional Area. A sight visibility area larger than that specified by subsection D1 may be required where determined by the Director to be necessary because of topography, roadway geometrics or traffic characteristics.

3.

Height Limit. No structure, landscaping, materials or other screening or visual obstruction shall exceed a height of 36 inches within the sight visibility areas defined above, except for:

a.

Trees with their lower branches trimmed up to provide a minimum clearance of eight feet above grade; or

b.

Structures, landscaping or other materials approved by the Director based on a determination that the specific geometrics or traffic characteristics of the intersection will accommodate the structure without compromising pedestrian or traffic safety.

(Ord. No. 1576, § 2 (Exh. A, amd.), 10-23-2012)

19.20.080 - Scenic Resources Protection.

A.

Purpose. This Section provides standards to implement the scenic resource protection policies of the General Plan (EN 27 and EN 27.1).

B.

Applicability. These requirements apply to all development proposed on sites designated by the Scenic Resources Map in the General Plan. Design Review (Section 19.42.030) shall be required for all projects within these areas. Scenic resource protection requirements for other areas are provided by Section 19.16.030 (Baylands Overlay District), and Division 19.26 (Hillside and Ridgeline Protection).

C.

Application Content. Development permit applications shall include the following information in addition to that required by Section 19.40.040 (Application Preparation and Filing):

1.

Graphic Visual Impact Analysis. Cross-sectional and elevational drawings analyzing the impacts of the proposed project on scenic views.

2.

Visual Simulations. Visual simulations of the proposed project illustrating how proposed structures will appear within the existing landscape after construction. The simulations shall be accurately prepared using computerized photo montage techniques, and/or story poles placed on the site at the locations of proposed building corners. Simulations shall be prepared showing the proposed project from at least the following vantage points, and any additional vantage points required by the Director:

a.

From all streets fronting the site;

b.

From adjacent neighborhoods, parks, and trails from which the proposed structures may be visible; and

c.

From any location adjacent to Highway 101 from which the proposed structures may be visible.

D.

Development Standards. Proposed development and new land uses shall comply with Section 19.16.030 (Baylands Overlay District), and Division 19.26 (Hillside and Ridgeline Protection) where applicable, and the following requirements:

1.

Protection of Existing Views. Development and new land uses, or changes to existing structures or land uses shall not result in a change in the elevation of the land, or the construction of any improvement that would significantly or materially alter, or impair major views, vistas, viewsheds of major landforms from public roads, or public vantage points as described above.

2.

Side Yard View Corridors. Where side yards provide a public view from the street to the river or bay, or a view to hills or valleys, the side yards should be maintained as open visual access corridors. These areas shall be open to the sky and free from all visual obstructions including trees and shrubs (except for a gate or fence constructed of open materials that still allow the view) from the front property line to the rear property line. Existing structures are exempt from this requirement.

3.

Screening. All industrial facilities, and public and private utilities shall be screened from the view of any public roadway to the maximum extent feasible. See also the screening requirements of Section 19.20.090 (Screening).

4.

Existing Topography. Proposed development, including roads, shall minimize the alteration of the natural topography and scenic values of the area.

5.

Hillside and Ridgeline Backdrops. The size, location, and massing of structures shall not significantly obscure views from Highway 101 and other public roads of the scenic backdrop provided by the hillsides.

6.

Landscaping. Landscaping shall be designed to enhance existing scenic views.

(Ord. No. 1576, § 2 (Exh. A, amd.), 10-23-2012)

19.20.090 - Screening.

This Section establishes standards for the screening and separation of adjoining residential and nonresidential land uses, equipment and outdoor storage areas, and surface parking areas.

A.

Screening Between Different Land Uses. A non-residential land use proposed on a site adjacent to a residential zoning district use shall provide screening at the parcel boundary as follows:

1.

The screen shall consist of plant materials and a solid, decorative wall of masonry or similar durable material, a minimum of six feet in height.

2.

The maximum height of the wall shall comply with the provisions of Section 19.20.040 (Fences, Walls, and Hedges).

The wall shall be architecturally treated on both sides, subject to the approval of the Director.

4.

The Director may waive or approve a substitute for this requirement if the Director first determines that:

a.

The intent of this Section can be successfully met by means of alternative screening methods; or

b.

Physical constraints on the site make the construction of the required screening infeasible; or

c.

The physical characteristics of the site or adjoining parcels make the required screening unnecessary.

B.

Mechanical Equipment, Loading Docks, and Refuse Facilities.

1.

Roof or ground mounted mechanical equipment (e.g., air conditioning, heating, ventilation ducts, and exhaust, etc.), loading docks, refuse storage areas, and utility services (electrical transformers, gas meters, etc.) shall be screened from public view from adjoining public streets and rights-of-way and adjoining area(s) zoned for residential uses.

2.

The method of screening shall be architecturally compatible with other on-site development in terms of colors, materials, and architectural style.

3.

Landscaping shall be installed adjacent to screen walls, at the discretion of the Director.

C.

Outdoor Storage and Work Yards. Land uses with outdoor storage of materials, recycling facility-processing centers, waste resource and waste recycling operations, and similar uses shall comply with the following:

1.

Outside storage and work areas shall be screened with a solid sight-obscuring decorative masonry wall, a minimum of six feet and a maximum of eight feet in height. The wall shall include sight-obscuring gates. Walls and gates shall be continuously maintained in good repair; and

2.

Site operations in conjunction with outdoor uses, including the loading and unloading of equipment and materials, shall be screened to minimize the visibility of operations.

D.

Outdoor Building Materials and Garden Supply Areas. Outdoor building materials and garden supply areas shall be screened with fencing, landscaping, meshing, walls, or similar material to minimize visibility of the storage area.

(Ord. No. 1576, § 2 (Exh. A, amd.), 10-23-2012)

19.20.100 - Setback Requirements and Exceptions.

This Section provides standards for the use and minimum size of required setbacks. These standards are intended to provide open areas around structures for: visibility and traffic safety; access to and around structures; access to natural light, ventilation and direct sunlight; separation of incompatible land uses; and space for privacy, landscaping, and recreation.

A.

Setback Requirements.

1.

All structures shall comply with the setback requirements of the applicable zoning district established by Article 2 (Zoning Districts, Allowable Land Uses, and Zone-Specific Standards), and with any special setbacks established for specific uses by this Zoning Ordinance, except as otherwise provided by this Section.

2.

No portion of a structure, including eaves or roof overhangs, shall extend beyond a property line; or into an access easement or street right-of-way.

3.

Each required setback shall be open and unobstructed from the ground upward, except as provided in this Section.

B.

Exception from Setback Requirements. The minimum setback requirements of this Zoning Ordinance apply to all uses except the following:

1.

Fences or walls in compliance with Section 19.20.040 (Fences, Walls, and Hedges);

2.

Decks, earthworks, free-standing solar devices, pavement, steps, terraces, and other site design elements which are placed directly upon the finish grade and do not exceed a height of 18 inches above the surrounding finish grade at any point; and

Pools, hot tubs, spas and less than 18 inches in height above finished grade, except as required by the Building Code. Any decking exceeding 18 inches above surrounding grade must comply with the standards contained in Section 19.34.032D4.

C.

Measurement of Setbacks. Setbacks shall be measured from the exterior wall of structures, as follows: See Figure 3-5.

1.

Front Yard Setbacks. The front yard setback shall be measured at right angles from the nearest point on the front property line of the parcel to the nearest portion of the structure, except as provided in following Subsections C.1.a through C.1.c. Whenever a future right-of-way line is officially established for a street, required setbacks shall be measured from the established lines.

a.

Averaging. The required front yard setback may be calculated based on an averaging of adjoining parcels only under the following circumstances:

(1)

On a site situated between two parcels developed with buildings, the minimum front yard setback shall be the average depth of the front yards on the two developed parcels.

(2)

Where a site is not situated between two developed parcels, and where parcels comprising 40 percent of the block frontage are developed with buildings, the minimum front yard setback shall be the average of the existing front yard depths on the block.

(3)

In computing the average front yard depth, a depth no greater than 10 feet more than the minimum required front yard setback shall be used in lieu of any greater existing front yard depth.

(4)

When an interior parcel in a residential zoning district adjoins a parcel on the same street frontage in another zoning district, the required front setback on the interior parcel may be reduced by the Director to not less than the average of the required depth and the width or depth of the setback required on the parcel in the other zoning district.

b.

Corner Parcels. The measurement shall be taken from the nearest line of the structure to the nearest point of the property line adjoining the street which is opposite the rear yard.

c.

Flag Lots. As determined by the Director based on the orientation of buildings on adjacent parcels, either:

(1)

The measurement shall be taken from the nearest point of the wall of the main structure facing the street to the point where the access strip meets the bulk of the parcel; establishing a building line parallel to the lot line nearest to the public street or right-of-way (see Figure 3-6); or

(2)

From the lot line that forms the outermost extension of the flag.

2.

Side Yard and Street Side Yard Setbacks. Side yard and street side yard setbacks shall be measured at right angles from the nearest point on the side property line of the parcel to the nearest portion of the structure; establishing a setback line parallel to the side property line, which extends between the front and rear yards.

3.

Rear Yard Setbacks.

a.

The rear yard setback shall be measured at right angles from the nearest point on the rear property line of the parcel to the nearest portion of the structure, establishing a setback line parallel to the rear property line, except as provided in following Subsection C.3.b.

b.

Where the side lot lines converge to a point, a line five feet long within the parcel, parallel to and at a maximum distance from the front lot line, shall be deemed to be the rear lot line for the purpose of determining the depth of the required rear yard setback. See Figure 3-7.

4.

Double-Frontage Lots. The location of the front and rear yard setbacks on double-frontage lots shall be determined by the Director based on the placement of existing buildings on adjacent lots.

==> picture [229 x 180] intentionally omitted <==

==> picture [166 x 153] intentionally omitted <==

D.

Allowed projections into setbacks. Attached architectural features may extend beyond the wall of the structure and into the front, side, and rear setbacks, in compliance with Table 3-2 below.

TABLE 3-2

ALLOWED PROJECTIONS INTO SETBACKS

Allowed Projection into Specifed Setback Allowed Projection into Specifed Setback Allowed Projection into Specifed Setback
Projecting Feature Front
Setback
Side Setback Rear Setback
Bay windows, and other similar cantilevered features
providing foor area, not exceeding 10 ft in width
36 in (1) 5 ft
Chimney/freplace, 6 ft or less in width 36 in 36 in (1)
Canopy, cornice, eave, roof overhang
Ground level deck or porch, which may not be roofed
(2)
6 ft 6 ft
Stairway, not attached to deck, not enclosed, and
does not extend above a ground foor entrance

Notes:

(1)

Feature may project no closer than 36 inches to any side or rear property line.

(2)

Decks less than 18 inches above finished grade are exempt in compliance with Section 19.20.100.B.2.

E.

Limitations on the Use of Setbacks. Required setback areas shall only be used in compliance with the following requirements, and as provided by Section 19.34.130 (Outdoor Dining Display and Sales):

1.

Structures. Required setback areas shall not be occupied by permanent structures other than:

a.

The fences and walls permitted by Section 19.20.040 (Fences, Walls, and Hedges);

b.

The projections into setbacks allowed by Subsection D. (Allowed Projections into Setbacks); and

c.

Accessory uses and structures permitted by Section 19.34.032.

2.

Storage. No required setback shall be used for the storage of inoperable vehicles, scrap, junk, building materials, or similar material.

3.

Parking. Required residential parking shall not be located within a front (or side on a streetside corner lot) setback area. Required parking for an accessory dwelling unit is addressed in Section 19.34.030 (Accessory

Dwelling Units). Non-required residential parking (e.g., guests parking on a driveway) is allowable within required setback areas only on paved driveways, and within paved side yards, in compliance with Section 19.30.070 (Parking Design Standards), and Section 19.34.170 (Vehicle Parking in Residential Zones).

4.

Pavement. Within a residential zoning district, pavement within a front yard setback shall be limited to no more than 50 percent of the area of the required setback, unless a greater percentage of paved area is approved through Design Review.

(Ord. No. 1576, § 2 (Exh. A, amd.), 10-23-2012; Ord. No. 1637, § 3(Exh. A), 2-27-2018; Ord. No. 1676, Exh. A, 3-8-2022)

19.20.110 - Solar Access and Solar Equipment.

All projects requiring discretionary approval shall be reviewed for potential energy conservation measures. Passive heating and cooling opportunities should be incorporated into single-family residential subdivisions and multi-family residential projects whenever possible.

A.

Energy Conservation and Solar Orientation. Consideration of the following passive solar energy techniques is strongly encouraged:

1.

Street Orientation. Streets that run generally east and west are encouraged because they increase the likelihood and desirability of houses sited with solar access to the south. South-wall glass is important to providing maximum passive solar heating. Where streets do run primarily north and south, passive solar access can still be provided by creative parcel configuration, orientation of units on the parcels and/or increased side yard areas.

2.

Setbacks. Placing the house near the north boundary of the parcel provides maximum southern exposure and open space to protect solar access controlled by the owner of the house rather than by an adjacent neighbor.

3.

Siting. In general, houses should be sited so that south-facing glass is maximized, and east- and west-facing glass is minimized. Dwelling units that are attached in preferred east-west directions should not be staggered so as to block the south-facing glass collector surfaces of other units in the attached group. Also, individual and attached units should be separated from north to south so that no unit blocks the solar access of another.

4.

Compact Design. Minimize heat loss by reducing the area of exterior wall and roof surfaces. Use a compact design, (i.e., a two-story house) rather than have the same amount of floor space spread out on a single story.

B.

Pools and Spas. Pool or spa facilities owned and maintained by a homeowner's association or multi-family rental complex should be equipped with a solar cover and solar water heating system.

C.

Obstruction of Solar Access. Structures (building, wall, fence, etc.) should not be constructed or vegetation placed or allowed to grow, so as to obstruct solar access on an adjoining parcel.

(Ord. No. 1576, § 2 (Exh. A, amd.), 10-23-2012)

19.20.120 - Solid Waste and Recyclable Materials Storage.

This Section provides standards for solid waste and recyclable material storage areas in compliance with the California Solid Waste Reuse and Recycling Access Act (Public Resources Code Sections 42900 et seq.).

A.

Applicability. These requirements apply to new multi-family residential, and non-residential projects, and additions to existing non-residential projects.

B.

Required Storage for Multi-Family Projects. Multi-family residential projects, with five or more units shall provide solid waste and recyclable material storage areas as follows:

1.

Individual Unit Storage Requirements. Each dwelling shall be designed to provide an indoor area for the indoor storage of solid waste and recyclable material prior to its placement in a common storage area. A minimum of three cubic feet shall be provided for the storage of solid waste and a minimum of three cubic feet shall be provided for recyclable material; and

2.

Common Storage Requirements. Multi-family residential projects shall provide solid waste and recyclable material storage areas in compliance with Table 3-3. The storage areas may be located indoors or outdoors as long as they are readily accessible to all residents. These requirements apply to each individual structure.

Table 3-3

Multi-Family Solid Waste Storage Requirements

Number of Units Minimum Storage Areas Required (sq. ft.) Minimum Storage Areas Required (sq. ft.)
Solid Waste Recycling Total Area
5-6 12 12 24
7-15 24 24 48
16-25 48 48 96
26-50 96 96 192
51-75 144 144 288
76-100 192 192 384
--- --- --- ---
101-125 240 240 480
126-150 288 288 576
151-175 336 336 672
176-200 384 384 768
201+ Every additional 25 units shall require an additional 48 sq. ft. for solid
waste and 48 sq. ft. for recyclables.

C.

Required Storage for Non-residential Structures and Uses. Non-residential structures and uses within all zoning districts shall provide solid waste and recyclable material storage areas in compliance with Table 3-4. These requirements apply to each individual structure, and shall apply to both new structures, and additions to existing structures which increase floor area by 30 percent or more within any 12-month period.

Table 3-4

Non-Residential Solid Waste Storage Requirements

Building Floor Area (sf) Minimum Storage Areas Required (sq. ft.) Minimum Storage Areas Required (sq. ft.)
Solid Waste Recycling Total Area
0-5,000 12 12 24
5,001-10,000 24 24 48
10,001-25,000 48 48 96
25,001-50,000 96 96 192
50,001-75,000 144 144 288
75,001-100,000 192 192 384
100,001+ Every additional 25,000 sq. ft. shall require an additional 48 sq. ft. for
solid waste and 48 sq. ft. for recyclables.

D.

Location Requirements. Solid waste and recyclable materials storage areas shall be located as follows:

1.

Solid waste and recyclable materials storage shall be located adjacent to or combined with one another as practically feasible. They may only be located inside a specially-designated structure, on the outside of a structure within an approved fence or wall enclosure, a designated interior court or yard area with appropriate access, or in rear yards and interior side yards. Exterior storage areas shall not be located in a required front

yard, street side yard, parking area, landscaped or open space areas or any areas required by the Municipal Code to be maintained as unencumbered;

2.

The storage area(s) shall be accessible to residents and employees. Storage areas within multi-family residential projects shall be located within 100 feet of an access doorway to each dwelling unit which they are intended to serve.

E.

Access. Driveways or aisles shall provide unobstructed access for collection vehicles and personnel and provide at least the minimum clearance required by the collection methods and vehicles used by the designated collector.

F.

Design and Construction. The design and construction of the storage areas shall:

1.

Be properly secured to prevent access by unauthorized persons, while allowing authorized persons access for collection and disposal of materials;

2.

Provide a concrete pad within the fenced or walled areas and a concrete apron which facilitates the handling of the individual bins or containers;

3.

Protect the areas and the individual bins or containers from adverse environmental conditions; and

4.

Be appropriately located and screened from view on at least three sides. The method of screening shall be architecturally compatible with the surrounding structures.

5.

If wood fencing is utilized, it should be knot free, durable material of at least 1-inch thickness.

(Ord. No. 1576, § 2 (Exh. A, amd.), 10-23-2012)

DIVISION 19.21 - ART PROGRAM

19.21.010 - Purpose of Division.

This Division sets forth requirements for art to enrich the lives of residents and visitors, create a unique sense of place and enhance the attractiveness and quality of life within the community. Art helps make our City more livable and more visually stimulating. The experience of art makes the public areas of buildings and their

grounds more welcoming, and it creates a deeper interaction with the places we visit and in which we work and live.

To achieve these goals, art should be integrated into project planning at the earliest possible stage. If providing art is required instead of paying an in-lieu fee, an artist should become a member of the project's design team early in the design process.

(Ord. No. 1576, § 2 (Exh. A, amd.), 10-23-2012)

19.21.020 - Definitions.

As Used in this Division:

A.

"Art" shall mean, but is not limited to, all paintings, murals, inscriptions, stained glass, fiber work, statues, reliefs, or other sculpture, monuments, fountains, arches, or other structure intended for ornament, commemoration, or display. Carvings, frescoes, mosaics, mobiles, photographs, drawings, collages, prints and work in clay, fiber, wood, metal, glass, plastics and other materials are also included. Landscape items including the artistic placement of natural materials or other functional art objects may be included. Works of art may be portable as well as permanent.

B.

"Construction Cost" shall be determined by the Chief Building Official in accordance with the most recent building valuation data published by the International Code Council for use as provided in Section 223 of the California Building Code.

C.

"Construction" or "Alteration" shall mean the construction of a new residential dwelling unit(s) or the construction of a new nonresidential structure(s) or the rehabilitation, renovation, remodeling or improvement resulting in an increase of the gross square footage of an existing non-residential building.

D.

"Art Project" shall mean the development, acquisition, and installation of the art required by this Division.

E.

"Residential Development" shall mean all residential development of five (5) or more units.

F.

"Nonresidential" shall mean every land use other than a residential development, including a mixed-use project with residential units.

(Ord. No. 1576, § 2 (Exh. A, amd.), 10-23-2012)

19.21.030 - Applicability.

This division shall apply to all new residential developments of five or more units and construction or alteration of nonresidential structures. This division shall not apply to accessory dwelling units and renovations, remodels or additions to existing residences, the residential portion of a mixed use project when four (4) or fewer units are proposed, or affordable housing components of residential and mixed-use projects.

(Ord. No. 1576, § 2 (Exh. A, amd.), 10-23-2012)

19.21.040 - Non-Residential Requirements.

Construction or alteration of a nonresidential building shall require that an Art Project be installed and maintained as part of the project. The Art Project shall have a value of not less than one-third of one percent of the construction cost of the completed development project.

(Ord. No. 1576, § 2 (Exh. A, amd.), 10-23-2012)

19.21.050 - Residential Requirements.

Construction of a residential development shall require that an Art Project be installed and maintained as part of the project. The Art Project shall have a value of not less than one-third of one percent of the construction cost of the completed development project.

(Ord. No. 1576, § 2 (Exh. A, amd.), 10-23-2012)

19.21.060 - General Requirements.

A.

Design Review. An Art Project proposed to satisfy the requirements of this Division shall be subject to Design Review for approval of the scale and location of the proposed Art.

B.

Recreation, Cultural and Community Services Advisory Commission. Art proposed to satisfy the requirements of this Division which is to be located on public property shall be referred to the City's Recreation, Cultural & Community Services Advisory Commission for consideration as to context, scale, artistic quality, media, permanence, durability, and for public safety. The Commission shall provide a recommendation to the Review Authority who will take final action on the Art Project.

C.

Design Review Commission. Art proposed to satisfy the requirements of this Division which is to be located on private property shall be reviewed by the City's Design Review Commission in conjunction with the Design Review of the structure or site where the Art is proposed to be located. The Design Review Commission shall provide a recommendation to the Review Authority, and shall consider the context, scale, artistic quality, media, permanence, durability, and for public safety and relationship to the building or site where the Art is proposed to be located. The Design Review Commission may request review and recommendation from the Recreation, Cultural & Community Services Advisory Commission where warranted.

D.

Location. Art shall be displayed in a manner that will enhance its enjoyment by the general public. Art may be located (1) in areas on the site of the building or addition clearly visible from the public street or sidewalk, or (2) on the site of the approved open space feature of the project, or (3) on adjacent public property upon the approval of any relevant public agency, (4) in a publicly accessible lobby area of an office building or hotel, (5) public park, (6) entry to residential development, (7) common area of a residential development, (8) or as otherwise determined appropriate by the Design Review Authority.

E.

Timing of Installation. Art shall be installed prior to the issuance of the first certificate of occupancy provided for any building in non-residential development or residence in a residential development. However, if the Community Development Director concludes that it is not feasible to install the works of art within the time allotted and adequate assurance (which the Director may require to be in the form of a letter of credit or bond) is provided that the works will be installed in a timely manner, the Community Development Director may extend the time for installation for a period of not more than 12 months.

(Ord. No. 1576, § 2 (Exh. A, amd.), 10-23-2012)

19.21.070 - In-Lieu Fees.

A.

The Director of Parks, Recreation and Community Services (DPRCS) may allow payment of an in-lieu fee for all or a portion of the art requirement if the DPRCS finds that the location, siting or scale makes the provision of art inappropriate or infeasible, or whether for other reasons, the DPRCS agrees with the developer's request not to integrate an art element into the project. The in-lieu fee shall be calculated in the following manner:

1.

Nonresidential Development. A fee equal to one-half of one percent of the construction cost, or the difference between the cost of the art installed and one-half of one percent of the development's construction cost. The fee shall be paid prior to the issuance of a building permit for a nonresidential development.

2.

Residential Development. A fee equal to one-third of one percent of the construction cost, or the difference between the cost of art installed and one-third of one percent of the construction cost. The fee shall be paid prior to the issuance of the first certificate of occupancy in a residential development.

3.

In-lieu Fees Shall be Placed in an Art Fund to be Administered by the City. In-lieu fees collected by the City shall be used for City-owned art or City-sponsored exhibitions. The fund shall be used exclusively to (1) provide sites for works of art, (2) acquire and install works of art, (3) maintain works of art, or (4) support the exhibition of art which is publicly accessible.

(Ord. No. 1576, § 2 (Exh. A, amd.), 10-23-2012)

19.21.080 - Maintenance and Removal, and Replacement of Works of Art.

The owner of the real property on which art is located shall maintain the art installed pursuant to this Division. No work of art may be removed unless a replacement work of art is approved pursuant to the procedures in Section 19.21. Artwork that has been damaged, destroyed, or stolen shall be replaced by the owner in compliance with this Division.

(Ord. No. 1576, § 2 (Exh. A, amd.), 10-23-2012)

DIVISION 19.22 - GENERAL PERFORMANCE STANDARDS

19.22.010 - Purpose of Division.

This Division provides performance standards that are designed to minimize various potential operational impacts of development and new land uses within the City, and promote compatibility with adjoining areas and land uses.

(Ord. No. 1576, § 2 (Exh. A, amd.), 10-23-2012)

19.22.020 - Applicability.

The provisions of this Division apply to all new and existing land uses, including permanent and temporary uses, in all zoning districts unless an exemption is specifically provided. Existing uses on the effective date of this Division shall not be altered or modified thereafter to conflict with these standards.

(Ord. No. 1576, § 2 (Exh. A, amd.), 10-23-2012)

19.22.030 - Electrical Interference.

Uses, activities, and processes shall not be operated to produce electric and/or magnetic fields that adversely affect the public health, safety, and general welfare of the community, including interference with normal radio, telephone, or television reception from off the premises where the activity is conducted.

(Ord. No. 1576, § 2 (Exh. A, amd.), 10-23-2012)

19.22.040 - Electrical and Mechanical Equipment.

Electrical and mechanical equipment (e.g., air conditioners, antennas, filters, heating and ventilation equipment, pumps, transformers, etc.) shall not be located and operated to disturb adjoining uses or activities. Electrical and mechanical equipment located within 15 feet of a side property line in a residential zoning district shall be sound attenuated to the maximum noise levels described in Table 3-5 in a manner acceptable to the Director.

(Ord. No. 1576, § 2 (Exh. A, amd.), 10-23-2012)

19.22.050 - Explosive or Fire Hazard.

Uses, activities, and processes shall comply with the minimum requirements of the Uniform Fire Code as adopted by the City, and California Code of Regulations Title 19.

(Ord. No. 1576, § 2 (Exh. A, amd.), 10-23-2012)

19.22.060 - Light and Glare.

Light or glare from interior or exterior lighting, mechanical or chemical processes, or from reflective materials used or stored on a site, shall be shielded or modified to prevent emission of light or glare beyond the property line. The placement of exterior lights shall eliminate spillover illumination or glare onto adjoining properties to the maximum extent feasible, and not interfere with the normal operation or enjoyment of adjoining properties. All non-essential internal and exterior lighting including lighted signs shall be turned off after 11:00 p.m. (except for uses with extended hours).

(Ord. No. 1576, § 2 (Exh. A, amd.), 10-23-2012)

19.22.070 - Noise and Construction Hours.

A.

Applicability. Uses, activities, and processes shall not generate or emit any noise or sound in excess of the levels provided in Table 3-5 beyond the property line of the parcel on which they are located, except as provided in Subsection B.

B.

Exceptions. The following are exempt from the allowable noise level requirements of Table 3-5 as noted:

1.

Aerial warning devices that are required by law to protect the health, safety, and welfare of the community;

2.

Emergency vehicle responses and all necessary equipment utilized in responses to a declared state of emergency;

3.

Airport, and railroad operations;

4.

Authorized construction activities, including warming-up or servicing of equipment, and any preparation for construction between 7 a.m. and 6 p.m. on weekdays, and between 10 a.m. and 5 p.m. on Saturdays. No construction is allowed on Sundays or official federal national holidays, except as otherwise authorized herein by the Community Development Director.

5.

Authorized grading activities and equipment operations between 7 a.m. to 6 p.m. weekdays only, when City inspectors are available.

6.

Routine maintenance activities.

Other construction activities as authorized in writing by the Community Development Director.

C.

Noise Measurement. Exterior noise levels shall be measured at the property line of the noise source. Noise measurement shall be made with a sound level meter using the "A" weighted scale at slow meter response. Fast meter response shall be used only for an impulsive noise.

Table 3-5

Allowable Exterior Noise Levels

Type of Land Use Allowable Exterior Levels (1)
Time Interval Maximum Noise Level (2)
Residential (3) 10 p.m. to 6 a.m. 45 dBA
6 a.m. to 10 p.m. 60 dBA
Commercial (4) 10 p.m. to 6 a.m. 60 dBA
6 a.m. to 10 p.m. 70 dBA
Industrial or manufacturing (4) Any time 70 dBA

Notes:

(1)

Each of the noise limits specified in Table 3-5 shall be reduced by 5 dBA for impulse or simple tone noises. If the ambient noise exceeds the resulting standard, the ambient shall be the standard.

(2)

Maximum noise levels shall not be exceeded for an aggregate period of more than three minutes within a onehour time period or by more than 20 dBA at any time.

(3)

Residential standards apply to sensitive receptors such as schools, hospitals, libraries, group care facilities, and convalescent homes. These uses may require special mitigation.

(4)

Commercial standards apply to Mixed Use Districts.

D.

Authorized construction activity and uses established through the discretionary land use permit process may be subject to specific noise conditions of approval and/or mitigation measures that are more restrictive.

(Ord. No. 1576, § 2 (Exh. A, amd.), 10-23-2012)

19.22.080 - Odor.

Noxious, odorous emissions of a type or quantity that would be detrimental to, or endanger the public health, safety, or general welfare of the community, are declared to be public nuisance and unlawful, and shall be modified to prevent the release of further emissions.

(Ord. No. 1576, § 2 (Exh. A, amd.), 10-23-2012)

19.22.090 - Vibration.

Uses, activities, and processes shall not generate ground vibration that is perceptible without instruments by the average person at any point along or beyond the property line of the parcel containing the activities. Vibrations from temporary construction, demolition, and vehicles that enter and leave the subject parcel (e.g., construction equipment, trains, trucks, etc.) are exempt.

(Ord. No. 1576, § 2 (Exh. A, amd.), 10-23-2012)

DIVISION 19.23 - ADULT-ORIENTED BUSINESSES

19.23.010 - Purpose of Division.

A.

It is the intent of this Division to prevent community wide adverse economic impacts, increased crime, decreased property values, and the deterioration of neighborhoods which can be brought about by the concentration of Adult-Oriented Businesses in close proximity to each other or proximity to other incompatible uses such as schools for minors, religious facilities, and residentially zoned districts or uses. The Council finds that it has been demonstrated in various communities that the concentration of Adult-Oriented Businesses causes an increase in the number of transients in the area, and an increase in crime, and in addition to the effects described above can cause other businesses and residents to move elsewhere. It is, therefore, the purpose of this Article to establish reasonable and uniform regulations to prevent the concentration of AdultOriented Businesses or their close proximity to incompatible uses, while permitting the location of AdultOriented Businesses in certain areas.

B.

It is the purpose of this Division to regulate Adult-Oriented Businesses in order to promote the health, safety, morals, and general welfare of the citizens of the City. The provisions of this Division have neither the purpose nor effect of imposing a limitation or restriction on the content of any communicative materials, including adultoriented materials. Similarly, it is not the intent nor effect of this Division to restrict or deny access by adults to adult-oriented materials protected by the First Amendment, or to deny access by the distributors and exhibitors of adult-oriented entertainment to their intended market. Neither is it the intent nor effect of this Division to condone or legitimize the distribution of obscene material.

(Ord. No. 1576, § 2 (Exh. A, amd.), 10-23-2012)

19.23.020 - Applicability.

A.

Regulatory Permit Required. It shall be unlawful for any person to engage in, conduct or carry on, or to permit to be engaged in, conducted or carried on, in or upon any premises in the City, the operation of an AdultOriented Business unless the person first obtains and continues to maintain in full force and effect an AdultOriented Business Regulatory Permit from the City in compliance with this Division. The fact that an applicant possesses other types of state or City permits or licenses does not exempt the applicant from the requirement of obtaining an Adult-Oriented Business Regulatory Permit for each site/location.

B.

Performer Permit Required. It shall be unlawful for any persons to engage in or participate in any live performance depicting specified anatomical areas or involving specified sexual activities in an Adult-Oriented Business unless the person first obtains and continues in full force and effect an Adult-Oriented Business Performer Permit from the City in compliance with this Division.

C.

Employment Without Permits Prohibited. It shall be unlawful for any owner, operator, manager, or permittee in charge of or in control of an Adult-Oriented Business which provides live entertainment depicting specified anatomical areas or involving specified sexual activities to allow any person to perform who is not in possession of a valid, unrevoked Adult-Oriented Business Performer Permit.

D.

Time Limit for Application Filing. All persons who possess an outstanding business license heretofore issued for the operation of an Adult-Oriented Business and all persons required by this Division to obtain an AdultOriented Business Performer Permit, shall apply for the permit within 90 days of the effective date of this Division. Failure to do so and continued operation of an Adult-Oriented Business, or the continued performances depicting specified anatomical areas or specified sexual activities in an Adult-Oriented Business after 90 days shall constitute a violation of this Division.

(Ord. No. 1576, § 2 (Exh. A, amd.), 10-23-2012)

19.23.030 - Location Requirements.

An Adult-Oriented Business establishment shall be located only in a zoning district where allowed by Article 2 (Zoning Districts, Allowable Land Uses, and Zone-Specific Standards), and only on a site that also complies with the requirements of this Section.

A.

Separation from Incompatible Uses. An Adult-Oriented Business establishment shall not be located within:

1.

Three hundred feet from any other Adult-Oriented Business establishment;

2.

Five hundred feet from any religious facility;

Five hundred feet from any school or other land use accommodating or oriented to youth/minors as determined by the Zoning Administrator (for example, video game arcades, skating rinks, pizza parlors, etc.);

4.

Five hundred feet from any public park; or

5.

Three hundred feet from any residential zoning district or conforming residential use (i.e., mixed use project).

B.

Measurement of Distance Between Uses. The required separation distance between an Adult-Oriented Business establishment and any of the uses or areas listed in Subsection A. shall be measured in a straight line, from the closest points on the property lines of each site.

(Ord. No. 1576, § 2 (Exh. A, amd.), 10-23-2012)

19.23.040 - Business Permit Filing and Processing.

Every person who proposes to maintain, operate or conduct an Adult-Oriented Business in the City shall file an application with the Police Chief upon a form provided by the City and shall pay a filing fee, as established by resolution adopted by the Council from time-to-time, which shall not be refundable.

A.

Application Content. Adult-Oriented Business Regulatory Permits are nontransferable, except in accordance with Subsection F. below. Therefore, all applications shall include the following information:

1.

Applicant Name and Signature.

a.

If the applicant is an individual, the individual shall state his or her legal name, including any aliases, address, and submit satisfactory written proof that he or she is at least 18 years of age.

b.

If the applicant is a partnership, the partners shall state the partnership's complete name, address, the names of all partners, whether the partnership is general or limited, and attach a copy of the partnership agreement, if any.

c.

If the applicant is a corporation, the corporation shall provide its complete name, the date of its incorporation, evidence that the corporation is in good standing under the laws of California, the names and capacity of all officers and directors, the name of the registered corporate agent and the address of the registered office for service of process.

d.

If the applicant is an individual, he or she shall sign the application. If the applicant is other than an individual, an officer of the business entity or an individual with a 10 percent or greater interest in the business entity shall sign the application.

e.

If the applicant intends to operate the Adult-Oriented Business under a name other than that of the applicant, the applicant shall file the fictitious name of the Adult-Oriented Business and show proof of registration of the fictitious name.

2.

Description of Business. A description of the type of Adult-Oriented Business for which the Permit is requested and the proposed address where the Adult Oriented Business will operate, plus the names and addresses of the owners and lessors of the Adult-Oriented Business site.

3.

Mailing Address. The address to which notice of action on the application is to be mailed.

4.

Employees, Contractors, and Performers. The names of all employees, independent contractors, and other persons who will perform at the adult-oriented business, who are required by Section 19.23.020 (Applicability) to obtain an adult-oriented business performer permit (for ongoing reporting requirements see Section 19.23.050 (Performer Permit Filing and Processing).

5.

Floor Plan. A sketch or diagram showing the interior configuration of the premises, including a statement of the total floor area occupied by the adult-oriented business. The sketch or diagram need not be professionally prepared, but shall be drawn to a designated scale or drawn with marked dimensions of the interior of the premises to an accuracy of plus or minus six inches.

6.

Documentation of Separation from Incompatible Uses. A certificate and straight-line drawing prepared within 30 days prior to application depicting the building and the portion thereof to be occupied by the Adult-Oriented Business, and

a.

The property line of any other adult-oriented business within 500 feet of the primary entrance of the AdultOriented Business for which a Permit is requested; and

b.

The property lines of any religious facility, school, park, residential zone or use within 700 feet of the primary entrance of the adult-oriented business.

7.

Parking Diagram. A diagram of the off-street parking areas and premises entries of the Adult-Oriented Business showing the location of the lighting system required by Section 19.23.080 (Adult Business Development and Performance Standards).

B.

Initial Application Review. If the Police Chief determines that the applicant has completed the application improperly, the Police Chief shall promptly notify the applicant of such fact and, on request of the applicant, grant the applicant an extension of time of 10 days or less to complete the application properly. In addition, the applicant may request an extension, not to exceed 10 days, of the time for the Police Chief to act on the application. The time period for granting or denying a Permit shall be stayed during the period in which the applicant is granted an extension of time.

C.

Investigation and Action on Complete Application. Upon receipt of a completed application and payment of the application and Permit fees, the Police Chief shall immediately stamp the application as received and promptly investigate the information contained in the application to determine whether the applicant shall be issued an Adult-Oriented Business Regulatory Permit.

1.

Within 30 days of receipt of the completed application, the Police Chief shall complete the investigation, grant or deny the application in accordance with the provisions of this Section, and so notify the applicant as follows:

a.

The Police Chief shall write or stamp "Granted" or "Denied" on the application and date and sign the notation.

b.

If the application is denied, the Police Chief shall attach to the application a statement of the reasons for denial.

c.

If the application is granted, the Police Chief shall attach to the application an Adult-Oriented Business Regulatory Permit.

d.

The application as granted or denied and the Permit, if any, shall be placed in the United States mail, first class postage prepaid, addressed to the applicant at the address stated in the application.

2.

The Police Chief shall grant the application and issue the Adult Oriented Business Regulatory Permit upon findings that the proposed business meets the locational criteria of Section 19.23.030; and that the applicant has met all of the development and performance standards and requirements of Section 19.23.080, unless the

application is denied for one or more of the reasons set forth in Subsection D. The Permittee shall post the Permit conspicuously in the Adult-Oriented Business premises.

3.

If the Police Chief grants the application or neither grants nor denies the application within 30 days after it is stamped as received (except as provided in Subsection B.), the applicant may begin operating the AdultOriented Business for which the Permit was sought, subject to strict compliance with the development and performance standards and requirements of Section 19.23.080, and any additional permit as may be required by Article 2.

4.

Other permits required. Any other permits required pursuant to Article 2 or 4 herein (e.g., Use Permit, Design Review, etc.) shall be granted or denied by the Review Authority within 90 days from the date of certification of an Environmental Impact Report or within 60 days from adoption of a Negative Declaration or within 30 days if the project is determined exempt from California Environmental Quality Act.

D.

Permit Denial. The Police Chief shall deny the application for any of the following reasons:

1.

The building, structure, equipment, or location used by the business for which an Adult-Oriented Business Regulatory Permit is required do not comply with the requirements and standards of the health, zoning, fire and safety laws of the City and the State of California, or with the locational or development and performance standards and requirements of these regulations.

2.

The applicant, his or her employee, agent, partner, director, officer, shareholder or manager has knowingly made any false, misleading or fraudulent statement of material fact in the application for an Adult Business Regulatory Permit.

3.

An applicant is under 18 years of age.

4.

The required application fee has not been paid.

5.

The Adult-Oriented Business does not comply with the locational standards in Section 19.23.030.

E.

Expiration of Permit. Each Adult-Oriented Business Regulatory Permit shall expire one year from the date of issuance, and may be renewed only by filing with the Police Chief a written request for renewal, accompanied by the Annual Permit Fee and a copy of the Permit to be renewed. The request for renewal shall be made at

least 30 days before the expiration date of the Permit. When made less than 30 days before the expiration date, the expiration of the Permit will not be stayed. Applications for renewal shall be acted on as provided herein for action upon applications for Permits.

F.

Transfer of Permit. A permittee shall not operate an Adult-Oriented Business under the authority of an AdultOriented Business Regulatory Permit at any place other than the address of the Adult-Oriented Business stated in the application for the Permit.

1.

A permittee shall not transfer ownership or control of an Adult-Oriented Business or transfer an Adult-Oriented Business Regulatory Permit to another person unless and until the transferee obtains an amendment to the Permit from the Police Chief stating that the transferee is now the permittee. An amendment may be obtained only if the transferee files an application with the Police Chief in accordance with this Section, accompanies the application with a transfer fee in an amount set by resolution of the City Council, and the Police Chief determines in accordance with this Section that the transferee would be entitled to the issuance of an original Permit.

2.

No Permit may be transferred when the Police Chief has notified the permittee that the Permit has been or may be suspended or revoked.

3.

Any attempt to transfer a permit either directly or indirectly in violation of this section is hereby declared void, and the Permit shall be deemed revoked.

(Ord. No. 1576, § 2 (Exh. A, amd.), 10-23-2012)

19.23.050 - Performer Permit Filing and Processing.

A.

Applicability. No person shall engage in or participate in any live performance depicting specified anatomical areas or involving specified sexual activities in an Adult-Oriented Business, without a valid Adult-Oriented Business Performer Permit issued by the City. All persons who have been issued an Adult-Oriented Business Regulatory Permit shall promptly supplement the information provided as part of the application for the Permit required by Section 19.23.040.A, with the names of all Performers required to obtain an Adult-Oriented Business Performer Permit, within 30 days of any change in the information originally submitted. Failure to submit the changes shall be grounds for suspension of the Adult-Oriented Business Regulatory Permit.

B.

Application Content. The application for a Permit shall be made on a form provided by the Police Chief. An original and two copies of the completed and sworn permit application shall be filed with the Police Chief. The completed application shall contain the following information and be accompanied by the following documents:

The applicant's legal name and any other names (including "stage names" and aliases) used by the applicant;

2.

Age, date and place of birth;

3.

Height, weight, hair and eye color;

4.

Present residence address and telephone number;

5.

Whether the applicant has ever been convicted of:

a.

Any of the offenses set forth in Sections 315, 316, 266a, 266b, 266c, 266e, 266g, 266h, 266i, 647(a), 647(b) and 647(d) of the California Penal Code as those sections now exist or may hereafter be amended or renumbered; or

b.

The equivalent of the aforesaid offenses outside the State of California.

6.

Whether the person is or has ever been licensed or registered as a prostitute, or otherwise authorized by the laws of any other jurisdiction to engage in prostitution in such other jurisdiction. If any person mentioned in this subsection has ever been licensed or registered as a prostitute, or otherwise authorized by the laws of any other state to engage in prostitution, a statement shall be submitted giving the place of the registration, licensing or legal authorization, and the inclusive dates during which the person was so licensed, registered, or authorized to engage in prostitution.

7.

State driver's license or identification number;

8.

Satisfactory written proof that the applicant is at least 18 years of age;

9.

The applicant's fingerprints on a form provided by the Police Department, and a color photograph clearly showing the applicant's face. Any fees for the photographs and fingerprints shall be paid by the applicant;

If the application is made for the purpose of renewing a Permit, the applicant shall attach a copy of the Permit to be renewed.

The completed application shall be accompanied by a non-refundable application fee. The amount of the fee shall be set by resolution of the Council.

C.

Initial Application Review. Upon receipt of an application and payment of the application fees, the Police Chief shall immediately stamp the application as received and promptly investigate the application. If the Police Chief determines that the applicant has completed the application improperly, the Police Chief shall promptly notify the applicant of the fact and grant the applicant an extension of time of not more than 10 days to complete the application properly. In addition, the applicant may request an extension, not to exceed 10 days, of the time for the Police Chief to act on the application. The time period for granting or denying a Permit shall be stayed during the period in which the applicant is granted an extension of time.

D.

Investigation and Action on Application.

1.

Within 30 days after receipt of the properly completed application, the Police Chief shall grant or deny the application and so notify the applicant as follows:

a.

The Police Chief shall write or stamp "Granted" or "Denied" on the application and date and sign such notation.

b.

If the application is denied, the Police Chief shall attach to the application a statement of the reasons for denial.

c.

If the application is granted, the Police Chief shall attach to the application an Adult-Oriented Business Performer Permit.

d.

The application as granted or denied and the Permit, if any, shall be placed in the United States mail, first class postage prepaid, addressed to the applicant at the residence address stated in the application.

2.

The Police Chief shall grant the application and issue the Permit unless the application is denied for one or more of the reasons set forth in Subsection E.

3.

If the Police Chief grants the application or if the Police Chief neither grants nor denies the application within 30 days after it is stamped as received (except as provided in Subsection C., the applicant may begin performing in the capacity for which the Permit was sought.

E.

Permit Denial. The Police Chief shall deny the application for any of the following reasons:

1.

The applicant has knowingly made any false, misleading, or fraudulent statement of a material fact in the application for a Permit or in any report or document required to be filed with the application;

2.

The applicant is under 18 years of age;

3.

The Adult-Oriented Business Performer Permit is to be used for performing in a business prohibited by State or City law;

4.

The applicant has been registered in any state as a prostitute; or

5.

The applicant has been convicted of any of the offenses enumerated in Subsection B.5, or convicted of an offense outside the State of California that would have constituted any of the described offenses if committed within the State of California. A Permit may be issued to any person convicted of the described crimes if the conviction occurred more than five years prior to the date of the application.

F.

Expiration. Each Adult-Oriented Business Performer Permit shall expire one year from the date of issuance and may be renewed only by filing with the Police Chief a written request for renewal, accompanied by the application fee and a copy of the Permit to be renewed. The request for renewal shall be made at least 30 days before the expiration date of the Permit. When made less than 30 days before the expiration date, the expiration of the Permit will not be stayed. Applications for renewal shall be acted on as provided herein for applications for Permits.

(Ord. No. 1576, § 2 (Exh. A, amd.), 10-23-2012)

19.23.060 - Suspension or Revocation of Permits.

An Adult-Oriented Business Regulatory Permit or Adult-Oriented Business Performer Permit may be suspended or revoked in accordance with the procedures and standards of this Section.

A.

Notice to Permittee. On determining that grounds for Permit revocation exist, the Police chief shall furnish written notice of the proposed suspension or revocation to the Permittee. Such notice shall set forth the time and place of a hearing, and the ground or grounds upon which the hearing is based, the pertinent Code sections, and a brief statement of the factual matters in support thereof. The notice shall be mailed, postage prepaid, addressed to the last known address of the Permittee, or shall be delivered to the Permittee personally, at least 10 days prior to the hearing date.

B.

Hearings. Hearings shall be conducted in accordance with procedures established by the Police Chief, but at a minimum shall include the following:

1.

The right for all parties involved to offer testimonial, documentary, and tangible evidence bearing on the issues;

2.

All parties may be represented by counsel; and

3.

All parties shall have the right to confront and cross-examine witnesses.

Any relevant evidence may be admitted that is the sort of evidence upon which reasonable persons are accustomed to rely in the conduct of serious affairs. Any hearing under this Section may be continued for a reasonable time for the convenience of a party or a witness. The Police Chief's decision may be appealed in accordance with Section 19.23.070.

C.

Basis for Action. A Permittee may be subject to suspension or revocation of his Permit, or be subject to other appropriate disciplinary action, for any of the following causes arising from the acts or omissions of the Permittee, or an employee, agent, partner, director, stockholder, or manager of an Adult-Oriented Business:

1.

The Permittee has knowingly made any false, misleading or fraudulent statement of material facts in the application for a Permit, or in any report or record required to be filed with the City.

2.

The Permittee, employee, agent, partner, director, stockholder, or manager of an Adult-Oriented Business has knowingly allowed or permitted, and has failed to make a reasonable effort to prevent the occurrence of any of the following on the premises of the Adult-Oriented Business, or in the case of an Adult-Oriented Business Performer, the permittee has engaged in one of the activities described below while on the premises of an Adult-Oriented Business:

a.

Any act of unlawful sexual intercourse, sodomy, oral copulation, or masturbation.

b.

Use of the establishment as a place where unlawful solicitations for sexual intercourse, sodomy, oral copulation, or masturbation openly occur.

c.

Any conduct constituting a criminal offense which requires registration under California Penal Code Section 290.

d.

The occurrence of acts of lewdness, assignation, or prostitution, including any conduct constituting violations of California Penal Code Sections 315, 316, or 318, or Subdivision b. of Section 647.

e.

Any act constituting a violation of provisions in the California Penal Code relating to obscene matter or distribution of harmful matter to minors, including but not limited to Sections 311 through 313.4.

f.

Any conduct prohibited by this Division.

3.

Failure to abide by an disciplinary action previously imposed by an appropriate City official.

D.

Action Following Hearing. After holding the hearing in accordance with the provisions of this Section, if the Police Chief finds and determines that there are grounds for disciplinary action, based upon the severity of the violation, the Police Chief shall impose one of the following:

1.

A warning;

2.

Suspension of the Permit for a specified period not to exceed six months; or

3.

Revocation of the Permit.

(Ord. No. 1576, § 2 (Exh. A, amd.), 10-23-2012)

19.23.070 - Appeals and Judicial Review.

After denial of an application for an Adult-Oriented Business Regulatory Permit or an Adult-Oriented Business Performer Permit, or after denial of renewal of a Permit, or suspension or revocation of a Permit, the applicant or person to whom the Permit was granted may appeal the administrative action to the Council in compliance

with Division 19.54. The Council shall act to grant or deny the appeal within sixty (60) days of receipt of request for review. The judicial review of any permit issued or denied in compliance with this Division shall be subject to expedited judicial review in accordance with the time limits set forth in Code of Civil Procedure Sections 1094.8 et seq.

(Ord. No. 1576, § 2 (Exh. A, amd.), 10-23-2012)

19.23.080 - Adult Business Development and Performance Standards.

The following requirements of this Section shall be deemed conditions of Adult-Oriented Business Regulatory Permit approvals, and failure to comply with every requirement shall be grounds for revocation of the Permit issued in compliance with these regulations:

A.

Fire Regulations. Maximum occupancy load, fire exits, aisles and fire equipment shall be regulated, designed and provided in accordance with the regulations and standards of the Novato Fire Protection District.

B.

Hours of Operation. Except for those businesses also regulated by the California Department of Alcoholic Beverage Control, an Adult-Oriented Business shall be open for business only between the hours of 8:00 a.m. and midnight on any particular day.

C.

Interior Lighting. All areas of the Adult-Oriented Business shall be illuminated at a minimum of the following foot-candles, minimally maintained and evenly distributed at ground level:

Area Minimum Illumination Level
in Footcandles
Bookstores and other retail establishments 20
Theaters and cabarets 1.5 during performances;
5 at all other times
Arcades 10
Hotels/motels 20 in public areas
Modeling studios 20

D.

Management Supervision. All indoor areas of the Adult-Oriented Business within which patrons are permitted, except restrooms, shall be open to view by the management at all times.

E.

Noise Mitigation. The premises within which the Adult-Oriented Business is located shall provide sufficient sound-absorbing insulation so that noise generated inside said premises shall not be audible anywhere on any adjacent property or public right-of-way, or within any other building or other separate unit within the same building.

F.

Parking Area Lighting. All off-street parking area and premise entries of the sexually-oriented business shall be illuminated from dusk to closing hours of operation with a lighting system which provides an average maintained horizontal illumination of one foot candle of light on the parking surface and/or walkways. The required lighting level is established in order to provide sufficient illumination of the parking areas and walkways serving the sexually-oriented business for the personal safety of patrons and employees and to reduce the incidence of vandalism and criminal conduct. The lighting shall be shown on the required sketch or diagram of the premises.

G.

Posting of Entrance. The building entrance to an Adult-Oriented Business shall be clearly and legibly posted with a notice indicating that persons under 18 years of age are precluded from entering the premises. Said notice shall be constructed and posted to the satisfaction of the Police Chief or designee. No person under the age of 18 years shall be permitted within the premises at any time.

H.

Restroom Facilities. The Adult-Oriented Business shall provide and maintain separate restroom facilities for male patrons and employees, and female patrons and employees. Male patrons and employees shall be prohibited from using restrooms for females, and female patrons and employees shall be prohibited from using restrooms for males, except to carry out duties of repair, maintenance and cleaning of the rest room facilities. The rest rooms shall be free from any Adult Material. Rest rooms shall not contain television monitors or other motion picture or video projection, recording or reproduction equipment. The foregoing provisions of this paragraph shall not apply to an Adult-Oriented Business which deals exclusively with sale or rental of Adult Material which is not used or consumed on the premises, such as an Adult Bookstore or Adult Video Store, and which does not provide rest room facilities to its patrons or the general public.

I.

Security Guards. Adult-Oriented Businesses shall employ security guards in order to maintain the public peace and safety, based upon the following standards:

1.

Adult-Oriented Businesses featuring live entertainment shall provide at least one security guard at all times while the business is open. If the occupancy limit of the premises is greater than 35 persons, an additional security guard shall be on duty.

2.

Security guards for other Adult-Oriented Businesses may be required if it is determined by the Police Chief that their presence is necessary in order to prevent any of the conduct listed in Section 19.23.050.B.5 from occurring on the premises.

3.

Security guards shall be charged with preventing violations of law and enforcing compliance by patrons of the requirements of these regulations. Security guards shall be uniformed in such a manner so as to be readily identifiable as a security guard by the public and shall be duly licensed as a security guard as required by applicable provisions of state law. No security guard required pursuant to this subsection shall act as a door person, ticket seller, ticket taker, admittance person, or sole occupant of the manager's station while acting as a security guard.

J.

Visibility of Activities. No Adult-Oriented Business shall be operated in any manner that permits the observation of any material or activities depicting, describing or relating to "specified Sexual Activities" or "specified Anatomical Areas" from any public way or from any location outside the building or area of such establishment. This provision shall apply to any display, decoration, sign, show window or other opening. No exterior door or window on the premises shall be propped or kept open at any time while the business is open, and any exterior windows shall be covered with opaque covering at all times.

K.

Adult Arcade Standards. Any adult-oriented business which is also an "adult arcade" shall comply with the following additional provisions:

1.

The interior of the premises shall be configured in such a manner that there is an unobstructed view from a manager's station of every area of the premises to which any patron is permitted access for any purpose, excluding restrooms. Restrooms may not contain video reproduction equipment. If the premises has two or more manager's stations designated, then the interior of the premises shall be configured in such a manner that there is an unobstructed view of each area of the premises to which any patron is permitted access for any purpose from at least one of the manager's stations. The view required in this subsection shall be direct line of sight from the manager's station.

2.

The view area for management supervision specified in Subsection K.1 shall remain unobstructed by any doors, walls, merchandise, display racks, or other materials at all times. No patron is permitted access to any area of the premises which has been designated as an area in which patrons will not be permitted.

3.

No viewing room may be occupied by more than one person at any one time.

4.

The walls or partitions between viewing rooms or booths shall be maintained in good repair at all times, with no holes between any two such rooms such as would allow viewing from one booth into another or such as to allow physical contact of any kind between the occupants of any two such booths or rooms.

Customers, patrons or visitors shall not be allowed to stand idly by in the vicinity of any such video booths, or to remain in the common area of such business, other than the restrooms, who are not actively engaged in shopping for or reviewing the products available on display for purchaser viewing. Signs prohibiting loitering shall be posted in prominent places in and near the video booths.

6.

The floors, seats, walls and other interior portions of all video booths shall be maintained clean and free from waste and bodily secretions. The presence of human excrement, urine, semen or saliva in any booth shall be evidence of improper maintenance and inadequate sanitary controls; repeated instances of such conditions may justify suspension or revocation of the owner and operator's license to conduct the adult-oriented establishment.

L.

Additional Requirements for Businesses with Live Performances. The following additional requirements shall pertain to Adult-oriented Businesses providing live entertainment depicting Specified Anatomical Areas or involving Specified Sexual Activities, except for businesses regulated by the Alcoholic Beverage Control Commission:

1.

No person shall perform live entertainment for patrons of an Adult-Oriented Business except upon a stage at least 18 inches above the level of the floor, which is separated by a distance of at least 10 feet from the nearest area occupied by patrons, and no patron shall be permitted within 10 feet of the stage while the stage is occupied by an entertainer. "Entertainer" shall mean any person who is an employee or independent contractor of the Adult-Oriented Business, or any person who, with or without any compensation or other form of consideration, performs live entertainment for patrons of an Adult-Oriented Business.

2.

The Adult-Oriented Business shall provide separate dressing room facilities for entertainers which are exclusively dedicated to the entertainers' use.

3.

The Adult-Oriented Business shall provide an entrance/exit for entertainers which is separate from the entrance/exit used by patrons.

4.

The Adult-Oriented Business shall provide access for entertainers between the stage and the dressing rooms which is completely separated from the patrons. If such separate access is not physically feasible, the AdultOriented Business shall provide a minimum three foot wide walk aisle for entertainers between the dressing room area and the stage, with a railing, fence or other barrier separating the patrons and the entertainers capable of (and which actually results in) preventing any physical contact between patrons and entertainers.

5.

No entertainer, either before, during or after performances, shall have physical contact with any patron and no patron shall have physical contact with any entertainer either before, during or after performances by such entertainer. This subsection shall only apply to physical contact on the premises of the Adult-Oriented Business.

6.

Fixed rail(s) at least 30 inches in height shall be maintained establishing the separations between entertainers and patrons required by this subsection.

7.

No patron shall directly pay or give any gratuity to any entertainer and no entertainer shall solicit any pay or gratuity from any patron.

8.

No owner or other person with managerial control over an Adult-Oriented Business shall permit any person on the premises of the Adult-Oriented Business to engage in a live showing of the human male or female genitals, pubic area or buttocks with less than a fully opaque coverage, and/or the female breast with less than a fully opaque coverage over any part of the nipple or areola and/or covered male genitals in a discernibly turgid state. This provision may not be complied with by applying an opaque covering simulating the appearance of the specified anatomical part required to be covered.

(Ord. No. 1576, § 2 (Exh. A, amd.), 10-23-2012)

19.23.090 - Registration of Employees.

Every permittee of an Adult-Oriented Business which provides live entertainment depicting specified anatomical areas or involving specified sexual activities shall maintain a register of all persons so performing on the premises and their permit numbers. The register shall be available for inspection during regular business hours by any police officer or health officer of the City.

(Ord. No. 1576, § 2 (Exh. A, amd.), 10-23-2012)

19.23.100 - Display of Permit and Identification Cards.

A.

Every Adult-Oriented Business shall display at all times during business hours the permit issued pursuant to the provisions of this Division for such Adult-Oriented Business in a conspicuous place so that the same may be readily seen by all persons entering the Adult-Oriented Business.

B.

The Police Chief shall provide each Adult-Oriented Business Performer required to have a Permit in compliance with this Division with an identification card containing the name, address, photograph and permit number of the performer.

C.

An Adult-Oriented Business Performer shall have their identification card available for inspection at all times during which the performer is on the premises of the Adult-Oriented Business.

(Ord. No. 1576, § 2 (Exh. A, amd.), 10-23-2012)

19.23.110 - Employment of and Services to Persons Under 18 Prohibited.

It shall be unlawful for any permittee, operator, or other person in charge of any Adult-Oriented Business to:

A.

Employ, or provide any service for which it requires a permit, to any person who is not at least 18 years of age; or

B.

Permit to enter, or remain within the Adult-Oriented Business, any person who is not at least 18 years of age.

(Ord. No. 1576, § 2 (Exh. A, amd.), 10-23-2012)

19.23.120 - Inspection.

An applicant or Permittee shall permit representatives of the Novato Police Department, Marin County Health Department, Novato Fire Protection District, Novato Community Development Department, or other City departments or agencies to inspect the premises of an Adult Oriented Business for the purpose of insuring compliance with the law and the development and performance standards applicable to Adult-Oriented Businesses, at any time it is occupied or opened for business. A person who operates an Adult-Oriented Business or his or her agent or employee is in violation of the provisions of this section if he/she refuses to permit such lawful inspection of the premises at any time it is occupied or open for business.

(Ord. No. 1576, § 2 (Exh. A, amd.), 10-23-2012)

19.23.130 - Nonconforming Uses.

A.

Amortization Requirements. Any use of real property existing on the effective date of this Division, that does not conform to the provisions of this Division, but which was constructed, operated, and maintained in compliance with all previous regulations, shall be regarded as a nonconforming use which may be continued for 12 months after the effective date of this ordinance. On or before that date, all the nonconforming uses shall be terminated unless an extension of time has been approved by the hearing officer in accordance with the provisions of Subsection B.

1.

Abandonment. Notwithstanding the above, any discontinuance or abandonment of the use of any lot or structure as an Adult-Oriented Business shall result in a loss of legal nonconforming status of the use.

2.

Amortization—Annexed property. Any Adult-Oriented Business that was a legal use at the time of the annexation of the property and which is located in the City, but which does not conform to the provisions of

Section 19.23.030 shall be terminated within one year of the date of annexation unless an extension of time has been approved by the hearing officer in accordance with the provisions of Subsection B.

B.

Extensions of Time. The owner or operator of a nonconforming use as described in Subsection A. may apply under the provisions of this Section to the City Manager for an extension of time within which to terminate the nonconforming use.

1.

Time and Manner of Application. An application for an extension of time within which to terminate a use made nonconforming by the provisions of Section 19.23.030 may be filed by the owner of the real property upon which such use is operated, or by the operator of the use. The application shall be filed with the City Manager at least 90 days but no more than 180 days prior to the time established in Subsection A. for termination of the use.

2.

Content of Application, Fees. The application shall state the grounds for requesting an extension of time. The filing fee for such application shall be the same as that for a variance as is set forth in the schedule of fees established by resolution from time to time by the City Council.

3.

Hearing Procedure. The City Manager shall appoint a hearing officer to hear the application. The hearing officer shall set the matter for hearing within 45 days of receipt of the application. All parties involved shall have the right to offer testimonial, documentary and tangible evidence bearing on the issues; may be represented by counsel; and shall have the right to confront and cross-examine witnesses. Any relevant evidence may be admitted that is the sort of evidence upon which reasonable persons are accustomed to rely in the conduct of serious affairs. Any hearing under this section may be continued for a reasonable time for the convenience of a party or a witness. The decision of the hearing officer shall be final and subject to judicial review pursuant to Code of Civil Procedure section l094.6.

4.

Approval of Extension, Findings. An extension under the provisions of this section shall be for a reasonable period of time commensurate with the investment involved, and shall be approved only if the hearing officer makes all of the following findings or such other findings as are required by law:

a.

The applicant has made a substantial investment (including but not limited to lease obligations) in the property or structure on or in which the nonconforming use is conducted; the property or structure cannot be readily converted to another use; and the investment was made prior to the effective date of this Division.

b.

The applicant will be unable to recoup said investment as of the date established for termination of the use; and

c.

The applicant has made good faith efforts to recoup the investment and to relocate the use to a location in conformance with Section 19.23.030.

(Ord. No. 1576, § 2 (Exh. A, amd.), 10-23-2012)

DIVISION 19.24 - AFFORDABLE HOUSING REQUIREMENTS

19.24.010 - Purpose and Findings.

A.

Purpose. The purpose of this Division (19.24) is to enhance the public welfare and ensure that further housing developments contribute to the attainment of the city's housing goals by increasing the production of units affordable by households of moderate, low and very low income, and additionally stimulating funds or development of moderate, low and very low income housing.

B.

Findings. The council finds that the citizens of the city are experiencing a housing shortage for moderate, low and very low income households. A goal of the city is to achieve a balanced community with housing available for households of a range of income levels. Increasingly, persons with moderate, low and very low incomes who work and/or live within the city are unable to locate housing at prices they can afford and are increasingly excluded from living in the city. Federal and state housing subsidy programs are not sufficient by themselves to satisfy the housing needs of moderate, low and very low income households. The city finds that the high cost of newly constructed housing does not, to any appreciable extent, provide housing affordable by moderate, low and very low income households while at the same time generates increased demand for lower wage service jobs to maintain public and/or common infrastructure, and that continued new development which does not include lower cost housing will serve to further aggravate the current housing shortage by reducing the supply of developable land. The city further finds that the housing shortage for persons of moderate, low and very low incomes is detrimental to the public health, safety and welfare, and further that it is a public policy of the state of California as mandated by the requirements for a housing element of the General Plan, to make available an adequate supply of housing for persons of all economic segments of the community.

(Ord. No. 1576, § 2 (Exh. A, amd.), 10-23-2012)

19.24.020 - Affordable Units or Fee Required.

A.

Requirement. All residential projects of seven (7) or more residential units shall be designed and constructed to include the number of affordable units required by Section 19.24.030 unless the City Council has approved an in-lieu fee pursuant to Section 19.24.040. Residential projects of six (6) or fewer units shall be designed and constructed to include the number of affordable units required by Section 19.24.030 or provide in-lieu fees pursuant to Section 19.24.040. No application for a rezoning, tentative map, master plan precise development plan, use permit, design review or building permit for a residential project shall be approved without compliance with this section 19.24.

B.

Exemptions. This Section 19.24 shall not apply to:

1.

The reconstruction of any dwelling units that were destroyed by fire, flood, earthquake or other act of nature.

2.

Accessory Dwelling Units subject to Section 19.34.030 (Accessory Dwelling Units) and Junior Accessory Dwelling Units subject to Section 19.34.031 (Junior Accessory Dwelling Units) of Division 19.34.

3.

Housing constructed or rehabilitated within a redevelopment project area if the Redevelopment Agency of the City of Novato imposes its own affordability requirements for housing constructed or rehabilitated within the project area pursuant to Section 33413 of the Health and Safety Code.

4.

Projects consisting, in whole or in part, of new or rehabilitated dwelling units developed by the City of Novato's Redevelopment Agency.

5.

Residential Care Facilities for the Elderly in compliance with Section 19.34.160 of Division 19.34.

6.

A land use application that has been accepted by the department as complete prior to October 9, 2007 shall be processed in accordance with the affordable housing requirements in effect when the application was determined complete.

7.

Single or two unit projects with residences of 3000 sq. ft. or less.

(Ord. No. 1576, § 2 (Exh. A, amd.), 10-23-2012; Ord. No. 1676, Exh. A, 3-8-2022; Ord. No. 1718, § 3(Exh. A), 9- 10-2024)

19.24.030 - Number of Affordable Units.

A.

Base Requirement. The number of affordable units required in a residential project are as follows:

Residential Project Size Percentage of Afordable Housing Units Required
3—6 Housing Units 10%* or provide in-lieu fee (see Section
19.24.020(A)
7—10 Housing Units 10%*
11 Units 11%
12 Units 12%
13 Units 13%
--- ---
14 Units 14%
15 Units 15%
16 Units 16%
17 Units 17%
18 Units 18%
19 Units 19%
20 Units or more Housing Units 20%

* See Fractional Units, Section 19.24.030(B)

1.

Rental Projects. A rental project shall include fifty percent (50%) of the required number of affordable units for rent to households earning not more than Low Income at monthly rents not to exceed 1/12 of 30% of the maximum annual income for households earning 60% of area Median Income, less a monthly utility allowance, and 50% of the dwelling units for rent to households earning not more than Very Low Income at monthly rents not to exceed 1/12 of 30% of the maximum annual income for households earning 50% of area Median Income less a monthly utility allowance.

2.

Ownership Projects. An ownership project shall include fifty percent (50%) of the required number of affordable units for sale to households earning nor more than Moderate Income at a price as set forth in subsection 2.a 1, below and fifty percent (50%) of the required number of affordable units for sale to households earning not more than Low Income at a price as set forth in subsection 2.a.2, below.

a.

Affordable Sales Price Calculation.

(1)

Moderate Income Units. In order to qualify as an affordable unit for sale to a Moderate Income Household, average monthly housing payments after factoring in a maximum ten percent down-payment, including interest, principal, mortgage insurance, property taxes, homeowners insurance, property maintenance and repairs, a reasonable allowance for utilities, and homeowner association dues, if any, shall not exceed onetwelfth ( 1/12 ) of thirty-five percent (35%) of the maximum annual household income for households earning not more than 90% of area Median Income, adjusted for assumed household size. The Application material required by Section 19.24.090 shall include documentation which demonstrates, to the satisfaction of the Community Development Director, that average monthly housing payments shall not exceed the standards specified herein.

(2)

Low Income Units. In order to qualify as an low income affordable unit for sale to a Low Income Household, average monthly housing payments after factoring in a maximum ten percent down-payment, including interest, principal, mortgage insurance, property taxes, homeowners insurance, property maintenance and repairs, a reasonable allowance for utilities, and homeowner association dues, if any, one-twelfth ( 1/12 ) of thirty percent (30) of the maximum annual household income for households earning not more than 65% of area median income, adjusted for assumed household size. The Application material required by Section 19.24.090 shall include documentation which demonstrates, to the satisfaction of the Community Development Director, that average monthly housing payments shall not exceed the standards specified herein.

(3)

Land Subdivisions and Parcel Maps. Residential lots created from a subdivision or parcel map application for rental projects and/or ownership projects shall, through conditions of approval, incorporate the requirements of this Division.

B.

Fractional Units. When the application of the percentages specified above results in a number that includes a fraction, the fraction shall be rounded up to the next whole number if the fraction is 0.70 or more. If the result includes a fraction below 0.70, the developer shall have the option of rounding up to the next whole number and providing the affordable unit on-site, or paying an in lieu fee instead of providing an additional affordable unit. The in lieu fee shall be calculated in accordance with Section 19.24.040.

C.

Replacement Units. If a proposed residential project would result in the elimination of existing deed restricted affordable dwelling units, the affordable dwelling units must be replaced on a one-for-one basis with equally affordable or more affordable deed restricted units.

(Ord. No. 1576, § 2 (Exh. A, amd.), 10-23-2012)

19.24.040 - In-Lieu Fees.

A.

As provided in Section 19.24.020A, an in-lieu fee may be paid instead of providing affordable units in a residential project of six (6) or fewer units. As provided in Section 19.24.030B, if the number of affordable units results in a fractional unit below 0.70 an in-lieu fee may be paid instead of providing an affordable unit. In-lieu fees shall be paid prior to issuance of the building permit(s) for the project. The in-lieu fees shall be paid into a separate city fund earmarked for the advancement and development of very-low, low, and moderate income housing. The City Council shall, from time to time, adopt a resolution setting forth the amount of the fees.

B.

A developer proposing to construct a residential project may apply for payment of a fee in lieu of providing some or all of the affordable units required by Section 19.24.030. Application for payment of a fee in lieu of providing some or all of the affordable units required by Section 19.24.030 shall be made in the form of a written request at the time the developer submits the application for the residential project. Final decision of whether to approve the payment of an in-lieu fee shall be at the discretion of the City Council. The decision of whether or not to authorize the payment of an in-lieu fee shall be based on factors including but not limited to,

location, development density, accessibility to public transportation, environmental conditions, and whether the payment of fees would better serve city housing goals, obligations and the production of affordable housing. If an in-lieu fee is approved, the fee shall be determined and paid as provided in Section 19.24.040A.

(Ord. No. 1576, § 2 (Exh. A, amd.), 10-23-2012)

19.24.050 - Alternatives.

A.

The developer may request an alternate means of compliance with this Article other than the provision of the affordable units required by Section 19.24.030 or the payment of in-lieu fees provided for by Section 19.24.040 as part of the application required by Section 19.24.100 in accordance with the following provisions:

1.

Off-Site Construction of Affordable Units. Affordable units may be constructed on a site or sites not contiguous to the residential project at the discretion of the City Council with review authority over the residential project upon a finding that off-site construction equally or better serves city interests because of factors involving the residential project including, but not limited to, overall project size, density, character and location, accessibility to public transportation, and proximity to retail and service establishments. The approval of off-site construction of affordable units shall be subject to Section 19.24.070D, and such terms and conditions as may be imposed by the applicable city body with review authority.

2.

Land Dedication. In lieu of building affordable units, the developer may apply for authorization to dedicate to land within the city provided that the land is suitable for the construction of at least the required number of affordable units pursuant to Section 19.24.030 and is as least equal in value to the cost of providing the affordable units as part of the residential project. The value of a proposed land dedication as compared to the cost of providing the affordable units within the project shall be determined by an appraiser and/or financial analyst appointed by the city and paid for by the developer.

The decision of whether to approve a land dedication in lieu of the building of affordable units shall be based on the factors included in Section 19.24.050(A)(1) above. Alternatively, a land dedication may be authorized based on a finding that the dedication of land in this instance would better serve the best interests of the city in terms of city housing goals, obligations, and the production of affordable housing. The approval of a land dedication shall be at the discretion of the Planning Commission or the City Council, which ever serves as the final review authority over the residential project, and shall be dedicated prior to or concurrent with the residential project's final map or parcel map recordation or issuance of the first building permit, whichever comes first. The approval of a land dedication shall also be subject to such terms and conditions as may be imposed by the city body with review authority.

(Ord. No. 1576, § 2 (Exh. A, amd.), 10-23-2012)

19.24.060 - Credit for Additional Affordable Units.

A.

If the developer completes construction on site of a greater number of affordable units in the project than required by this Article, the additional units may be credited toward meeting the requirements of this Article for a future project. The Developer may use the credits in a future project or transfer the credits in writing to another developer. Credits will only be counted toward required affordable units with the same bedroom count, the same tenure (rental or ownership), and equivalent affordability targets. The credits must be used within 10 years of issuance. Projects which have obtained a density bonus pursuant to Section 19.24.100 or which receive a government subsidy in any form, financial or other, for purposes of construction shall not be eligible for credits.

(Ord. No. 1576, § 2 (Exh. A, amd.), 10-23-2012)

19.24.070 - Affordable Unit Standards.

A.

Mix, Size and Number of Bedrooms.

1.

Affordable units in an ownership project shall be proportional in unit mix including but not limited to the number of bedrooms and unit size as the market rate units. The affordable ownership units need not exceed 1,400 square feet and three bedrooms when included in a development of market rate units for ownership that exceed 1,400 square feet and three bedrooms.

2.

Affordable units in rental projects shall be proportional in unit mix including but not limited to the number of bedrooms and unit size as the market rate units. The affordable rental units need not exceed 900 square feet and two bedrooms when included in a development of market rate rental units that exceed 900 square feet and two bedrooms.

B.

Location and Design. Affordable units shall be dispersed throughout a residential project to the extent feasible and be comparable in construction quality and exterior design to the market rate units.

C.

Equal Access. The affordable units shall have equal access to all on-site amenities available to market rate units.

D.

Timing of Construction. All affordable units must be constructed and occupied prior to or concurrently with the construction and occupancy of market rate units unless an alternative construction timing schedule has been approved by the city body with review authority.

E.

Duration of Affordability Requirement. Affordable units shall be legally restricted to occupancy by households of the income levels for which the units were designated, for a minimum period of 99 years from the date of

first occupancy for rental units, and 99 years from the date of first sale for owner-occupied units, unless the requirements of a California law require a shorter period of duration.

(Ord. No. 1576, § 2 (Exh. A, amd.), 10-23-2012)

19.24.080 - Eligibility for Occupancy of Affordable Units.

A.

General Eligibility. No household may occupy an affordable unit unless the city or its designee has approved the household's eligibility, or has failed to make a determination of eligibility within the time or other limits provided by the affordable rental housing agreement or affordable ownership and resale restrictions provided for in this Article. If the city or its designee maintains a list or identifies eligible households, initial and subsequent occupants shall be selected first from the list of identified households, in compliance with any rules approved by the city.

B.

Occupancy as Principal Residence. A household who occupies a rental affordable unit or who purchases an affordable unit in an ownership project shall, at all times during that household's occupancy, occupy the unit as a principal residence.

(Ord. No. 1576, § 2 (Exh. A, amd.), 10-23-2012)

19.24.090 - Housing Agreements for Affordable Units.

A.

Developer Housing Agreement. Each developer, as a condition of approval for a residential project, shall be required to execute an Inclusionary Housing Agreement in a form provided by the city. The contents of the agreement may vary depending on the manner in which the provisions of this Article are satisfied for a particular residential project. However, each Inclusionary Housing Agreement shall include the following:

1.

A description of the residential project, including whether the affordable units will be rented or owner-occupied;

2.

The number, size and location of the affordable units;

3.

Provisions and/or documents for resale restrictions, deeds of trust, right of first refusal or rental restrictions;

4.

Provisions for monitoring the ongoing affordability of the affordable units, and the process for qualifying prospective resident households for income eligibility;

Any additional obligations relevant to the compliance with this Article; and

6.

Provision for the city to recoup costs for implementation and monitoring of the agreement(s).

B.

Recording of Agreement. Each Inclusionary Housing Agreement shall be recorded against owner-occupied affordable units and the residential projects containing rental affordable units. Additional rental or resale restrictions, deeds of trust, rights of first refusal and/or other documents acceptable to the city shall also be recorded against owner-occupied affordable units. In cases where the requirements of this Article are satisfied through the development of off-site affordable units, the Inclusionary Housing Agreement shall simultaneously be recorded against the property where the off-site units are to be developed.

C.

Time of Recordation. For residential projects for which a parcel or tentative map has been approved, the Inclusionary Housing Agreement shall be recorded concurrent with the recording of the final map for the residential project. For residential projects not subject to parcel or tentative maps, the Inclusionary Housing Agreement shall be recorded prior to the issuance of a building permit.

D.

Purchasers of Affordable Units. Each purchaser of an affordable unit in an ownership project, whether that purchaser bought the affordable unit from the developer or from a previous owner of the affordable unit, shall be required to execute an agreement in a form provided by the city which contains resale restrictions including, but not limited to, restrictions on who may purchase the affordable unit and restrictions on the maximum sales price permitted on resale. The resale restrictions may also allow the city a right of first refusal to purchase the affordable unit at the maximum price which could be charged to a purchaser household at the time the owner proposes sale. This agreement shall be recorded against the affordable unit as part of the closing documents for the sales transaction.

(Ord. No. 1576, § 2 (Exh. A, amd.), 10-23-2012)

19.24.100 - Affordable Housing Plan Application.

A.

Applications. Applications for residential projects subject to this Article shall include an Affordable Housing Plan. The Affordable Housing Plan shall include the following information in addition to information otherwise required under this Code. The city may require additional information deemed necessary to clarify that the proposed Residential Project and Affordable Housing Plan are consistent with the requirements of this Article.

Required Affordable Housing Plan Information:

1.

The location, structure, proposed occupancy (rental or ownership) and size of the proposed market rate and affordable units;

2.

The calculations used to determine the number of required affordable units;

3.

A floor plan or site plan depicting the location of the affordable units;

4.

The income level targets for each affordable unit;

5.

For phased developments, a phasing plan;

6.

A marketing plan stating how qualified households will be reviewed and selected to either purchase or rent affordable units; and

7.

Any other information requested by the Community Development Director to assist in the evaluation of the plan for compliance with the standards of this Article.

(Ord. No. 1576, § 2 (Exh. A, amd.), 10-23-2012)

19.24.110 - Adjustments, Waivers.

A.

Waiver. Notwithstanding any other provision in this Article, the requirements of this Article shall be waived, adjusted or reduced if the developer demonstrates that there is no reasonable relationship between the impact of a proposed residential project and the requirements of this Article, or that applying the requirements of this Article would take property in violation of the United States or California Constitutions. To receive an adjustment or waiver, the developer must include all relevant information in support of a waiver or adjustment at the time the developer submits the application for the residential project. The developer shall also present all arguments in support of a waiver or modification before the city body with review authority over the residential project.

(Ord. No. 1576, § 2 (Exh. A, amd.), 10-23-2012)

DIVISION 19.25 - DENSITY BONUS

19.25.010 - Purpose.

The purpose of this Division is to provide for density bonuses and incentives to developers who comply with California Government Code Sections 65915 through 65918 (State Density Bonus Law) and to provide a local density bonus for the production of senior citizen housing.

(Ord. No. 1587, § 6(Exh. F), 12-3-2013)

19.25.020 - Definitions.

Unless otherwise specified in this Division, the definitions found in State Density Bonus Law shall apply to the terms contained herein.

(Ord. No. 1587, § 6(Exh. F), 12-3-2013)

19.25.030 - Applicability.

This Division shall apply to all zoning districts that permit housing at a prescribed density by the General Plan Land Use Designation and/or zoning district. Where the density allowed under the zoning district is inconsistent with the density allowed under the General Plan Land Use Designation, the Land Use Designation density shall prevail.

(Ord. No. 1587, § 6(Exh. F), 12-3-2013)

19.25.040 - State Density Bonus and Incentives.

A developer of a housing development in the city may be permitted a density bonus and incentives in accordance with the provisions of California Government Code Sections 65915 through 65918 (State Density Bonus Law).

(Ord. No. 1587, § 6(Exh. F), 12-3-2013)

19.25.050 - Local Senior Density Bonus.

A.

The City shall grant a local Senior Density Bonus to 30 dwelling units per acre when an applicant for a Senior Citizen housing development, as defined in California Civil Code Section 51.3, seeks such Bonus and agrees to construct a housing development located in and compliant with the Affordable Housing Opportunity Overlay District pursuant to 19.16.070. The rounding method applicable to the local Senior Density Bonus shall be as set forth in Section 19.02.020(c)(1).

B.

If a developer of senior citizen housing pursuant to 19.25.050 (A) also seeks a state density bonus and any incentives pursuant to 19.25.040, the additional (bonus) units and any incentives allowed shall be calculated on the applicable base density as set forth in Section 19.16.070(F)(1). The rounding method for fractional units allowed pursuant to the State Density Bonus shall be as specified in State Density Bonus Law. See Table 1 for an example of the calculation for projects employing a maximum local senior density bonus and a State Density Bonus.

Table 1. Example Calculation for Local Senior Housing Density Bonus on parcels assigned AHO:

No. of "Base" Units
per 19.16.070(f)(1)
Afordability Local Senior
Bonus*
State Mandated
Density Bonus**
Total Possible Units
with Local Senior
and State Density
Bonus
23
(1 acre site)
20% afordable (5
units):
10% low income - 2
units
10% very low
income - 3 units
7 units
(23 + 7 = 30)
35% - 9 units
(35% x 23 = 9
where 8.05 is
rounded to 9)
39 units
(5 afordable;
34 market-rate)
--- --- --- --- ---
34
(1.5 acre site)
20% afordable (7
units)
10% low income - 3
units
10% very low
income - 4 units
11 units
(34 + 11 = 45)
35% - 12 units
(35% x 34 = 12
where 11.90
rounded up to
12)
57 units
(7 afordable
50 market
rate)
  • Local senior bonus increases maximum allowable base density to 30 du/acre.

**However, the State Density Bonus for senior housing is calculated on the "Base" project density, not including the local senior bonus.

(Ord. No. 1587, § 6(Exh. F), 12-3-2013)

19.25.060 - Application Requirements and Review.

A.

An application for a state density bonus, senior density bonus, incentive or concession, waiver or modification of a development standard, or a revised parking standard in accordance with section 19.25.040, shall be submitted with the first application for approval of a housing development and shall be processed concurrently with all other applications required for the housing development. The application shall be submitted on a form prescribed by the city and shall include, at a minimum, the following information:

1.

A site plan showing the total number and location of all proposed housing units and the number and location of proposed housing units which qualify the housing development for density bonus housing units.

2.

The manner in which the applicant shall satisfy the affordability requirements for the housing units which qualify the housing development for density bonus units.

3.

A description of any requested incentives and concessions, waivers or modification of development standards, or modified parking standards. For all incentives and concessions, except mixed use development, the application shall include evidence deemed sufficient by the city that the requested incentives and concessions result in identifiable, financially sufficient, and actual cost reductions. For waivers or modifications of development standards, the application shall include evidence deemed sufficient by the city that the waiver or

modification is necessary to make the housing units economically feasible and that the development standard from which a waiver or modification is requested will have the effect of precluding the construction of the housing development at the densities to which the applicant is entitled pursuant to this article and with the concessions and incentives permitted by this article.

4.

If a density bonus is requested for a land donation, the application shall show the location of the land to be dedicated and provide evidence that each of the conditions pursuant to Government Code Section 65915 (g)(2) (A through H) are met.

5.

If a density bonus or incentive or concession is requested for a child care facility pursuant to Government Code Section 65915 (h), the application shall show the location and square footage of the child care facility and provide evidence that the community lacks adequate child care facilities.

B.

Review and Consideration. An application for a density bonus, incentive or concession, waiver or modification of a development standard, or revised parking standard shall be considered and acted upon by the city body with review authority for the housing development.

C.

Approval. Before approving an application for a density bonus, incentive or concession, or waiver or modification of a development standard, the approval body shall make the following findings:

1.

If the density bonus is based all or in part on a donation of land, the conditions of Government Code Section 65915 (g)(2)(A through H) are met.

2.

If the density bonus, incentive or concession is based all or in part on the inclusion of a child care facility, that the conditions included in Government Code Section 65915 (h)(2)(A) and (B) are met.

3.

If the incentive or concession includes mixed use development, the finding included in Government Code Section 65915 (k)(2) are met.

4.

If a waiver or modification of a development standard is requested, the developer has demonstrated, for each requested waiver or modification, that the waiver or modification is necessary to make the housing units economically feasible and that the development standards from which a waiver or modification is requested will have the effect of precluding the construction of a housing development at the densities to which the applicant is entitled pursuant to this Division or with the concessions and incentives permitted by this Division.

D.

The approval body may deny a concession or incentive if it makes a written finding based upon substantial evidence of either of the following:

1.

The concession or incentive is not required to provide for affordable rents or affordable housing costs as required by this article.

2.

The concession or incentive would have a specific adverse impact upon public health or safety or the physical environment or on any real property listed in the California Register of Historical Resources, and there is no feasible method to satisfactorily mitigate or avoid the specific adverse impact without rendering the development unaffordable to lower, very low or moderate income households. For purposes of this subsection, "specific adverse impact" means a significant, quantifiable, direct and unavoidable impact, based on objective, identified, written public health or safety standards, policies, or conditions as they existed on the date that the application was deemed complete.

E.

The approval body may deny a waiver or modification of a development standard only if it makes a written finding based upon substantial evidence of either of the following:

1.

The waiver or modification would have a specific adverse impact upon health, safety or the physical environment and there is no feasible method to satisfactorily mitigate or avoid the specific adverse impact without rendering the housing development unaffordable to lower, very low or moderate income households. For purposes of this subsection, "specific adverse impact" means a significant, quantifiable, direct and unavoidable impact, based on objective, identified, written public health or safety standards, policies, or conditions as they existed on the date that the application was deemed complete.

2.

The waiver or modification would have an adverse impact on any real property listed in the California Register of Historical Resources.

F.

If a density bonus or concession or incentive is based on the provision of child care facilities, the approval body may deny the density bonus or concession or incentive if it finds, based on substantial evidence, that the City already has adequate child care facilities.

(Ord. No. 1587, § 6(Exh. F), 12-3-2013)

19.25.070 - Density Bonus Housing Agreement.

A.

Density Bonus Housing Agreement. An applicant requesting a density bonus shall agree to enter into an affordable housing agreement ("agreement") with the city in the city's standard form of agreement. Execution of the agreement shall be made a condition of approval for any discretionary planning permit for housing developments pursuant to this article and shall be recorded as a restriction on any parcels on which the housing units which qualify the housing development for a density bonus will be constructed.

B.

Recording of Agreement. The agreement shall be recorded prior to the final or parcel map approval, or, where the housing development does not include a map, prior to the issuance of a building permit.

C.

Contents of the Agreement. Each agreement shall include, but not be limited to, the following:

1.

A description of the residential development, including whether the housing units which qualify the housing development for a density bonus will be rented or owner-occupied;

2.

The number, size and location of the housing units which qualify the housing development for a density bonus;

3.

Provisions and/or documents for resale restrictions, deeds of trust, right of first refusal or rental restrictions;

4.

Provisions for monitoring the ongoing affordability of the housing units which qualify the housing development for a density bonus, and the process for qualifying prospective resident households for income eligibility; and

5.

Any additional obligations relevant to the compliance with this Division.

D.

Owner-Occupied Agreements. The purchaser of each owner-occupied housing unit which qualified the housing development for a density bonus shall execute the City's standard form agreement, to be recorded against the parcel, and which includes such provisions as the city may require to ensure continued compliance with this Division.

E.

Agreements for Child Care Facilities and Land Donations. Density bonus housing agreements for child care facilities and land dedications shall ensure continued compliance with all conditions included in Government Code Section 65915 (h)(2)(A) and (B) and Government Code Section 65915 (g)(2)(A through H), respectively.

(Ord. No. 1587, § 6(Exh. F), 12-3-2013)

DIVISION 19.26 - HILLSIDE AND RIDGELINE PROTECTION

19.26.010 - Purpose of Division.

The standards of this Division are intended to:

A.

Protect the City's scenic resources and distinctive environmental setting by preserving ridgelines and scenic vistas in their natural state, limiting development in hillside areas and encouraging retention of natural topographic features and vegetation;

B.

Reduce the potential for hazards and environmental degradation related to slope failure, increased erosion, sedimentation, storm water run-off, fire hazards, loss of vegetation, excessive grading, visual intrusion of structures, and potential for traffic hazards;

C.

Provide for compatibility of land uses, maintain privacy for property owners where feasible and preserve public views of hillsides, ridgelines, and natural vegetation;

D.

Provide for safe, convenient and structurally sound development in hillside areas and minimize risk from natural disasters;

E.

Minimize grading and encourage grading practices and design techniques that are appropriate in hillside areas;

F.

Provide for proper maintenance and fire management and minimize public expense for long-term maintenance of slope areas and public improvements in hillside areas.

(Ord. No. 1576, § 2 (Exh. A, amd.), 10-23-2012)

19.26.020 - Applicability.

The standards in this Division apply to subdivisions, uses, new structures, additions to existing structures including accessory structures and to all other development on parcels with an average slope of 10 percent or greater. See also Section 19.20.080 (Scenic Resource Protection), and General Plan Exhibit EN - Map 3 in Chapter IV: Environment.

(Ord. No. 1576, § 2 (Exh. A, amd.), 10-23-2012)

19.26.030 - Permit Process and Application Requirements.

Design Review approval shall be required for all development subject to the provisions of this Division, except for new accessory structures, additions to existing residential structures which are less than ten percent of the

square footage of the structure to be expanded, retaining walls or other improvements that are determined by the director to be visually insignificant. See also Section 19.42.030 (Design Review). The Design Review application and review process for all hillside development shall include the following procedures and application submittal requirements:

A.

As part of the design review process, a Design Review Commission workshop shall be held as described by the procedure in Section 19.42.030 (D)(1) for all hillside development projects. However, applications for individual Single-family homes, minor additions and accessory structures may be exempted from the workshop requirement as determined by the director.

B.

When a hillside development project requires multiple land use permit and/or subdivision applications, all such applications shall be filed, processed, reviewed and considered for action concurrently.

C.

All Design Review applications for hillside development shall be accompanied by information and materials required by Section 19.40.040 (Application Preparation and Filing), and all additional materials required by the application contents handout provided by the department for hillside development as updated.

D.

A constraint analysis shall be prepared and submitted with a Design Review application for undeveloped hillside sites in compliance with Section 19.40.040 B (Constraints Analysis). The extent of information included in the constraint analysis shall be based on and limited to the known constraints of the site. For example, the constraint analysis need not include special studies and surveys assessing riparian conditions, if such conditions are clearly not present on the site. Regardless, the analysis shall be accompanied by a geotechnical report, which identifies and proposes mitigation measures for any soils or geological conditions that may affect site stability or structural integrity.

E.

Three-dimensional building elevations and scaled cross-sections shall be prepared and submitted to demonstrate building planes, heights and massing.

F.

A photo montage, computer-generated visual simulations and/or a site model may be required when the director determines that such information is necessary to demonstrate topographic relationships, building mass and scale, site grading, visual impacts or project relationship with the adjacent neighborhood.

G.

The installation of story poles is required to demonstrate the location, footprint, massing and height of proposed hillside buildings. The installation of stakes and flags may also be required to demonstrate the location of proposed access roads, driveways and retaining walls. Story poles shall be erected in accordance

with the City of Novato Placement of Story Poles Policy and Procedures, which are available at the Community Development Department.

(Ord. No. 1576, § 2 (Exh. A, amd.), 10-23-2012)

19.26.040 - Hillside Development Design Criteria.

Hillside development shall comply with the following design criteria, as deemed applicable by the review authority:

A.

Terrain Alteration. The project should be designed to fit the terrain rather than altering the terrain to fit the project. Development patterns that require excessive cuts or fill, form visually protruding horizontal bands or steeply cut slopes for roads or lots shall be avoided.

B.

Structure Siting and Design. Site design shall utilize varying setbacks, structure heights, split-level foundations, and low retaining walls and terraces to blend structures into the terrain. Front building setbacks shall be varied and staggered consistent with natural hillside character.

C.

Location of Structures. Structures should be located in the most accessible, least visually prominent, and most geologically stable portion or portions of the site. When feasible, place structures so that they will be screened by existing vegetation, rock outcroppings, or depressions in topography. Buildings and improvements should be located to save trees and minimize visual impacts. Additional native plant materials should be added to augment the screening qualities of existing vegetation, where appropriate.

D.

Retaining Walls. Tall and/or long retaining walls shall be avoided. Retaining walls shall be divided into terraces to reduce the individual heights of walls where practicable, with landscaping to screen them from view. Generally, no retaining wall should be higher than 8 feet. See Figure 3-10.

E.

Exterior Lighting. Hillside development shall not create an array of bright lights. Lighting shall be properly designed to eliminate direct and off-site glare and the spill of light to surrounding areas. Site and building designs shall incorporate low-intensity exterior lighting. The use of low ground-level fixtures is encouraged, as opposed to the use of fewer, but taller fixtures.

F.

Colors and Materials. A harmonious mixture of materials, and colors, should be used to blend structures and site improvements with the natural hillside as follows:

1.

Colors that emulate native vegetation and soils shall be used for exterior elevations and roofs. Darker, flat tones, such as, browns, black, greens and terra cotta shall be used for exterior siding and roofs in high-visibility areas. Light or bright colors shall be avoided; and

2.

Surface materials and roofs should include a mix of rough textures to blend with the coarseness of landscaping and natural vegetation in hillside areas. Materials including but not limited to stucco, wood, brick, and coarse block are appropriate materials to use.

G.

Architectural Design. Structures shall be designed as follows:

1.

Buildings and improvements shall be scaled to complement the hillsides and to avoid excessively massive forms that dominate views of the hills.

2.

Residential development on infill hillside lots shall be of a scale that is compatible with the existing adjacent neighborhood, and shall be designed to locate windows, balconies, and outdoor living areas with consideration for the privacy of adjacent dwellings and yards, to the maximum extent feasible.

3.

Building facades shall have varying vertical planes and overhangs shall be used as a means to create changing shadow lines to reduce the visual mass of forms. Building architectural elevations shall be stepped to follow the natural contour of the slope and to minimize building heights. See Section 19.26.050.J for building step back requirements.

4.

Wall surfaces visible from off-site on properties located within an area of Scenic Resource, Section 19.20.080, as designated by the General Plan, shall be minimized in scale through such design features as: the use of single story elements, setbacks, roof pitches, and landscaping.

5.

Roof pitches shall generally be designed to follow the angle of the site slope; but variation may be provided to avoid a monotonous appearance. See Figure 3-9.

6.

Structures with visible structural underpinnings that extend more than six feet above grade shall be avoided. Integrate structural underpinnings for decks, additions or foundation structures that exceed six feet in height into the design aesthetic of the building.

(Ord. No. 1576, § 2 (Exh. A, amd.), 10-23-2012)

19.26.050 - Hillside Project Development Standards.

A.

Residential Density. When creating new residential lots or when a single family property is being developed with more than one dwelling unit, residential densities shall be reduced in compliance with Table 3-6. No development potential shall be allowed for areas with average slopes of greater than 25 percent. Each site to be developed shall be mapped to depict the average slope areas, based on the ranges in Table 3-6. The average slope shall be calculated using the contour measurement method as defined in Article 6 (Definitions - Average Slope) of this chapter. The maximum residential density allowed under the General Plan land use designation is then multiplied by the reduction factor defined for each slope area to determine the maximum allowable density for each area. The maximum number of units allowed is then determined by calculating, the combined sum of the area of each slope category, which have been multiplied by the corresponding reduction factor. Resulting fractional unit numbers shall be rounded down to the nearest whole number. Areas with different General Plan designations or zoning districts must be analyzed as separate site areas to determine the total allowable units. (This section does not apply to the development of one single family dwelling unit or an accessory dwelling unit on an existing, legal lot.)

Table 3-6

Allowable Residential Density

and Building Intensity Floor Area Ratio (FAR) Based on Site Slope

General Plan Land Use Average Slope Range Percent Reduction in Reduction Factor Designation Allowable Units or

FAR/Sq. Ft.
RVL 0% to 10% None None
10% to 25% None None
Greater than 25% 100% 0.0
R1, R4, R5, R10, R20 0% to 10% None None
10% to 25% 60% 0.4
Greater than 25% 100% 0.0
BPO, CN, CF, CI, LIO,
MU
0% to 10% None None
10% to 20% 20% 0.8
Greater than 20% 100% 0.0

B.

Clustered Residential Development. Clustered residential development is required, where appropriate and to the extent feasible, as a means of preserving the natural appearance of hillside areas. Under this concept, dwelling units would be grouped in the more level portions of the site, while steeper areas would be preserved in a natural state.

C.

[Non-Residential Development.] For purposes of this chapter, non-residential development shall include development consisting of residential and non-residential uses where the gross square footage area of the non-residential development exceeds that of the residential development.

D.

Non-Residential Building Intensity. The maximum floor area of nonresidential development shall be reduced for slope areas in compliance with Table 3-6. A building intensity reduction factor of 0.8 shall be applied to that portion of a site with an average slope of 10 to 20 percent. No development potential shall be allowed for slopes greater than 20 percent.

E.

Subfloor Parking for Non-Residential Buildings. The maximum allowable floor area of non-residential development may be increased up to a maximum of 20 percent when at least 25 percent of the required parking spaces are provided below grade, or subfloor and/or incorporated into the design of the building. The 20 percent increase in allowable floor area shall be applied to the total floor area calculated after the maximum allowable floor area ratios for the applicable zoning district and building intensity reduction factors in Subsection D of this section are applied to the site areas. In no case shall a project that receives a bonus, exceed the FAR otherwise permitted pursuant to the General Plan Land Use designation.

F.

Street and Driveway Layout. Streets and driveways shall follow the natural contours of the terrain to reduce grading, where feasible. The following street and driveway designs may be considered subject to the approval of the City Engineer and the Novato Fire Protection District:

1.

Cul-de-sacs, split roads and loop roads, where appropriate to fit the natural topography.

2.

Narrower street sections similar to those defined in the Novato Municipal Code Chapter V (Development Standards) Rural Street Standards, where appropriate to minimize grading, tree removal and visual impacts.

G.

Lot Configuration. The creation of new lots or the relocation of lot lines shall comply with the following standards:

1.

Lots shall not be created which are impractical for improvement, due to steepness of terrain, geologic hazards, or location of watercourses or drainage.

2.

Lot layout shall be designed to avoid grading or building within 25-vertical feet of the top 5-foot contour of a ridgeline or knoll.

3.

Lots shall not be created with building envelopes which would allow structures to project within 25-feet of the top 5-foot contour of a ridgeline or knoll.

4.

Lots shall not be created where the average slope within the building envelopes would exceed 25 percent for residential sites and 20 percent for non-residential sites.

5.

Lot configurations shall be designed to minimize grading and preserve topographic and geologic features.

6.

Lot configurations shall take into account natural landforms and vegetation to the greatest extent possible.

7.

Lots shall be designed to avoid lot-to-lot drainage. Individual lots shall include the top of slope areas to the extent practicable to help reduce lot-to-lot drainage and facilitate any future slope maintenance.

H.

Placement of Structures. Structures shall not be placed on average slopes exceeding 25 percent for residential development and 20 percent for non-residential development, to the extent feasible. Encroachment of building envelopes on slopes exceeding these percentages may be permitted by the review authority only where any of the following findings can be made:

1.

It is substantially unfeasible to locate the proposed building inside the maximum percent slope area; or

2.

Where such location would have a substantially more adverse effect on the environment; or

3.

Where such location is deemed appropriate to facilitate clustered development; or

4.

Measures are included that provide adequate mitigation of environmental impacts such as visual, biological and geotechnical impacts.

I.

Single-Family Residential Building Size Limits. A limitation on home size is required in hillside areas to ensure that the home is compatible with the hillside conditions and the scale of development in the community. Residential building sizes for new homes and additions to existing homes shall be limited by floor area ratio, utilizing a sliding-scale that is based on the average slope of the lot and the lot size. As the average slope of a lot increases by one percent, the allowable floor area ratio is decreased by one percent. The floor area ratio limits are presented in Tables 3-6.1 and 3-6.2. This resulting allowable floor area ratio represents a maximum limit subject to the following conditions and allowances:

1.

The maximum residential building size shall be limited to 4,000 square feet, regardless of the maximum permitted floor area ratio.

2.

A minimum single family residential building size of 2,000 square feet may be permitted, if deemed appropriate by the Review Authority.

3.

The allowable floor area ratio does not include a 500 square foot allowance for garage and accessory structures. The combined square footage of the garage and/or accessory structures area proposed in excess of 500 square feet shall be counted against the maximum allowed floor area ratio.

4.

The square footage of an accessory dwelling unit shall be counted against the maximum floor area ratio applicable to the primary residence and any accessory structures.

5.

The floor area ratio limits presented in Table 3-6.1 apply to existing lots (existing prior to the enactment of this ordinance) with average slopes in excess of 25 percent. New residential lots created after the enactment of this ordinance (Ordinance No. 1480, enacted 1/13/04) are not permitted in areas where the average slope is in excess of 25 percent.

6.

The Review Authority may consider a single family residential building size in excess of the limit established by Tables 3-6.1 and 3-6.2 if any of the following apply:

a.

The subject property contains unique conditions, which permit the building to be secluded and have minimal visibility (upon completion) from off-site public or private property.

b.

It is determined that the proposed design of the residential building is exemplary or unique in innovative architectural design.

Table 3-6.1

Single-Family Residential Building Size Limits for Existing Lots Recorded on or Prior to Enactment of Ordinance No. 1480, Dated 1/13/04

Average Slope of Lot Maximum Allowable Floor Area Ratio
10% 40%
11% 39%
12% 38%
13% 37%
14% 36%
15% 35%
16% 34%
17% 33%
18% 32%
19% 31%
20% 30%
21% 29%
22% 28%
23% 27%
24% 26%
25% 25%
--- ---
26% 24%
27% 23%
28% 22%
29% 21%
30% 20%
31% 19%
32% 18%
33% 17%
34% 16%
35% 15%
36% 14%
37% 13%
38% 12%
39% 11%
40% + 10%

Table 3-6.2

Single-Family Residential Building Size Limits for New Lots Recorded After Enactment of Ordinance No. 1480, Dated 1/13/04

Average Slope of Lot Maximum Allowable Floor Area Ratio
10% 40%
11% 39%
12% 38%
13% 37%
14% 36%
15% 35%
16% 34%
17% 33%
18% 32%
19% 31%
20% 30%
21% 29%
--- ---
22% 28%
23% 27%
24% 26%
25% 25%

J.

Siting and Height Limitations. Structures that are placed adjacent to ridgelines or knolls shall comply with the following provisions in addition to those required by Article 2 (Zoning Districts, Allowable Land Uses, and ZoneSpecific Standards), and Section 19.20.070 (Height Limits and Exceptions):

1.

Siting Restrictions. Structures shall not be placed so that they are silhouetted against the sky when viewed from a public street, except where the review authority determines that the only feasible building site on an existing lot cannot comply with this standard. See Figure 3-11.

2.

Placement Below Ridgeline Required. Structures shall be located so that a vertical separation of at least 25 feet is provided between the top of the structure and the top five-foot contour of the ridge or knoll to maintain the natural appearance of the ridge. See Figure 3-12. Where the review authority determines that a parcel contains no feasible building site other than where a structure will extend above the ridgeline, proposed structures shall not exceed a height of 16 feet above the highest point on the ridgeline or hilltop within 100 feet of the proposed structure.

3.

Height Measurement. The maximum allowable building height shall be measured in compliance with Section 19.20.070 (Height Limits and Exceptions), with the exception that either the existing pre-developed grade, or the finished grade, whichever has the lower elevation, shall be utilized.

4.

Building Height Limit. The maximum allowable building height shall be 25 feet for residential buildings and 35 feet for non-residential buildings. For residential buildings, the following additional height limits which are intended to reduce building mass are required:

a.

The height of a residential building measured from the lowest grade along any perimeter building elevation to the peak of the highest roof element shall not exceed 35 feet. See Figure 3-12.1.

b.

Building step backs shall be required along the down slope elevation to reduce bulk and mass, and to avoid tall walls in one vertical plane. The height of the tallest vertical plane along down slope building elevations shall not exceed 20 feet measured from grade. Walls extending above this 20-foot limit, shall be stepped back a minimum of 10 feet. See Figure 3-12.2.

Height of Lowest Floor—Cripple Wall Height Limit. The vertical distance between either the natural or finished grade, whichever is lower, and the lowest finished floor elevation of a structure shall not exceed 10 feet.

K.

Setbacks Between Structures and Toes/Tops of Slopes. On adjacent lots having a difference in vertical elevation of three feet or more, the required side yard shall be measured from the nearest toe or top of slope to the structure, whichever is closer.

L.

Fire Safety. Projects shall comply with the fire safety requirements of Chapter V, (Development Standards), Section 5-21 (Fire Safety) of this code.

M.

Grading. Grading plans shall be prepared in compliance with Chapter V (Development Standards), Section 5- 23 (Grading) of this code.

(Ord. No. 1576, § 2 (Exh. A, amd.), 10-23-2012; Ord. No. 1676, Exh. A, 3-8-2022)

19.26.060 - Supplemental Design Review Findings Required for Hillside Development.

Design Review for hillside development may be approved by the review authority only when the required findings have been made. Design Review for hillside development shall be subject to the findings required under Section 19.42.030.F (Design Review) of this code, and the following supplemental hillside development findings:

A.

The design, scale, massing, height and siting of development is compatible with the character and scale of the surrounding, developed neighborhood.

B.

The design and site layout of the hillside project is respective of and protects the natural environment to the maximum extent feasible.

C.

Site grading has been designed to be as minimal as possible to achieve sensitive hillside design, minimize tree removal, and provide safe site access and required parking.

D.

The hillside project is designed and sited to screen development, to the extent feasible, through clustering and/or avoiding of highly visible hillsides, ridgelines, and knolls.

(Ord. No. 1576, § 2 (Exh. A, amd.), 10-23-2012)

DIVISION 19.27 - RESIDENTIAL OBJECTIVE ARCHITECTURE STANDARDS

19.27.010 - Purpose.

The purpose of this Division is to specify objective architecture standards for residential and residential mixeduse development projects to achieve the following:

A.

Promote high-quality architectural design to strengthen the aesthetic character and ambiance of Novato;

B.

Ensure the orderly and harmonious appearance of new residential and residential mixed-use development within the community;

C.

Ensure the architectural design of new residential and residential mixed-use development is authentic to the specific architectural style being expressed;

D.

Provide clear and effective architectural standards to assist project developers and architects in designing new residential and residential mixed-use developments; and

E.

Streamline the review of proposed residential development and residential mixed-use development projects as required by State law.

(Ord. No. 1705, § 4(Exh. A), 10-10-2023)

19.27.020 - Applicability.

This Division shall apply to all proposed residential and residential mixed-use development projects that, pursuant to State law, are subject to regulation by objective design standards only.

(Ord. No. 1705, § 4(Exh. A), 10-10-2023)

19.27.030 - Implementation of Architecture Standards.

A.

Residential and residential mixed-use buildings shall be designed in compliance with the architecture standards of this Division.

B.

Detached single-family, two-family dwellings, and multifamily residential developments shall be designed in the Contemporary, Craftsman, Mediterranean, Tudor, and/or Victorian architectural styles subject to the requirements of this Division.

C.

Residential mixed-use developments shall be designed in the Contemporary, Craftsman, Main Street Classical, Mediterranean, Tudor, or Victorian architectural styles subject to the requirements of this Division.

D.

Architectural Variation.

1.

Detached Single-Family Dwellings. Any of the architectural styles allowed for detached single-family residences, as listed in Subsection 19.27.030 B., shall be used or mixed in a detached single-family residential development subject to the following:

a.

A detached single-family residential development comprised of two dwellings shall be designed to provide a different architecture style for each building or provide a minimum of two different façade designs based on a single architectural style using different combinations of the architectural elements allowed for that style to differentiate each building.

b.

A detached single-family residential development comprised of three or more dwellings shall be designed with a mix of architectural styles or provide a minimum of three different facade designs for each architectural style proposed to repeat in the development by using differing combinations of the architectural elements allowed for that style to differentiate each building. Dwelling units of the same architectural style or facade design shall not be placed on:

i.

Adjoining parcels sharing a common side property line; or

ii.

Parcels within 60-feet across from one another, measured from the mid-point of the front yard property line of a given parcel to the mid-point of the front yard property line of any other parcel.

2.

Two-Family Dwellings. Any of the architectural styles allowed for two-family dwellings, as listed in Subsection 19.27.030 B., shall be used or mixed in a two-family dwelling development subject to the following:

a.

A two-family dwelling development project consisting of a single building shall be designed in one of the allowed architectural styles.

b.

A two-family dwelling development project of two buildings shall be designed so that each two-dwelling building has a differing architectural style or provides a minimum of two different facade designs based on a

single architectural style using different combinations of the architectural elements allowed for that style to differentiate each building.

c.

A two-family dwelling development project of three or more buildings shall be designed with a mix of architectural styles or provide a minimum of three different façade designs for each architectural style proposed to repeat in the development using different combinations of the architectural elements allowed for that style to differentiate each building. Dwellings of the same architectural style or facade design shall not be placed on:

i.

Adjoining parcels sharing a common side property line; or

ii.

Parcels within 60-feet across from one another, measured from the mid-point of the front yard property line of a given parcel to the mid-point of the front yard property line of any other parcel.

3.

Multi-Family Dwellings. Multi-family dwelling residential developments shall be designed in one of the allowed architectural styles listed in Subsection 19.27.030 B.

4.

Residential Mixed-Use Developments. Residential mixed-use developments shall be designed in one of the allowed architectural styles listed in Subsection 19.27.030 C.

E.

Ground Floor Residential Entryways—Residential Mixed-Use Developments. Upper floor multi-family dwellings in a residential mixed-use development shall be accessed by a ground level, common entry along the primary building street frontage or secondary building street frontage for buildings with multiple street frontages. Residential entries shall be distinguished from commercial storefronts pursuant to the following standards:

1.

Minimum entryway height of 12-feet measured from the landing in front of the entry door to the underside of the ceiling or any projecting element (e.g., awning) defining the entryway, whichever is lower.

2.

Minimum entryway width of eight-feet measured from the building walls or pilaster on either side of the entry, whichever is closer.

3.

Entryways shall be inset from the primary building facade by a minimum depth of three-feet, measured from the face of the façade to the entry door.

4.

Entryways shall be distinguished from commercial storefronts by varying the pattern or orientation of the finish materials selected for a given storefront(s) or through the application of wall cladding matching the cladding applied elsewhere on the building.

F.

Storefronts—Residential Mixed-Use Developments. Ground-level storefronts shall be distinguished from the upper floors of a building by:

1.

Incorporating a horizontal plane break through molding, tablature, cornice, or a string/belt course of a minimum of six-inches in depth between the first floor and second floor; and/or

2.

Applying a wall cladding at the first floor that is different from the cladding applied to the upper floor(s). A change in wall cladding shall occur at a horizontal massing transition point or trim element dividing the first floor from the second floor of a building.

G.

Architectural Detail—Detached Single-Family and Two-Family Dwellings. Detached single-family and twofamily dwellings shall be designed to:

1.

Apply the wall, base, roof, eave, rake, parapet, window, and dormer standards applicable to the selected architectural style(s) to all facades of a dwelling;

2.

Provide a porch at the primary entry to a dwelling. A primary entry is a doorway accessed by a walkway connecting through a front yard area to a public or private sidewalk or street. A developer may choose to provide an additional porch(es) on another façade(s) of a dwelling. All porches shall comply with the porch standards applicable to the selected architectural style(s); and

3.

Provide, at a minimum, one balcony or bay window on the front facade and each side and/or rear façade(s) of a dwelling on a parcel with side and/or rear property lines adjoining a private or public street. A developer may choose to provide an additional balcony(ies) and/or bay window(s) on other facades. All balconies and bay windows shall comply with the standards applicable to balconies and bay windows for the selected architectural style(s).

H.

Architectural Detail—Multi-Family Dwellings and Residential Mixed-Use Developments. The architectural elements required for a selected architectural style shall be applied to all sides of a multi-family or residential

mixed-use building, including front, street side, interior side, and rear facades.

I.

Substitution of Architecture and Adjustment of Standards. A developer may voluntarily agree in writing to substitute a different architectural style(s) and/or seek an adjustment of the architectural standards of this Division. The agreement shall: (1) be on a form provided by the City, (2) specify the standard(s) to be substituted or adjusted, and (3) require Design Review pursuant to the procedures of Section 19.42.030. By entering into such an agreement, a developer thereby forfeits any right to streamlined review, ministerial action, and/or any limitations on the application of subjective standards that may otherwise apply to a given project under State law.

J.

Architectural Standards Guide. The following graphic provides a guide to using the architectural standards of this Division.

(Ord. No. 1705, § 4(Exh. A), 10-10-2023)

19.27.040 - Architectural Styles Overview.

Table A (Architectural Styles Overview) provides an overview of allowed architectural styles.

(Ord. No. 1705, § 4(Exh. A), 10-10-2023) 19.27.050 - Contemporary Standards.

General note: The images above and the descriptions in Subsections 1 and 2 below are intended to provide a brief overview of the architectural style and are descriptive, not regulatory.

Contemporary Style Standards

Single-Family and Multifamily Buildings

Note: The image below is intended to provide a reference for architectural elements and is illustrative, not regulatory. It is not an exhaustive list of applicable standards.

Contemporary Style Standards — Mixed-Use Buildings

Note: The image below is intended to provide a reference for architectural elements and is illustrative, not regulatory. It is not an exhaustive list of applicable standards.

(Ord. No. 1705, § 4(Exh. A), 10-10-2023) 19.27.060 - Craftsman Standards.

General note: The images above and the descriptions in Subsections 1 and 2 below are intended to provide a brief overview of the architectural style and are descriptive, not regulatory.

Craftsman Style Standards

Single-Family and Multifamily Buildings

Note: The image below is intended to provide a reference for architectural elements and is illustrative, not regulatory. It is not an exhaustive list of applicable standards.

Prototypical Building Elevation

Craftsman Style Standards — Mixed-Use Buildings

Note: The image below is intended to provide a reference for architectural elements and is illustrative, not regulatory. It is not an exhaustive list of applicable standards.

Parapet Elevation

(Ord. No. 1705, § 4(Exh. A), 10-10-2023)

19.27.070 - Main Street Classical Standards.

General note: The images above and the descriptions in Subsections 1 and 2 below are intended to provide a brief overview of the architectural style and are descriptive, not regulatory.

Main Street Classical Style Standards — Mixed-Use Buildings

Note: The image below is intended to provide a reference for architectural elements and is illustrative, not regulatory. It is not an exhaustive list of applicable standards.

(Ord. No. 1705, § 4(Exh. A), 10-10-2023) 19.27.080 - Mediterranean Standards.

General note: The images above and the descriptions in Subsections 1 and 2 below are intended to provide a brief overview of the architectural style and are descriptive, not regulatory.

Mediterranean Style Standards

Single-Family and Multifamily Buildings

Note: The image below is intended to provide a reference for architectural elements and is illustrative, not regulatory. It is not an exhaustive list of applicable standards.

Mediterranean Style Standards — Mixed-Use Building

Note: The image below is intended to provide a reference for architectural elements and is illustrative, not regulatory. It is not an exhaustive list of applicable standards.

(Ord. No. 1705, § 4(Exh. A), 10-10-2023)

19.27.090 - Tudor Standards.

General note: The images above and the descriptions in Subsections 1 and 2 below are intended to provide a brief overview of the architectural style and are descriptive, not regulatory.

Elements of Tudor Style — Single-Family and Multifamily Buildings

Note: The image below is intended to provide a reference for architectural elements and is illustrative, not regulatory. It is not an exhaustive list of applicable standards.

Tudor Style Standards — Mixed-Use Buildings

Note: The image below is intended to provide a reference for architectural elements and is illustrative, not regulatory. It is not an exhaustive list of applicable standards.

(Ord. No. 1705, § 4(Exh. A), 10-10-2023)

19.27.100 - Victorian Standards.

General note: The images above and the descriptions in Subsections 1 and 2 below are intended to provide a brief overview of the architectural style and are descriptive, not regulatory.

Victorian Style Standards — Single-Family and Multifamily Buildings

Note: The image below is intended to provide a reference for architectural elements and is illustrative, not regulatory. It is not an exhaustive list of applicable standards.

Victorian Style Standards — Mixed-Use Buildings

Note: The image below is intended to provide a reference for architectural elements and is illustrative, not regulatory. It is not an exhaustive list of applicable standards.

(Ord. No. 1705, § 4(Exh. A), 10-10-2023)

DIVISION 19.28 - LANDSCAPING

19.28.010 - Purpose of Division.

This Division establishes landscape standards to mitigate the effects of urbanization on the environment and to provide for an aesthetically pleasing urban setting with sufficient outdoor use areas. It is the intent of this Division to establish a measure of consistency in landscaping for new projects as well as providing a mechanism to require updating and upgrading of existing landscaping and outdoor use areas in existing developments when improvements are proposed. It is also the intent of this Division to encourage optimum use of drought-tolerant plant materials in conjunction with water-conserving automatic irrigation systems.

(Ord. No. 1576, § 2 (Exh. A, amd.), 10-23-2012)

19.28.020 - Applicability.

The provisions of this Division apply to all land uses as follows:

A.

New Projects. New nonresidential projects, multi-family residential projects, and single-family residential subdivisions shall provide landscaping in compliance with the requirements of this Division.

B.

Existing Development. The approval of a land Use Permit for physical alterations and/or changes in use within an existing development may include conditions of approval requiring compliance with specific landscaping and irrigation requirements of this Division. When landscaping is required, the landscape and irrigation improvements shall be installed prior to final building inspection.

C.

Alternatives to Requirements. The Review Authority may approve modifications to the standards of this Division to accommodate alternatives to required landscape materials or methods, where the Review Authority first determines that the proposed alternative will be equally effective in achieving the intent of this Division.

(Ord. No. 1576, § 2 (Exh. A, amd.), 10-23-2012)

19.28.030 - Landscape Area Requirements.

A.

General Requirements. Landscaping shall be provided as follows:

1.

Setbacks. The setback, outdoor use and open space areas required by this Zoning Ordinance, and easements for utilities and drainage courses shall be landscaped, except where:

a.

Occupied by allowed structures or paving;

b.

A required setback is screened from public view; or

c.

It is determined by the Director that landscaping is not necessary to fulfill the purposes of this Division.

2.

Unused Areas. All areas of a project site not intended for a specific use, including pad sites in shopping centers intended for future development, shall be landscaped unless the Director determines that landscaping is not necessary to fulfill the purposes of this Division.

3.

Parking Areas. Parking areas shall be landscaped in compliance with Division 19.30 (Parking and Loading).

B.

Measurement of Required Landscape Areas. Wherever this Zoning Ordinance requires landscaping areas of a specified width, the width shall be exclusive of curbs or walls.

C.

Required Outdoor Use Areas. Non-residential uses shall provide outdoor use areas for passive outdoor recreation (i.e., picnicking, hiking, biking, etc.) or may contribute to the provision of such public facilities, where such uses are planned or proposed within 2,500 feet of the project.

(Ord. No. 1576, § 2 (Exh. A, amd.), 10-23-2012)

19.28.040 - Landscape Standards.

A.

General Requirements.

1.

Minimum Dimensions. Landscaped areas shall have a minimum interior width of three feet. Landscaped areas containing trees shall have a minimum interior width of four feet.

2.

Height Limits. Proposed landscape materials shall be designed to:

a.

Comply with the height limits for landscaping within sight distance visibility areas established by Section 19.20.070.D (Height Limits and Exceptions—Sight Visibility Area Required); and

b.

Not interfere with the proper operation of solar collector devices on adjacent parcels.

3.

Protective Curbing. Required landscaping on sites within the R10, R20, and non-residential zoning districts shall be protected with a minimum six-inch high concrete curb, except adjacent to bicycle paths or where deemed unnecessary the Director.

4.

Irrigation System Required. All landscaped areas (except areas to be maintained with intentionally unirrigated native plants) shall be provided with an automatic irrigation system.

5.

Safety Requirements. Landscape materials shall be located so that at maturity they do not:

a.

Interfere with safe sight distances for vehicular, bicycle, or pedestrian traffic;

b.

Conflict with overhead utility lines, overhead lights, or walkway lights; or

c.

Block pedestrian or bicycle ways.

B.

Landscape Plans.

1.

Each application for approval of a project subject to this Division shall include plans and written material showing how the landscaping requirements are to be met.

2.

The degree of specificity of landscape plans and written material shall relate to the type of permit or request for approval being sought. Landscape plans shall include the information and materials listed on the Department handout for landscape and irrigation plans.

3.

Landscape plans shall be prepared by a landscape architect or other person qualified by education and experience to prepare landscape plans.

4.

Changes to approved landscaping or irrigation plans shall not be made without prior written approval of the Director.

5.

The construction/installation of landscape and irrigation improvements shall be accomplished in compliance with the approved plans as a prerequisite to any final approval/clearance of the use or development to which it relates.

C.

Planting Material. Where landscape is required, it shall include trees, shrubs, and ground covers, as follows:

1.

General Requirements.

a.

Plant materials shall be selected for: energy efficiency and drought tolerance; adaptability and relationship to Novato environment; color, form, and pattern; ability to provide shade; soil retention, fire resistiveness, etc.

Overall landscape plan shall be integrated with all elements of the project (e.g., buildings, parking lots, and streets) to achieve desirable microclimate and minimize energy demand.

b.

Plant materials shall be sized and spaced to achieve immediate effect and shall not be less than a 15-gallon container for trees, five-gallon container for specimen shrubs and a one-gallon for mass planting, unless otherwise approved by the Review Authority on the basis that the alternate size will achieve the desired immediate effect equally well.

2.

Trees. Tree planting shall comply with the following standards. Existing trees shall be retained and preserved in compliance with Municipal Code Chapter XVII, Shrubs and Trees, and Zoning Code section 19.39.040 (Woodland and Tree Preservation).

a.

Trees shall not be planted under any eave, overhang, balcony, light standard or other structure that may interfere with normal growth.

b.

Trees in landscape planters less than 10 feet in width or located closer than five feet from a permanent structure shall be provided with root barriers.

c.

Trees shall be staked in compliance with standards provided by the Department.

d.

Number of trees:

(1)

Parking area: refer to 19.30 (Parking and Loading).

(2)

Street setbacks: one per 200 square feet of landscaped area.

(3)

Balance of site: one per 600 square feet of landscaped area.

(4)

Street trees: one per 40-foot length of right-of-way. The Director may modify this requirement depending on spread of tree at maturity.

Groundcover and Shrubs.

a.

The majority of areas required to be landscaped shall be covered with groundcover, shrubs, turf, or other types of plants that are predominantly drought tolerant.

b.

A minimum of two, five-gallon size shrubs shall be provided for every 6 feet of distance along street setbacks.

c.

Groundcover shall be provided throughout the landscaped area and shall be planted at least 6 inches on center.

d.

Artificial groundcover or shrubs shall not be allowed.

e.

Crushed rock, redwood chips, pebbles, stone, and similar materials shall be allowed up to 15 percent of the total required landscape area. Artificial or synthetic ground covers are not allowed.

f.

Nonturf areas (e.g., shrub beds) shall be top dressed with a bark chip mulch or approved alternative.

D.

Landscape Design.

1.

Plant Selection and Grouping.

a.

Plants having similar water use shall be grouped together in distinct hydrozones.

b.

Plants shall be selected appropriately based upon their adaptability to the climatic, geological, and topographical conditions of the site. Protection and preservation of native species and natural areas is encouraged.

c.

Fire prevention shall be addressed on sites in areas identified by the Safety Element of the General Plan as being fire prone by providing fire-resistant landscaping buffers between development areas and naturally vegetated areas, as identified by the Director.

2.

Water Features. Decorative water features (e.g., fountains, ponds, waterfalls) shall have recirculating water systems.

E.

Irrigation Design.

1.

Control System. All landscaped areas shall be provided with an approved irrigation system that shall include an automatic master control with multi-calendar, timer, and multi-station capabilities.

2.

Runoff and Overspray. Soil types and infiltration rate shall be considered when designing irrigation systems. All irrigation systems shall be designed to avoid runoff, low head drainage, overspray or other similar conditions where water flows onto adjacent property, nonirrigated areas, walks, roadways or structures. Proper irrigation equipment and schedules, including repeat cycles, shall be used to closely match application rates to infiltration rates to minimize runoff.

Special attention shall be given to avoid runoff on slopes and to avoid overspray in planting areas in median strips.

F.

Hydroseeding.

1.

Plans Required. When planting is to be utilized for permanent landscape treatment or for natural area restoration, plans indicating location and type of hydroseeding shall be submitted in compliance with the Department handout on hydroseeding.

2.

Separation Requirements. Hydroseeded or other "natural" areas shall be separated from structures and other built improvements by an area of more formal landscaping at least five feet in width.

G.

Water-Efficient Landscape Criteria. Landscape and irrigation plans shall comply with the requirements and guidelines of the North Marin Water District for water efficient landscape.

H.

Landscape Completion Certification Required. Evidence of the completion of required landscaping and irrigation improvements shall be supplied to the Department by the author of the landscape and irrigation plan. Evidence shall be on a "Landscape Certification" form available at the Department and shall be submitted as a prerequisite to final building inspection.

I.

Maintenance Contract Required. A two-year landscape maintenance contract which includes a landscaping security in an amount equal to 50 percent of the cost of the landscape project shall be posted as a prerequisite to final building inspection, except for subdivisions with landscaping which is included in the subdivision improvement agreement, in which case a one-year maintenance period is acceptable. The developer may transfer maintenance responsibility to another party, for example, homeowners' association, provided that the security remains posted for the remainder of the originally-required time period.

J.

Maintenance. Landscaping shall be properly maintained at all times.

1.

Irrigation equipment shall be in working condition at all times.

2.

Litter shall be removed from all landscaped areas in a timely fashion.

3.

Turf areas shall be mowed on a regular basis and be kept green. Accumulation of leaves, twigs, bark, and other similar materials shall be removed on a regular basis. Planting areas shall be kept in a weed-free fashion at all times.

4.

Landscaping maintenance shall include pruning, cultivating, weeding, fertilizing, replacement of plants, and watering on a regular basis.

5.

Landscape maintenance shall include the pruning or removal of overgrown vegetation, cultivated or uncultivated, that is likely to harbor rats, vermin or other nuisances, or otherwise be detrimental to neighboring properties.

6.

Landscape maintenance shall include the removal of dead, decayed, diseased, or hazardous trees, weeds and debris constituting unsightly appearance, dangerous to public safety and welfare or detrimental to neighboring properties or property values. Compliance shall be by removal, replacement, or maintenance.

7.

All landscaping (trees, shrubs, ground cover, turf, etc.) which, due to accident, damage, disease, lack of maintenance, or other cause, fail to show a healthy appearance and growth, shall be replaced. Replacement plants shall conform to all standards that govern the original planting installation, approved landscaping plan, or as approved by the Director.

(Ord. No. 1576, § 2 (Exh. A, amd.), 10-23-2012)

DIVISION 19.30 - PARKING AND LOADING

19.30.010 - Purpose of Division.

This Division establishes regulations to ensure that sufficient off-street parking facilities are provided for all uses and that parking facilities are properly designed, attractive, and located to be unobtrusive yet meet the needs of the specific use.

(Ord. No. 1576, § 2 (Exh. A, amd.), 10-23-2012)

19.30.020 - Applicability.

Every use and structure, including a change or expansion of a use or structure shall provide parking and loading areas in compliance with the provisions of this Division. A use shall not be commenced and structures shall not be occupied until improvements required by this Division are satisfactorily completed.

(Ord. No. 1576, § 2 (Exh. A, amd.), 10-23-2012)

19.30.030 - General Parking Regulations.

A.

Parking Spaces to be Permanent. Parking spaces shall be permanently available, marked and maintained for parking purposes for the use they are intended to serve. Required parking spaces shall be independently accessible such that a vehicle may enter or exit any space without the necessity of moving another vehicle.

B.

Parking and Loading to be Unrestricted. Owners, lessees, tenants, or persons having control of the operation of a premises for which parking spaces are required shall not prevent or restrict authorized persons from using these spaces without prior approval of the Director. Fees for required on-site parking in residential zones shall be prohibited.

C.

Restriction of Parking Area Use. Required off-street parking areas shall be used exclusively for the temporary parking of vehicles and shall not be used for the sale, lease, display, repair, or storage of vehicles, trailers, boats, campers, mobile homes, recreational vehicles, merchandise, or equipment, or for any other use not authorized by the provisions of this Zoning Ordinance.

(Ord. No. 1576, § 2 (Exh. A, amd.), 10-23-2012)

19.30.040 - Number of Parking Spaces Required.

Each use shall provide at least the minimum number of off-street automobile parking spaces required by this Section, except where parking requirements are adjusted in compliance with Section 19.30.050 (Adjustments to Parking Requirements). See Section 19.30.090 for Bicycle parking requirements, and Section 19.30.100 for motorcycle parking requirements.

A.

Parking Requirements by Land Use. Each land use shall be provided the number of parking spaces required by Table 3-7, except where a greater number of spaces is required through conditions of approval. Sites located within the D (Downtown Novato Specific Plan) overlay district shall provide the number of parking spaces required by Table 3-7 within the Downtown (D) overlay, where applicable.

B.

Basis for Calculations. In any case where Table 3-7 establishes a parking requirement based on the floor area of a use in a specified number of square feet (for example: 1 space per 1,000 sf), the floor area shall be construed to mean gross floor area.

C.

Expansion of Structure, Change in Use. When an existing nonresidential structure is enlarged or increased in capacity, or when a change or expansion in use requires more parking than is presently provided, parking spaces shall be provided for the entire structure in compliance with this Chapter.

D.

Multi-Tenant Sites. A site with multiple tenants shall provide the aggregate number of parking spaces required for each separate use, except where:

1.

The site was developed comprehensively as a shopping center, the parking ratio shall be that required for the shopping center as a whole regardless of individual uses listed in Table 3-7; or

2.

The site qualifies for shared parking in compliance with Section 19.30.050 (Adjustments to Parking Requirements).

E.

Uses Not Listed. Land uses not specifically listed in Table 3-7, shall provide parking as required by the Director. The Director shall use the requirements of Table 3-7 as a guide in determining the minimum number of parking spaces to be provided and may require the applicant fund a parking study. The Director may approve the temporary reduction of parking spaces in conjunction with a seasonal or intermittent use.

F.

Excessive Parking. The parking standards established in this Division are both minimum and maximum standards. Parking spaces in excess of these standards may be approved in conjunction with Design Review, a Use Permit, or Master Plan/Precise Development Plan for the project, and when commensurate landscaping and pedestrian improvements are also provided.

G.

Bench or Bleacher Seating. Where fixed seating is provided (e.g., benches or bleachers), a seat shall be construed to be 18 inches of bench space for the purpose of calculating the number of required parking spaces.

Table 3-7

Parking Requirements by Land Use

Land Use Type:
Manufacturing, Processing, and Warehousing
Number of Parking Spaces Required
General manufacturing, industrial, and processing
uses
1 space for each 1,000 sf, which may include
incidental ofce space comprising less than 5% of
the total gross foor area. The parking requirements
for additional ofce space shall be calculated
separately as provided by this table for "Ofces."
Recycling facilities See Section
19.34.150 (Recycling Facilities).
Research and development, laboratories 1 space for each 300 sf, plus 1 space for each
company vehicle.
Warehouses, distribution centers, and storage
facilities (not including mini-storage for personal use)
1 space for each 1,500 sf. The gross foor area may
include incidental ofce space comprising less than
5% of the total gross foor area. The parking
requirements for additional ofce space shall be
calculated separately as provided by this table for
"Ofces."

Table 3-7

Parking Requirements by Land Use (Continued)

Land Use Type:
Recreation, Education, and Public Assembly
Number of Parking Spaces Required
Child day-care
Centers 1 space per employee, plus 1 space per 5 children;
Downtown (D) overlay - 1 space per employee, plus 1
space per 10 children
Large family day-care homes 1 space per employee, in addition to required
residential spaces.
Commercial recreation activities as follows, or
otherwise required by Use Permit:
Golf courses (regulation) 5 spaces for each hole.
Golf courses (pitch & putt) 4 spaces for each hole.
Miniature golf 3 spaces for each hole.
Tennis/racquetball/handball or other courts 3 spaces for each court, plus 1 space for each 300 sf
for ancillary uses;
Downtown (D) overlay - 3 spaces for each court, plus
1 space for each 300 sf for ancillary uses.
--- ---
Indoor recreation/ftness centers
Arcades 1 space for each 250 sf;
Downtown (D) overlay - 1 space for each 500 sf.
Bowling alleys 4 spaces for each lane, plus required spaces for
ancillary uses;
Downtown (D) overlay - 2 spaces for each lane, plus
required spaces for ancillary uses.
Health/ftness clubs 1 space for each 250 sf;
Downtown (D) overlay - 1 space for each 500 sf.
Pool and billiard rooms 2 spaces for each table, plus required space for
ancillary uses;
Downtown (D) overlay - 1 space for each table, plus
required space for ancillary uses.
Skating rinks 1 space for each 100 sf of skating area;
Downtown (D) overlay - 1 space for each 250 sf of
skating area.
Libraries, museums, art galleries 1 space for each 300 sf, plus 1 space for each ofcial
vehicle;
Downtown (D) overlay - 1 space for each 500 sf, plus
1 space for each ofcial vehicle.
Outdoor recreation facilities Determined by Use Permit.
Public assembly uses (e.g., churches and other
places of worship, cinemas, performance theaters,
meeting halls, and membership organizations).
1 space for each 4 fxed seats or 1 space for every
50 sf of assembly area, classrooms, meeting rooms,
etc.
Schools (private)
Elementary/Junior High 1.5 spaces for each classroom, plus 1 space for
every 200 sf of assembly area in an auditorium.
High School 0.2 spaces for each student, plus 1 space for each
employee.
College 0.5 spaces for each student, plus 1 space for each
employee.
Trade and business schools 1 space for each student;
Downtown (D) overlay - 1 space for each 4 students.
Studios for dance and art 1 space for each 200 sf;
Downtown (D) overlay - 1 space for each 500 sf.

Table 3-7

Parking Requirements by Land Use (Continued)

Land Use Type:
Residential Uses
Number of Parking Spaces Required (4)
Accessory dwelling units 1
As required by Section
19.34.030
Alcoholism or Drug Abuse Recovery or Treatment
Facility, 7 or more persons
1 space for each 3 beds
Community Care Facility, 7 or more persons 1 space for each 3 beds
Duplexes 2 spaces for each unit, 1 in a garage and located
within 100 feet of the unit it serves;1
Downtown (D) overlay - 1 space for each unit in a
garage and located within 100 feet of the unit it
serves.
Emergency shelter 1 space for each employee
Group quarters (including boarding houses, rooming
houses, dormitories, and organizational houses)
1 space for each bed, plus 1 space for each 8 beds
for guest parking, 1 space for each employee on
largest shift;
Downtown (D) overlay - 1 space for each bed, plus 1
space for each employee on largest shift.
Junior accessory dwelling units As required by Section
19.34.031
Mixed-use developments Determined by type of use.
Mobile home parks Two spaces for each mobile home (tandem parking
allowed in an attached carport), plus 1 guest parking
space for each two units. (1) (2)
Recreational vehicle parking shall be provided at the
rate of 1 space for every 5 units.
Multi-family dwellings, condominiums and other
attached dwellings (2)
Studio unit - 1.2 spaces per unit;
Downtown (D) overlay - 1 space per unit.
1-bedroom unit - 1.5 spaces per unit;
Downtown (D) overlay - 1 space per unit.
2-bedroom unit - 2 spaces per unit;
Downtown (D) overlay - 1.5 spaces per unit.
3-bedroom unit - 2.2 spaces per unit;
Downtown (D) overlay - 2 spaces per unit.
Additional guest parking - 1 space for each 3 units
(1);
Downtown (D) overlay - 1 space for each 4 units (1).
--- ---
Residential care facilities for the elderly (RCFE) The parking requirements for this use are in Table 3-7
under "Service Uses."
SB 9 dwelling units As required by Section
19.34.029
Senior housing projects 1 space for each unit with half the spaces covered,
plus 1 guest parking space for each 10 units.
Single-family dwellings (3) 2 spaces, 1 in a garage. 3 enclosed spaces
maximum unless approved through Design Review.
(1)

Notes:

(1)

Guest parking shall be clearly marked for guests only and shall be evenly dispersed throughout the site. Appropriate signs shall be provided to direct visitors to the parking.

(2)

At least one space per unit shall be covered (i.e., within a garage or carport).

(3)

For any unit which is located farther than 150 feet from a street designed to accommodate parking, 4 spaces per unit.

(4)

Adjustments to parking standards for parcels designated Downtown Core on the General Plan Land Use Map are provided in Section 19.30.050F.

Table 3-7

Parking Requirements by Land Use (Continued)

Land Use Type:
Retail Trade
Number of Parking Spaces Required
Appliances, building materials and furniture stores
(large item retail)
1 space for each 600 sf of gross foor area, plus 1
space for each 1,000 sf of outdoor display area;
Downtown (D) overlay - 1 space for each 1,000 sf of
foor area.
Automobile, mobile home, vehicle, machinery and
parts sales
1 space for each 350 sf, plus 1 space for each 3,000
sf of outdoor display and service area, plus 1 space
for each 300 sf for a parts department, plus 1 space
for each 2 employees;
Downtown (D) overlay - 1 space for each 350 sf, plus
1 space for each 8,000 sf of outdoor display, service
area, plus 1 space for each 300 sf for a parts
department, plus 1 space for each 2 employees.
--- ---
Bars and night clubs 1 space for each 50 sf of seating area and
waiting/lounge area exclusive of dance foor, plus 1
space for each 30 sf of dance foor.
Convenience stores 1 space for each 200 sf;
Downtown (D) overlay - 1 space for each 250 sf.
General retail 1 space for each 200 sf, plus 1 space for each
company vehicle, plus 1 space for each 1,000 sf of
outdoor display area;
Downtown (D) overlay - 1 space for each 300 sf, plus
1 space for each company vehicle, plus 1 space for
each 1,000 sf of outdoor display area.
Hardware stores 1 space for each 300 sf, plus 1 space for each
company vehicle, plus 1 space for each 1,000 sf of
outdoor display area.
Restaurants Note: within the Downtown (D) overlay, outdoor
seating approved within the public right-of-way shall
not be counted as foor area in parking calculations.
Table service with or without takeout 1 space for each 50 sf of indoor and outdoor seating
area, and waiting/lounge area;
Downtown (D) overlay - 1 space for each 250 sf of
indoor and outdoor seating area, and waiting/lounge
area.
Take-out only (e.g., delicatessens) 1 space for each 200 sf.
Shopping centers (shall use unsegregated parking
area)
1 space for each 250 sf for centers of less than
30,000 sf, and 1 space for each 300 sf for centers of
30,000 sf or more, plus 1 space for each 1,000 sf of
outdoor display area;
Downtown (D) overlay - 1 space for each 300 sf for
centers of less than 30,000 sf, plus 1 space for each
1,000 sf of outdoor display area.

Table 3-7

Parking Requirements by Land Use (Continued)

Land Use Type:
Services
Number of Parking Spaces Required
Banks and fnancial services 1 space for each 250 sf;
Downtown (D) overlay - 1 space for each 500 sf.
Copy and reproduction centers 1 space for each 400 sf.
--- ---
Consumer products - repair and maintenance 1 space for each 250 sf;
Downtown (D) overlay - 1 space for each 300 sf.
Equipment rental 1 space for each 300 sf, plus 1 space for each 1,500
sf of outdoor use area.
Gas stations (including multi-use stations) 1 space for each 400 sf; plus 3 spaces for each
service bay. 50% of pump island parking may be
credited toward ancillary use parking requirements
(convenience store, take-out restaurant, car wash).
Hotels and motels 1 space for each guest room, plus required spaces
for accessory uses.
Kennels and animal boarding 1 space for each 500 sf, plus 1 space for each 1,000
sf of boarding area.
Medical services
Clinics, medical/dental ofces 1 space for each 250 sf;
Downtown (D) overlay - 1 space for each 250 sf. for
ground foor uses; 1 space for every 300 sf for uses
on upper foors.
Board and care homes Board and care homes - 1 space for each bed or
sleeping room.
Convalescent hospital 1 space for each 3 patient beds per facility license.
Hospitals 1 space for each patient bed per facility license, plus
1 space for each 400 sf of ofce area, plus required
spaces for ancillary uses as determined by the
Review Authority.
Medical/dental labs 1 space for each 250 sf;
Downtown (D) overlay - 1 space for each 250 sf for
ground foor uses; 1 space for every 300 sf for uses
on upper foors.
Ofces, administrative, corporate 1 space for each 275 sf;
Downtown (D) overlay - 1 space for each 250 sf for
ground foor uses; 1 space for every 300 sf for uses
on upper foors.
Personal services
Barber/beauty shops (and other personal services) 1 space for each 250 sf;
Downtown (D) overlay - 1 space for each 300 sf.
Massage Establishments and
Massage establishments-small
1 space for each 250 sf;
Downtown (D) overlay - 1 space for each 300 sf.
Residential care facility for the elderly (RCFE), 7 or
more persons
1 space for each 3 beds.
--- ---
Storage, personal storage facilities 1 space for each 1,500 sf, plus 2 spaces for manager
ofce/residence.
Vehicle repair and maintenance
Repair garage 1 space for each 400 sf, plus 3 spaces for each
service bay.
Self-service vehicle washing 2 spaces for each washing stall, for queuing and
drying.
Full-service vehicle washing 10 spaces, plus 10 spaces for each wash lane for
drying area, plus queuing area for 3 vehicles ahead of
each lane.
Tattoo studios 1 space for each 1,500 sf, plus 2 spaces for manager
ofce/residence.
Veterinary clinics and hospitals 1 space for each 350 sf, plus 1 space for each 1,000
sf of boarding area.

(Ord. No. 1576, § 2 (Exh. A, amd.), 10-23-2012; Ord. No. 1611, § 5(Exh. D), 11-29-2016; Ord. No. 1637, § 3(Exh. A), 2-27-2018; Ord. No. 1676, Exh. A, 3-8-2022; Ord. No. 1723, § 3(Exhs. A, B), 3-25-2025; Ord. No. 1725, § 5(Exh. A), 7-22-2025)

19.30.050 - Adjustments to Parking Requirements.

A.

Shared On-Site Parking. Where two or more adjacent nonresidential uses have distinct and differing peak parking use periods, (e.g. a theater and a bank), a reduction in the required number of parking spaces may be allowed through Use Permit approval. Approval shall also require a recorded covenant running with the land, recorded by the owner of the parking lot, guaranteeing that the required parking will be maintained exclusively for the use or activity served for the duration of the use or activity.

B.

Reduction of Parking. The Review Authority for a land use or development permit application may reduce the number of parking spaces required by Section 19.30.040 (Number of Parking Spaces Required) based on quantitative information provided by the applicant that documents the need for fewer spaces (e.g., sales receipts, documentation of customer frequency, information on parking standards required for the proposed land use by other cities, etc.).

C.

Reduction of Parking—Off-Hour Uses Within the Downtown (D) Overlay. The Review Authority for a land use or development permit application within the Downtown (D) overlay district may reduce the parking requirements of this Division for land uses that are determined by the Review Authority to operate exclusively at night, when

their peak parking demand occurs after the evening peak period parking demand within the Downtown (D) overlay district generally, and adequate on-street or public parking is available.

D.

Public Parking Within the Downtown (D) Overlay. Required parking may be reduced or waived by the Review Authority for projects located within a public parking district or where:

1.

The property owner executes an agreement within the City to pay a parking in-lieu fee (The amount and applicability of an in-lieu fee(s) shall be as established by resolution of the City Council); and

The property owner agrees to execute an agreement with the City to participate in a parking assessment district and waives the right to protest the formation of the district; or

2.

The property owner provides some other fair share contribution/agreement towards the provisions of public parking facilities acceptable to the Review Authority.

Any agreement shall be recorded prior to the issuance of a Building Permit for the project.

E.

Off-Site Parking—Downtown (D) Overlay. Where approved by the Review Authority, parking required for a use proposed within the Downtown (D) overlay district may be located in an off-site parking facility away from the site of the proposed use.

1.

Evaluation of Proposal. In considering a request for off-site parking, the applicant shall submit a proposed parking plan showing the location, layout and proximity of the parking. The Review Authority shall consider how the distance between the parking area and the proposed use may affect whether the off-site facility will satisfy the parking needs of the proposed use.

2.

Guarantee of Continued Availability. Required parking spaces that are approved off-site shall be secured by a recordable covenant, lease, or other agreement, acceptable to the City Attorney. The parties to the covenant, lease, or agreement shall include the owners, and if applicable, the lessees of the off-site parking spaces and the owners, and if applicable, the lessees of the subject site, with covenants reflecting the conditions of approval and the approved off-site parking plan.

3.

Loss of Off-Site Spaces.

a.

Notification to the City. The owner or operator of a business that uses approved off-site spaces to satisfy the parking requirements of this Division shall immediately notify the Director of any change of ownership or use of

the property for which the spaces are required, and of any termination or default of the agreement between the parties.

b.

Effect of Termination of Agreement. Upon notification that a lease for required off-site parking has terminated, the Director shall determine a reasonable time in which one of the following shall occur:

(1)

Substitute parking is provided that is acceptable to the Director; or

(2)

The size or capacity of the use is reduced in proportion to the parking spaces lost.

F.

Parking Within the Downtown Core. Notwithstanding any other provisions in Division 19.30, parking for nonresidential uses on parcels designated Downtown Core (CD) on the General Plan Land Use Map shall be provided consistent with the following provisions:

1.

New Construction, Expansion of Use, or Change of Use. New construction, expansion of existing structures, or a change of use not subject to a use permit, involving up to a maximum total building FAR of 1.0, shall be exempt from providing parking in accordance with this Subsection.

2.

Nonresidential Development in Excess of 1.0 FAR. Parking for floor area above a 1.0 FAR shall be provided consistent with the requirements of Table 3-7 of this Division, except where adjusted in compliance with the provisions of this Section.

3.

Change of Use subject to Use Permit. For use changes that are subject to use permit approval, the Review Authority shall have the discretion to waive required parking as described in Subsection F1, subject to making findings required for use permits.

4.

Parking Study. For any project subject to design review, use permit, or proposing a change of use to a land use with a more intensive parking requirement, the Director may require the applicant to submit a parking demand and occupancy study to document the availability of adequate public or private parking capacity to support the proposed project and existing development. Should a project specific parking study identify that insufficient parking is available to support a proposed project, the Review Authority may condition the project to reduce parking demand, allow parking to be satisfied in an alternative manner as specified in this Section, or deny the application. A parking study shall be required for projects involving 10,000 sq. ft. or more of new or expanded floor area.

5.

Review of Parking Demand. To ensure that new nonresidential development, expansion of existing uses, and use changes do not adversely impact public parking availability in the Downtown Core under the provisions of this Subsection, the City shall implement the following procedures and policies:

a.

Conduct an annual parking demand and occupancy study to assess the demand for on-street parking stalls and other public parking facilities in the Downtown Core, including public parking in and around the City Hall campus. The study shall individually analyze parking demand in the Downtown Core areas east and west of Redwood Boulevard.

b.

The parking demand and occupancy study shall be conducted anytime between the last two weeks of September and the first two weeks of October annually. The parking demand and occupancy study shall consist of three consecutive occupancy counts conducted at 12:00 p.m., 2:15 p.m., and 5:15 p.m. on a weekday.

c.

Should the results of the annual parking demand and occupancy study indicate that public parking stall occupancies in the Downtown Core areas east or west of Redwood Boulevard are at or above a threshold of 85%, the City shall initiate a series of confirming parking occupancy counts, utilizing the methodology described in Subsection b. above, to verify the findings of the initial parking demand and occupancy survey.

If public parking stall occupancies are constant at a rate exceeding 85% or higher, the City shall commence planning efforts to ensure adequate parking in the Downtown Core. Should public parking stall occupancies reach a rate of 90%, the on-site parking exemption described in this Subsection shall be suspended, unless additional parking is under construction or a project applicant submits a parking study indicating the proposed project would not create a significant impact. Said suspension shall apply to the specific area of the Downtown Core (e.g., Downtown Core parcels east or west of Redwood Boulevard) that is found to exceed the occupancy threshold. Thereafter, new development, expansion of existing uses, or use changes not subject to a use permit shall provide parking consistent with the requirements of Table 3-7 of this Division, except where adjusted in compliance with other provisions of this Section.

d.

For purposes of this Section, public parking shall include on-street parking stalls located within the public right-of-way, parking stalls located in municipal parking areas, or any other parking stall that is available on an unrestricted basis for use by the general public (e.g., parking stalls leased by the City).

6.

Residential Uses. Residential uses shall provide parking as required by this Division.

Disabled Parking. Notwithstanding any provision of section 19.30.050, disabled parking may be required onsite consistent with applicable state or local regulations.

8.

Removal of Existing Parking Stalls. Existing on-site parking stalls may be removed as necessary to accommodate nonresidential expansions.

9.

Assessment District. The property owner shall execute and record an agreement with the City to participate in a parking assessment district and waive the right to protest the formation of the district.

G.

Parking within the AHO Overlay. Notwithstanding any other provisions in Division 19.30, parking for multi-family residential uses complying with Section 19.16.070, in the AHO Overlay district shall be provided consistent with the following provisions:

1.

Zero to one bedroom: one onsite parking space per unit.

2.

Two to three bedrooms: two onsite parking spaces per unit.

3.

Four and more bedrooms: two and one-half parking spaces per unit.

If the total number of parking spaces required for a development is other than a whole number, the number shall be rounded up to the next whole number. For purposes of this Section, a development may provide onsite parking through tandem parking or uncovered parking but not through on-street parking.

(Ord. No. 1576, § 2 (Exh. A, amd.), 10-23-2012; Ord. No. 1587, § 6(Exh. D), 12-3-2013)

19.30.060 - Disabled/Handicapped Parking Requirements.

Parking areas shall include parking spaces accessible to the disabled in the following manner:

A.

Number of Spaces and Design Standards. Parking spaces for the disabled shall be provided in compliance with Section 1129B of the Uniform Building Code and the Federal Accessibility Guidelines. Disabled accessible parking spaces shall count toward fulfilling the parking requirements of this Division.

B.

Residential Multi-Family Uses. For each dwelling unit required to be designed to accommodate the physically handicapped or required to be made adaptable for the physically handicapped, the required parking shall be provided in compliance with Part 2, Title 24, California Code of Regulations.

(Ord. No. 1576, § 2 (Exh. A, amd.), 10-23-2012)

19.30.070 - Parking Design Standards.

Parking areas shall be designed and constructed in compliance with the following standards:

A.

Location of Parking Areas.

1.

Required off-street parking shall be located on the same parcel as the uses served; except with Use Permit approval, parking may be located on a parcel in the vicinity of the parcel served subject to a recorded covenant running with the land, recorded by the owner of the parking lot, guaranteeing that the required parking will be maintained exclusively for the use or activity served for the duration of the use or activity.

2.

Residential parking areas shall comply with the standards of Sections 19.20.100E.3 and E.4 and Section 19.34.170.

B.

Access to Parking Areas and Parking Spaces.

1.

Access to Parking Lots. Parking lots shall be designed to prevent vehicle access at any point other than at designated access drives.

2.

Internal Maneuvering and Queuing. Parking areas shall

provide suitable maneuvering room so that vehicles enter the street in a forward direction, except for single-family homes and duplexes. Non-residential parking lots shall also provide queuing area between the street and the first point where vehicles may maneuver within the parking lot. The queuing area shall have a minimum depth of 20 feet. See Figure 3-13.

3.

Vertical Clearance. A minimum unobstructed clearance height of 14 feet shall be maintained above areas accessible to vehicles in non-residential parking facilities.

C.

Access to Adjacent Sites. In non-residential developments, it is encouraged to provide shared vehicle and pedestrian access to adjacent nonresidential properties for convenience, safety and efficient circulation. A joint access agreement guaranteeing the continued availability of the shared access between the properties and

running with the land should be recorded by the owners of the abutting properties, as approved by the Director.

D.

Parking Space and Lot Dimensions.

1.

Residential. Parking spaces within carports and garages shall have minimum dimensions of 20 feet in length by 10 feet in width.

2.

All Other Parking Spaces. Minimum parking space dimensions shall be as follows: See Figure 3-14.

a.

Standard parking spaces shall be 9 feet by 19 feet.

b.

Compact parking spaces within a non-residential project, up to a maximum of 20 percent of total number of required spaces, may be 8½ feet by 17 feet.

c.

Parallel parking spaces shall be 8 feet by 24 feet.

d.

The width of a parking space shall be increased by one foot if either side of the space is adjacent to a wall, fence, support column or other structure.

Figure 3-14

Types of Parking Spaces

E.

Curbing and Wheel Stops.

1.

Curbing. Continuous concrete curbing at least six inches high and six inches wide shall be provided along the edges of parking spaces adjacent to fences, walls, sidewalks, other structures, and landscaping.

a.

Alternative barrier designs may be approved by the Director.

b.

Parking spaces adjacent along their length to landscaped areas or other similar surfaces shall incorporate an additional curbing width of 12 inches (for a total of 18 inches) to provide a place to stand while exiting and entering vehicles.

c.

To increase the landscaped area within a parking lot, a maximum of two feet of the parking stall depth shall be landscaped with low-growth, hearty materials in lieu of paving, allowing a two-foot bumper overhang while maintaining the required parking dimensions. In the case where a walkway is necessary in lieu of landscaping, the walkway shall be widened by two feet to provide for a safe curb stop. See Figure 3-15.

2.

Wheel stops. Use of individual wheel stop blocks is prohibited except in work areas, parking areas not open to the public, and in other locations when deemed necessary by the Director.

F.

Directional Arrows and Signs.

1.

Parking spaces, aisles, approach lanes and maneuvering areas shall be clearly marked with directional arrows and lines to ensure the safe and efficient flow of vehicles.

The Director may require the installation of traffic signs in addition to directional arrows to ensure the safe and efficient flow of vehicles in a parking facility.

G.

Grade of Parking Areas. Parking areas should not exceed a grade of five percent, and shall not exceed 10 percent measured in any direction.

H.

Landscaping. Parking area landscaping shall be provided in compliance with the following requirements:

1.

Landscape Plan Required. A comprehensive landscape and irrigation plan shall be submitted for review and approval by the Review Authority.

2.

Pedestrian Accessibility. Landscaping shall be designed to accommodate safe convenient and uninterrupted pedestrian circulation throughout the parking lot and to buildings.

3.

Landscape Materials. Landscaping materials shall be provided throughout the parking lot area using a combination of trees, shrubs and ground cover. Drought-tolerant landscape materials shall be emphasized.

4.

Irrigation. All landscaped areas shall be provided with an automatic sprinkler system.

5.

Parking Lot Perimeter Landscaping.

a.

Adjacent to Streets. Parking areas adjoining a public street shall be designed to provide a 10-foot wide landscaped planting strip, exclusive of curbing, between the street right-of-way and parking area.

The landscaping shall be designed and maintained to screen cars from view from the street to a height of 36 inches. Screening materials may include a combination of plant materials, earth berms, solid masonry walls, raised planters, or other screening devices that meet the intent of this requirement. Trees shall be provided at a minimum rate of one for every 20 linear feet of landscaped area.

b.

Adjacent to Side or Rear Property Lines. Parking areas shall provide a perimeter landscaped strip at least five feet wide exclusive of curbing, where the facility adjoins a side or rear property line. The perimeter landscaped strip may be located within a required setback area. Trees shall be provided at minimum rate of one for each 20 linear feet of landscaped area.

c.

Adjacent to Residential Use. Parking areas for nonresidential uses adjoining residential uses shall provide a landscaped buffer yard with a minimum 10-foot width exclusive of curbing between the parking area and the common property line bordering the residential use. A solid decorative masonry wall shall be provided along the property line. Trees shall be provided at a minimum rate of one for every 20 linear feet of landscaped area. The Director may require additional trees where screening is a particular concern.

6.

Parking Lot Interior Landscaping.

a.

Minimum Area of Landscaping. A minimum of five percent of the total off-street parking area shall be landscaped with trees, shrubs, and ground cover. The perimeter landscaping required by Subsection H.5 shall not be considered part of the required parking lot landscaping.

b.

Required Tree Plantings. Trees shall be provided throughout the parking area at a minimum ratio of one tree for every three parking spaces in a row. The trees shall be distributed throughout the parking lot interior to provide shade in warm weather, and may be located in planter strips between parking aisles, and shall be planted in planter areas at the ends of parking aisles and in finger planters between parking spaces, in compliance with the following Subsection H.6.c. The tree species shall be selected from the City's list of acceptable parking lot shade trees, as approved by the Director.

c.

Planter Dimensions. Planters with trees shall have a minimum interior dimension of four feet. All ends of parking lanes shall be separated from drive aisles by landscaped islands or other means approved by the Director. A landscape finger shall be provided between the side lines of adjacent parking spaces at least every eight parking spaces.

d.

Larger Projects. Parking lots with more than 150 spaces shall provide a concentration of landscape elements at primary entrances, including specimen trees, flowering plants, enhanced paving, and project identification.

I.

Lighting. Parking areas shall have lighting capable of providing adequate illumination for security and safety. Lighting standards shall be energy-efficient and in scale with the height and use of the on-site structures. All illumination, including security lighting, shall be directed downward, away from adjacent properties and public rights-of-way. Lighting location shall take into account the location and expected mature characteristics of onsite landscape materials.

J.

Residential Guest Parking. Guest parking for multi-family residential uses shall be designated and restricted for the exclusive use of the guests with appropriate signs and pavement markings.

K.

Striping and Identification. Parking spaces shall be clearly outlined with four-inch wide lines painted on the surface of the parking facility. Circulation aisles, approach lanes, and turning areas shall be clearly marked with directional arrows and lines to ensure safe traffic movement.

L.

Surfacing. Parking spaces, driveways, and maneuvering areas shall be paved and permanently maintained in compliance with the standards in Subsection 5-17.008e of the Development Standards.

M.

Landscape Maintenance Security. Security to guarantee parking lot landscape maintenance shall be provided in compliance with Section 19.28.040.I (Maintenance Contract Required).

(Ord. No. 1576, § 2 (Exh. A, amd.), 10-23-2012)

19.30.080 - Driveways and Aisles.

A.

Single-Family Uses. Each single-family dwelling shall provide a continuous paved driveway from the street to the required parking area. Driveways shall be kept free and clear of stored materials, including inoperable vehicles. Vehicle storage shall comply with 19.34.170 (Vehicle Parking in Residential Zones). The maximum pavement area shall comply with 19.20.100.E.4.

B.

Multi-Family and Nonresidential Uses. Drive aisles within multi-family residential and nonresidential parking areas shall be designed and constructed in compliance with the following standards:

Table 3-8

Drive Aisle Widths

Angle of Parking Minimum Aisle Width (1)
45 degrees or less 12 feet
46 to 52 degrees 13 feet
53 to 55 degrees 14 feet
56 to 60 degrees 15 feet
61 to 70 degrees 18 feet
71 to 80 degrees 22 feet
81 or more degrees 24 feet

Notes:

(1)

The Director may require greater widths where slopes or other obstructions are encountered.

C.

Drive-Through Facilities. Retail or service uses providing drive-in/drive through facilities shall be designed and operated to effectively mitigate problems of traffic congestion, excessive pavement, litter, noise, and unsightliness.

1.

Drive-through aisles shall have a minimum 15½ -foot radius at curves and a minimum width of 12 feet.

2.

Each entrance to an aisle and the direction of traffic flow shall be clearly designated by signs and pavement markings.

3.

Each drive-through aisle shall be separated from the circulation routes necessary for ingress or egress from the property, or access to a parking space.

4.

The vehicle queuing capacity of the drive-through facility and the design and location of the ordering and pickup facilities shall be determined by the Director.

5.

Each drive-through aisle shall be appropriately screened with a combination of landscaping, low walls, and/or berms to prevent headlight glare from impacting adjacent streets and parking lots.

D.

Clearance from Obstruction. The nearest edge of a driveway apron or curb return shall be at least five feet from the nearest property line, centerline of a fire hydrant, utility pole, traffic signal, light standard, or other similar facility.

E.

Visibility. Drive aisles shall be designed and located so that adequate visibility is ensured for pedestrians, bicyclists, and motorists when entering individual parking spaces, circulating within a parking facility, and entering or leaving a parking facility.

(Ord. No. 1576, § 2 (Exh. A, amd.), 10-23-2012)

19.30.090 - Bicycle Parking and Support Facilities.

Bicycle parking shall be provided for all multi-family projects and non-residential uses in compliance with this Section.

A.

Number of Bicycle Spaces Required.

1.

Multi-family projects shall provide bicycle parking spaces equal to a minimum of 10 percent of the required vehicle spaces, unless separate secured garage space is provided for each unit. The bicycle spaces shall be distributed throughout the project.

2.

Retail commercial uses shall provide bicycle parking spaces equal to a minimum of five percent of the required vehicle spaces, distributed to serve customers and employees of the project.

3.

Other non-residential uses providing employment shall provide bicycle parking spaces equal to a minimum of 10 percent of the required vehicle spaces, distributed to serve employees and visitors to the project

4.

Places of public assembly shall provide bicycle parking spaces equal a minimum of 10 percent of the required vehicle spaces, distributed to serve customers, visitors, and employees.

B.

Bicycle Parking Design and Devices.

1.

Parking Equipment. Each bicycle parking space shall include a stationary parking device to adequately secure the bicycle.

2.

Parking Layout.

a.

Aisles providing access to bicycle parking spaces shall be at least five feet in width.

b.

Each bicycle space shall be a minimum of two feet in width and six feet in length, and have a minimum of seven feet of overhead clearance.

c.

Bicycle spaces shall be conveniently located and generally within proximity to the main entrance of a structure.

d.

Bicycle spaces shall be separated from motor vehicle parking spaces or aisles by a fence, wall, or curb, or by at least five feet of open area, marked to prohibit motor vehicle parking.

C.

Required Shower Facilities. All new buildings and additions to existing buildings that result in a total floor area as shown in the following table shall be required to provide showers and dressing areas for each gender as shown in the following table:

Type of Land Use Number of Showers Required
for Specifed Building Floor Area
Number of Showers Required
for Specifed Building Floor Area
1 Shower
for Each Gender
1 Additional Shower
for Each Gender
Ofce Uses (business, professional) 50,000 to 149,999 sf Each 100,000 sf over 150,000
Retail Trade, Service Uses 100,000 to 299,999 sf Each 200,000 sf over 300,000
Manufacturing and Industrial Uses 50,000 sf or more N.A.

D.

Required Locker Facilities. Land uses required by this Section to provide bicycle parking spaces shall also provide one locker for each required bicycle parking space. Required lockers shall be located in relation to required showers and dressing areas to permit access to locker areas by either gender.

E.

Required Bicycle/Pedestrian Paths. Land uses required to provide bicycle parking spaces shall provide bicycle and pedestrian paths to and from the required parking and locker facilities; access across the site frontage; and provide connections through the interior of the site to any adjacent public open space, rights-of-way, park or community facilities.

(Ord. No. 1576, § 2 (Exh. A, amd.), 10-23-2012)

19.30.100 - Motorcycle Parking.

Parking lots with 50 or more parking spaces shall provide motorcycle parking spaces conveniently located near the main entrance of a structure, accessed by the same aisles that provide access to the automobile parking spaces in the parking lot.

A.

Number of Spaces Required. A minimum of one motorcycle parking space shall be provided for each 50 automobile spaces or fraction thereof.

B.

Space Dimensions. Motorcycle spaces shall have minimum dimensions of four feet by seven feet.

(Ord. No. 1576, § 2 (Exh. A, amd.), 10-23-2012)

19.30.110 - Loading Space Requirements.

A.

Loading Spaces to be Permanent. Loading spaces shall be permanently available, marked and maintained for loading purposes for the use they are intended to serve. The Director may approve the temporary reduction of loading spaces in conjunction with a seasonal or intermittent use.

B.

Number of Loading Spaces Required. Nonresidential uses with less than 10,000 square feet of gross floor area shall provide one loading space, which may be combined with parking spaces. Nonresidential uses with gross floor area of 10,000 square feet or more shall provide loading spaces in compliance with Table 3-9. Requirements for uses not specifically listed shall be determined by the Zoning Administrator based upon the requirements for comparable uses and upon the particular characteristics of the proposed use.

Table 3-9

Loading Space Requirements

Type of Land Use Total Gross Floor Area Loading Spaces Required (1)
Manufacturing, research, and
development, institutional, and
service uses
10,000 to 19,999 sf 1 space
20,000 sf or more 1 space for each additional 20,000
sf, or fraction thereof.
Ofce uses 10,000 to 34,999 sf 1 space
35,000 sf or more 1 space for each additional 35,000
sf or fraction thereof.
Commercial and other allowed
uses
10,000 sf or more 1 for each 10,000 sf, or fraction
thereof.

Notes:

(1)

The Review Authority may increase these requirements where it determines that additional loading spaces will be needed.

C.

Loading Area Design Standards. Loading areas shall be designed and constructed as follows:

1.

Location. Loading spaces shall be located based on the operating characteristics of the proposed use to:

a.

Ensure that the loading facility is screened from adjacent streets as much as possible;

b.

Ensure that loading and unloading takes place on-site and in no case within adjacent public rights-of-way or other traffic areas on-site;

c.

Ensure that vehicular maneuvers occur on-site; and

d.

Minimize adverse impacts upon neighboring residential properties.

2.

Dimensions. Minimum loading space dimensions shall be 12 feet in width, 45 feet in length, and with 14 feet of vertical clearance. Loading spaces for office facilities and nonresidential land uses of less than 10,000 square feet may be 10 feet in width by 30 feet in length, and may be combined with parking spaces. The Director may increase or decrease the dimensions where it is clear that larger or smaller loading spaces are warranted due to the nature of the proposed project.

3.

Lighting. Loading areas shall have lighting capable of providing adequate illumination for security and safety. Lighting standards shall be energy-efficient and in scale with the height and use of adjacent structures.

4.

Loading Doors and Gates. Loading bays and roll-up doors shall be painted to blend with the exterior structure walls. Loading bays and doors, and related trucks shall be adequately screened from view from adjacent streets as determined by the Review Authority.

5.

Screening. Loading areas abutting residentially zoned parcels shall be screened in compliance with 19.20.090 (Screening).

6.

Striping. Loading areas shall be striped indicating the loading spaces and identifying the spaces for "loading only." The striping shall be permanently maintained by the property owner/tenant in a clear and visible manner at all times. Curb-adjacent loading areas shall be identified by a yellow painted curb and the words "Loading only."

D.

Waiver of Loading Space Requirements. The Director may waive all or part of the requirement to provide loading spaces if he or she first finds that unusual circumstances unique to the proposed project make the

requirement unattainable or unnecessary.

(Ord. No. 1576, § 2 (Exh. A, amd.), 10-23-2012)

19.30.120 - Trip and Travel Demand Reduction Measures.

A.

Purpose. This Section provides requirements for new and reconstructed non-residential projects that are intended to reduce vehicle trips and travel demand.

B.

Applicability. Specific trip and travel demand reduction measures shall be incorporated into the design of nonresidential projects as provided by this Section. All facilities and improvements constructed or otherwise required shall be permanently maintained in good repair.

C.

Required Project Features. Non-residential uses shall provide the features shown in the following table, as required through the land Use Permit and/or subdivision process, and in compliance with Municipal Code Section 18-14 (Trip Reduction). Subsection D. below provides standards for each of the required measures. All calculations shall be based on gross floor area, in square feet.

Measure Required Based on Project Floor Area
(gross foor area in square feet)
Measure Required Based on Project Floor Area
(gross foor area in square feet)
Measure Required Based on Project Floor Area
(gross foor area in square feet)
Measure Required Based on Project Floor Area
(gross foor area in square feet)
Trip/Travel Demand Reduction
Measures
10,000 to
24,000
25,000 to
49,999
50,000 to
99,999
100,000+
Electric vehicle recharging
Preferential parking
Shower/locker facilities
Tenant Transit Information
Transportation information center
Transit stop ■(1) ■(1) ■(1) ■(1)

Notes:

(1)

Required if determined by the Review Authority to be necessary to mitigate project impacts. See Subsection D.5 below.

D.

Standards for Required Features. Where specific trip and travel demand reduction measures are required by Subsection C. above, each required measure shall be provided as follows:

1.

Electric Vehicle Recharging. Electric vehicle recharging facilities shall be provided to encourage the use of electric powered vehicles.

2.

Tenant Transit Information. The property owner shall provide ridesharing and public transportation information to tenants as part of occupancy move-in materials, in compliance with Municipal Code Section 18-14 et seq. (Trip Reduction).

3.

Preferential Parking. Preferential parking facilities shall be provided as follows:

a.

Minimum Number of Spaces Required. At least one and one-half (1.5) preferential space shall be provided for each 10,000 square feet of commercial/office space and shall be signed/striped for preferential parking vehicles. Preferential parking spaces shall be reserved for use by potential carpool/vanpool vehicles, motorcycles, and electric vehicles. Spaces reserved for vanpools shall be accessible to vanpool vehicles, in compliance with Subsection D.3.c., below.

b.

Location of Employee Spaces. Not less than 10 percent of parking spaces reserved for employees shall be located as close as is practical to the employee entrances without displacing handicapped and customer parking needs.

c.

Space Layout, Vertical Clearance. Vanpool vehicle spaces within a parking structure and access routes to the spaces shall be provided a minimum vertical clearance of seven feet, two inches (7'-2"). Adequate turning radii and space dimensions shall also be provided in vanpool areas.

d.

Information on Space Availability. A statement that preferential parking spaces for employees are available and a description of the method for obtaining the spaces shall be posted at the required transportation information center.

e.

Signage, Striping. Spaces shall be signed/striped as required by the Director.

f.

Permit Application Information. The preferential parking area shall be identified on the site plan submitted with the development permit applications for the project, to the satisfaction of the Director.

4.

Shower/Locker Facilities. Shower and locker facilities shall be provided in compliance with Section 19.30.090 (Bicycle Parking and Support Facilities).

5.

Transit Stop. If determined by the City to be necessary to mitigate project impacts, transit stop improvements shall be provided. The City will consult with the local transit service providers in determining appropriate improvements. When locating transit stops and/or planning building entrances, entrances shall be designed to provide safe and efficient access to nearby transit stations/stops.

6.

Transportation Information Center. A bulletin board, display case, or kiosk displaying transportation information shall be located where the greatest number of employees are likely to see it. Information in the area shall include, but is not limited to the following:

a.

Current maps, routes, and schedules for public transit routes serving the site;

b.

Telephone numbers for referrals on transportation information, including numbers for the regional ridesharing agency and local transit operators;

c.

Ridesharing promotional material supplied by commuter-oriented organizations;

d.

Bicycle route and facility information, including regional/local bicycle maps and bicycle safety information; and

e.

A listing of facilities available for carpoolers, vanpoolers, bicyclists, transit riders and pedestrians at the site.

(Ord. No. 1576, § 2 (Exh. A, amd.), 10-23-2012)

DIVISION 19.31 - PROPERTY MAINTENANCE

19.31.010 - Purpose.

This Division establishes a process to ensure that the property owner and/or responsible person maintain previously constructed or installed improvements on private property in a manner that protects the public health, safety, and general welfare.

(Ord. No. 1576, § 2 (Exh. A, amd.), 10-23-2012)

19.31.020 - General Maintenance Requirements.

Any person owning, leasing, occupying, or having charge or possession of any property shall maintain it in a manner that is determined by the Director to not be detrimental or injurious to the public health, safety, and general welfare, and that does not interfere with the comfortable enjoyment of life or property.

(Ord. No. 1576, § 2 (Exh. A, amd.), 10-23-2012)

19.31.030 - Specific Violations.

It shall be unlawful to maintain or fail to maintain any property, or on-site improvements, in a manner that results in any of the following conditions:

A.

Nuisances Possibly Dangerous to Children. The storing or allowing the storage of any abandoned or broken appliances and equipment or neglected machinery on private property for any length of time. Any appliances, equipment, machinery, or accumulation of materials shall be removed immediately upon notification by the Director.

B.

Deteriorating and Defective Structures. Any and all improvements located on private property shall be presumed to be in violation of this Section if any of the following conditions exist:

1.

Peeling paint, cracked or broken stucco, or other exterior covering, in excess of four square feet of any single facade (i.e., any exterior side) of a structure;

2.

Broken, cracked, or missing windows or doors;

3.

Roofs missing shingles, tile, or other material used as roof composition or the material is loose or unstable;

4.

Improperly maintained (torn, tattered, shredded, broken, rusted) awnings; or

5.

Fences, walls, and gates with peeling paint, broken bricks, broken mortar, cracked or broken stucco, or are which are not constructed of uniform materials or in a uniform manner.

C.

Hazardous and Unsanitary Conditions.

1.

Accumulating any human or animal waste material or substances, stagnant water, or any combustible or hazardous materials or substances, fluid or solid on any part of or in any structure on real property.

2.

A pond, spa, swimming pool, fountain, or other body of water which is abandoned, unattended, unfiltered, or not otherwise properly maintained, resulting in polluted or stagnant water.

D.

Improper Parking or Storage of Goods, Equipment, and Vehicles.

1.

Using or allowing the use of any hardscape area for parking which prevents or hinders access to elevators, building entrances or exits, or trash receptacles or blocks access to any structure for emergency vehicles or personnel.

2.

The keeping or storing of camper shells, inoperable vehicles, cargo containers, appliances, and other equipment and materials in yard areas or driveways in which storage is not allowed, where the items are not screened from view from public or private streets or highways.

E.

Non-maintenance of Landscape and Hardscape. Maintaining or allowing the maintenance of any paved areas for vehicle parking and access, porches, steps, or walkways in a hazardous condition due to cracked, raised, or missing surface materials.

F.

Non-maintenance of Parking Facilities. Failure to properly maintain any of the following parking lot features:

1.

Driveway and parking area paving;

2.

Lighting fixtures;

3.

Lot striping;

4.

Signs; and

5.

Trash recepticals and enclosures.

G.

Overgrown, Dead, Decayed or Diseased Vegetation. Overgrown, dead, decayed or diseased vegetation on private property. There shall be a conclusive presumption that vegetation is overgrown or dead if it has not been cut and trimmed, not responded to adequate watering and maintenance, or not replaced within 15 days after notification by the Director that the vegetation is overgrown or dead.

H.

Refuse and Waste. Refuse and waste material which by reason of its location or character may constitute a fire hazard or threat to the health, safety, and general welfare, including aesthetic impacts, of the surrounding residential area. Compost piles are not considered refuse and waste.

I.

Other Provisions of the Municipal Code. A violation of any other provisions of the Municipal Code which pertains to real property, structures, or which otherwise concerns the public health, safety, and general welfare.

J.

Code Violations. Any violation of the Uniform Building Code, Uniform Fire Code, or Uniform Housing Code, as amended.

K.

Drainage. Land, the topography, geology, or configuration of which, whether in a natural state or as a result of grading operations, modifications or excavation, causes erosion, subsidence, or surface water drainage problems that may be potentially injurious to the public health, safety and welfare or to adjacent properties. Allowing obstructions to water flow to occur or develop within a natural drainage whether from a natural state, vegetative growth, placement of fill or any structures, or an object from an upstream location.

L.

Signs. Any sign in violation of Section 19.32. Allowing any abandoned sign that refers to a business that is no longer operating at the site to remain in place.

(Ord. No. 1576, § 2 (Exh. A, amd.), 10-23-2012)

19.31.040 - Abatement of Violations.

The abatement of any conditions described in this Chapter shall be performed in compliance with Division 19.59 (Zoning Ordinance Enforcement).

(Ord. No. 1576, § 2 (Exh. A, amd.), 10-23-2012)

DIVISION 19.32 - SIGNS

19.32.010 - Purpose of Division.

The regulations established by this Division are intended to appropriately limit the placement, type, size, and number of signs allowed within the City, and to require the proper maintenance of signs. The purposes of these limitations and requirements are to:

A.

Avoid traffic safety hazards to motorists and pedestrians caused by visual distractions and obstructions;

B.

Promote the aesthetic and environmental values of the community by providing for signs that do not impair the attractiveness of the City as a place to live, work, and shop;

C.

Provide for signs as an effective channel of communication, while ensuring that signs are aesthetically proportioned in relation to adjacent structures and the structures to which they are attached; and

D.

Safeguard and protect the public health, safety, and general welfare.

(Ord. No. 1576, § 2 (Exh. A, amd.), 10-23-2012)

19.32.020 - Applicability.

A.

Signs Regulated. The requirements of this Division shall apply to all signs in all zoning districts, except as follows:

1.

The requirements of this Division do not apply to signs within the REI zoning district.

2.

The requirements of this Division apply to signs within the PD (Planned Development) zoning district only to the extent that individual sites are not subject to specific sign standards established by an approved Master Plan or Precise Development Plan.

B.

Applicability to Sign Content. The provisions of this Division do not regulate the message content of signs (sign copy), regardless of whether the message content is commercial or noncommercial.

(Ord. No. 1576, § 2 (Exh. A, amd.), 10-23-2012)

19.32.030 - Design Review and Sign Permit Requirements.

No sign shall be installed, constructed, or altered unless it is first approved in compliance with this Section, or allowed without Sign Permit approval by Subsection F., below.

A.

Fees and Plans Required. An application for a Sign Permit shall be filed and processed in compliance with Division 19.40 (Applications - Filing and Processing). The application shall also include architectural elevations

and plans of all proposed signs drawn to scale, with all dimensions noted, and include illustrations of copy, colors, materials, and samples of the proposed colors and materials.

B.

Design Review and Approval. The Director shall review all Sign Permit applications and approve only those that comply with the findings required in Subsection D. The Director may require conditions of approval as are reasonably necessary to achieve the purposes of this Division.

The Director may refer Sign Permit applications to the Design Review Commission for action, either for the individual Sign Permit, or as part of a development project that is otherwise subject to Design Review Commission review.

C.

Master Sign Plan.

1.

When Required. A Master Sign Plan must be approved by the Director (or by the Design Review Commission upon referral by the Director) prior to the issuance of any Sign Permit for:

a.

A new nonresidential project with four or more tenants including four or more tenants located on a parcel zoned Planned District (PD) and subject to an approved Precise Development Plan; and

b.

Major rehabilitation work on an existing nonresidential project with four or more tenants, that involves exterior remodeling, and/or application requests to modify 50 percent or more of the existing signs on the site within a one year period. For the purposes of this Division, major rehabilitation means adding more than 50 percent to the gross floor area of the building/buildings, or exterior redesign of more than 50 percent of the length of any facade within the project.

All signs installed or replaced within the nonresidential project shall comply with the approved Master Sign Plan.

2.

Content of Plan. A Master Sign Plan shall provide standards for the uniform style, construction, size, and placement of signs within the proposed nonresidential project.

3.

Revisions. Revisions to a Master Sign Plan may be approved by the Director if it is first determined that the revision is minor and that the intent of the original approval, and any applicable conditions are not affected.

D.

Findings for Approval. The approval of a Sign Permit or Master Sign Plan shall require that the Review Authority first make all the following findings:

1.

The proposed signs do not exceed the standards of Sections 19.32.060 (Zoning District Sign Standards) and 19.32.070 (Standards for Specific Types of Signs), and are of the minimum size and height necessary to enable motorists and pedestrians to readily identify the facility or site from a sufficient distance to safely and conveniently access the facility or site;

2.

The size, location, and design of the signs are visually complementary and compatible with the size and architectural style of the primary structures on the site, any prominent natural features of the site, and structures and prominent natural features on adjacent properties on the same street; and

3.

The proposed signs are in substantial conformance with the design review criteria provided in Section 19.32.050 (General Requirements for All Signs).

E.

Time Limit for Action. A Sign Permit or a Master Sign Plan shall be approved or disapproved by the Review Authority in compliance with Section 19.40.070 (Initial Application Review).

F.

Signs and Sign Changes Allowed Without a Sign Permit. The following are permitted without a Sign Permit, provided that they comply with Section 19.32.050 (General Requirements for All Signs), and any required Building Permit is obtained:

1.

Nonstructural Modifications, and Maintenance.

a.

Modifications to sign copy on conforming signs, or changes to the face or copy of conforming changeable copy signs;

b.

Nonstructural modifications of the face or copy of an existing conforming sign installed in compliance with a Master Sign Plan, provided that the modifications are consistent with the Master Sign Plan approved in compliance with Subsection C.;

c.

The normal maintenance of conforming signs, except as set forth in 19.32.090.C.

2.

Temporary Signs. Temporary signs in compliance with Section 19.32.070.E.

3.

Governmental Signs. Signs installed by the City, or a Federal or State governmental agency within a public right-of-way; and any sign, posting, notice, or similar sign placed by or required by a governmental agency in carrying out its responsibility to protect public health, safety, and general welfare.

4.

Official Flags. Flags of national, State, or local governments, or nationally recognized religious, fraternal, or public service agencies, provided that the length of the flag shall not exceed one-third the height of the flag pole. The maximum allowed height of a flag pole in a residential zoning district shall be 12 feet; the maximum height of a flag pole in a non-residential zoning district shall be 30 feet. Additional height may be authorized through Design Review approval.

5.

Political Signs. Political signs are allowed without a Sign Permit provided that the signs:

a.

Are no more than six (6) feet in height and shall not exceed 24 square feet in area within residential zoning districts and shall not exceed 32 square feet in area within nonresidential zoning districts;

b.

May be installed for up to 60 days prior to an election on private property with the property owner's consent or within the public right-of-way only in accordance with sight visibility area requirements of Section 19.20.070D; and

c.

Shall be removed within seven days following the election. Signs not removed after seven days shall be removed by the City at the expense of the political candidate or organization involved.

6.

Public Directional Signs and Notices. Signs showing the location of public facilities such as public telephones, restrooms, and underground utilities.

7.

Service Station Price Signs. Service station price signs required by State law.

8.

Street Addresses. Street address numbers not exceeding an aggregate area of two square feet.

(Ord. No. 1576, § 2 (Exh. A, amd.), 10-23-2012)

19.32.040 - Prohibited Signs.

The following types of signs and devices shall be specifically prohibited:

A.

Abandoned signs;

B.

Animated signs, including electronic message display signs, and variable intensity, blinking, or flashing signs, except time and temperature displays (which are not considered signs);

C.

Balloons and other inflatable devices;

D.

Banners;

E.

Flags, except those allowed by Section 19.32.030.F;

F.

Illegal signs;

G.

Light bulb strings, except for holiday decorations;

H.

Moving signs, except barber poles;

I.

Obscene signs;

J.

Permanent off-site signs except as provided in Section 19.32.070.E.2;

K.

Pennants;

L.

Pole signs and other freestanding signs over six feet in height;

M.

Roof signs;

N.

Because of the City's compelling interest in ensuring traffic safety, signs that simulate in color, size, or design, any traffic control sign or signal, or that make use of words, symbols, or characters in a manner that interferes with, misleads or confuses pedestrian or vehicular traffic;

O.

Signs attached to or suspended from a vehicle parked within a public right-of-way, or in a location on private property that is visible from a public right-of-way, except a sign painted directly upon, magnetically affixed to, or permanently affixed to the body or other integral part of the vehicle; and

P.

Temporary and portable signs, except as allowed by Subsections 19.32.070.E and G.

(Ord. No. 1576, § 2 (Exh. A, amd.), 10-23-2012)

19.32.050 - General Requirements for All Signs.

A.

Sign Area. The measurement of sign area to determine compliance with the sign area limitations of this Division shall occur as follows:

1.

The surface area of a sign shall be calculated by enclosing the extreme limits of all framing, writing, logo, representation, emblem, or other display within a single continuous perimeter composed of squares or rectangles with no more than eight lines. See Figure 3-16.

2.

Supporting framework or bracing that is clearly incidental to the display itself shall not be computed as sign area.

3.

The area of a double-faced (back-to-back) sign shall be calculated as a single sign face if the distance between each sign face does not exceed 18 inches and the two faces are parallel with each other.

4.

Where a sign consists of one or more three-dimensional objects (i.e., balls, cubes, clusters of objects, sculpture or statue-like trademarks), the sign area shall be measured as their maximum projection upon a

vertical plane. See Figure 3-17.

5.

For signs that incorporate time and temperature devices, the area of these devices shall not be included in the total area of the sign.

B.

Sign Height (Freestanding). The height of a freestanding sign shall be measured as the vertical distance from the finished grade adjacent to the base of the sign structure to the highest point of the structure, where finished grade does not include fill, planters, or other material artificially placed to allow increased sign height.

C.

Sign Location Requirements.

1.

All signs shall be located on the same site as the subject of the sign, except as otherwise allowed by this Division. A sign may project over an adjacent public right-of-way only when authorized by an encroachment permit as well as a Sign Permit.

2.

No sign shall be located within the public right-of-way, except as otherwise allowed by this Division. Signs permitted within the right-of-way pursuant to this Division shall not be allowed within median islands or on utility poles or in a manner that blocks pedestrian or bicycle access or creates a hazard for any public or private accessway. In any event, no signs shall be allowed in the right-of-way along or adjacent to Scottsdale Marsh.

3.

All signs shall be located to maintain adequate sight distance from intersections, driveways and pedestrian or bicycle accessways and shall meet the sight visibility area requirements of Section 19.20.070D.

4.

The location of all signs shall be evaluated to ensure:

a.

That the setback is appropriate for the height and area of a freestanding or projecting sign;

b.

That flush or projecting signs relate to the architectural design of the building. Signs that cover windows, or that spill over natural boundaries and architectural features shall be discouraged;

c.

That signs do not unreasonably block the sight lines of existing signs on adjacent properties; and

d.

Pedestrian and vehicular safety.

D.

Design Criteria for Signs. The following design criteria shall be used in reviewing the design of individual signs. Substantial conformance with each of the following design criteria shall be required before a Sign Permit or Building Permit can be approved:

1.

Color. Colors on signs and structural members should be harmonious with one another and reflective of the dominant colors of the building or buildings being identified. Contrasting colors may be utilized if the overall effect of the sign is still compatible with the building colors and prevailing colors in the surrounding neighborhood (where a theme can be identified).

2.

Design and Construction.

a.

Design drawings for proposed permanent signs should be prepared by design professionals (e.g., architects, building designers, landscape architects, interior designers, those whose principal business is the design, manufacture, or sale of signs) or others who in the opinion of the Director are capable of producing professional results.

b.

All permanent signs should be constructed by a person or persons whose principal business is building construction or related trade including those whose principal business is the manufacture and installation of signs, or others capable of producing professional results. The intent is to achieve signing of careful construction, neat and readable copy, and durability so as to reduce maintenance costs and to prevent dilapidation.

3.

Materials and Structure.

a.

Sign materials (including those for framing and support) should be representative of the type and scale of materials used on the building or buildings which the sign identifies. Insofar as possible, sign materials should match the materials used on the building and on other signs.

b.

Materials selected for permanent signs shall be durable and capable of withstanding weathering over the life of the sign with reasonable maintenance.

c.

The size of the structural members (e.g. columns, crossbeams, and braces) should be proportional to the sign panel they are supporting. In general, fewer larger supporting members are preferable to many smaller supports.

d.

The use of individual letters incorporated into the building design is encouraged, rather than signs with background and framing other than the building wall.

e.

The use of reflective materials or surfaces may be approved only where the Review Authority determines that these materials will not distract motorists or create other hazards, and should be minimized in all cases.

E.

Copy Design Guidelines. The City does not regulate the message content (copy) of signs; however, the following are principles of copy design and layout that can enhance the readability and attractiveness of signs. Copy design and layout consistent with these principles is encouraged, but not required.

1.

Sign copy should relate only to the name and/or nature of the business or commercial center.

2.

Permanent signs that advertise continuous sales, special prices, or include phone numbers, etc. should be avoided.

3.

Information should be conveyed briefly or by logo, symbol, or other graphic manner. The intent should be to increase the readability of the sign and thereby enhance the identity of the business.

4.

The area of letters or symbols should not exceed 40 percent of the background area in commercial districts or 60 percent in residential districts.

Freestanding signs should contain the street address of the parcel or the range of addresses for a multi-tenant center.

F.

Illumination of Signs. The artificial illumination of signs, either from an internal or external source, shall be designed to minimize light and glare on surrounding rights-of-way and properties.

1.

External light sources shall be directed and shielded to limit direct illumination of any object other than the sign.

2.

The light from an illuminated sign shall not be of an intensity or brightness that will interfere with the reasonable enjoyment of residential properties. In areas with low ambient nighttime illumination levels (e.g., residential neighborhoods or business districts with little or no illuminated signing) applicants shall be encouraged to use light, illuminated copy against dark or opaque backgrounds.

3.

Signs shall not have blinking, flashing, or fluttering lights or other illuminating devices that have a changing light intensity, brightness or color.

4.

Colored lights shall not be used at a location or in a manner so as to be confused or construed as traffic control devices.

5.

Neither the direct nor reflected light from primary light sources shall create a hazard to operators of motor vehicles.

6.

Reflective-type bulbs and incandescent lamps that exceed 15 watts shall not be used on the exterior surface of signs so as to expose the face of the bulb or lamp to a public right-of-way or adjacent property.

7.

Light sources shall utilize energy efficient fixtures to the greatest extent possible.

8.

Illuminated panels, visible tubing, and strings of lights outlining all or a portion of a building, other than lighting that is primarily for indirectly illuminating architectural features, signs, or landscaping, shall be deemed "signs" subject to this Division and shall be counted as part of the allowed sign area. Each line of tubing or lights shall be deemed to have a minimum width of at least six inches for the purpose of area calculation.

G.

Maintenance of Signs. Signs and supporting hardware, including temporary signs, shall be maintained in good repair and functioning properly at all times. Repairs to signs shall be of equal or better in quality of materials and design as the original sign. Signs which are not properly maintained and are dilapidated shall be deemed to be a public nuisance, and may be abated in compliance with Municipal Code Section 1-6.

When existing signs are removed or replaced, all brackets, poles, and other supports that are no longer required shall be removed. Unpainted areas shall be painted to match the adjacent portion of the building or sign support structure.

(Ord. No. 1576, § 2 (Exh. A, amd.), 10-23-2012)

19.32.060 - Zoning District Sign Standards.

Only the signs and sign area authorized by this Section shall be allowed unless otherwise expressly provided in Section 19.32.030.D (Exempt signs) or Section 19.32.070 (Standards for Specific Types of Signs).

A.

A, OS, C, and Residential Zoning Districts. Signs in the Agriculture (A), Open Space (OS), Conservation (C), and residential zoning districts established by Section 19.04.020 (Zoning Districts Established) shall not exceed the standards in the Table 3-10. Temporary construction, real estate and subdivision identification signs may be permitted in residential zoning districts in conformance with the requirements of Section 19.32.070.E, (Standards for Specific Types of Signs).

Table 3-10

Sign Standards for A, OS, C,

and Residential Zoning Districts

Allowed Sign Types Maximum
Number
Maximum Sign Area Maximum Sign
Height
Lighting Allowed
Wall or monument 1 of either allowed
sign type per
entrance or street
frontage
32 sf maximum
each;
64 sf total for all
signs
Wall signs: below
edge of roof;
Monument: 6 ft
Indirect only

B.

Commercial, Office, and Industrial Zoning District Sign Standards. Signs in the Business and Professional Office (BPO), Neighborhood Commercial (CN), General Commercial (CG), Downtown Core (CD), Commercial/Industrial (CI), Light Industrial/Office (LIO), Mixed Use (MU), and Community Facilities and Parkland (CF) zoning districts established by Section 19.04.020 (Zoning Districts Established) shall comply with the following requirements:

General Sign Area Limitations. Signs in the commercial, office, and industrial zoning districts established by Section 19.04.020 (Zoning Districts Established) shall comply with the requirements in Table 3-11.

2.

Multi-Tenant Sites and Buildings. In addition to the signage allowed by Table 3-11 for each occupant on the basis of frontage, multi-tenant sites and buildings may have a freestanding identification sign with an area equal to 1/4 square foot for each ground floor linear foot of primary building frontage, up to a maximum of 200 sf.

C.

Downtown Novato Specific Plan (D) Overlay District Sign Standards. Instead of the "Maximum Sign Area Requirements" of Table 3-11, the aggregate area of all signs on a site within the Downtown Novato Specific Plan (D) overlay district shall not exceed one square foot of sign area for each linear foot of primary building frontage. For corner parcels, an additional one-half square foot of sign area may be allowed for each linear foot of secondary building frontage. No single sign shall exceed 25 square feet. Signs within the Downtown (D) overlay district shall also comply with the standards for specific types of signs in Section 19.32.070.

Table 3-11

Sign Standards for the BPO, CN, CG, CD, CI, LIO, CF, and MU Zoning Districts

Sign
Class
Allowed
Sign Types
Maximum
Number
of Signs
Maximum
Sign Area (1)
Maximum
Sign Height
Placement
Requirements
Lighting
Allowed
Additional
Requirements
1. Ground
foor
Wall and/or
window,
awning,
canopy,
projecting,
or
freestanding.
Single
tenant site
or
building:
3 per
primary
building
frontage.
1 per
secondary
frontage.
Multi-
tenant site
or
building:
1 per
business
frontage
Interior
parcels: The
greater of: 1
sf for each
ground level
linear ft of
primary
bldg.
frontage (for
buildings
with multiple
frontages, 1
sf for each
linear foot of
the primary
frontage
plus 0.5 sf
for each ft of
secondary
frontage); or
0.5 sf for
each linear
Freestanding:
6 ft
All others:
Below edge
of roof.
Near main
entrance.
Shall not
cover doors,
windows, or
architectural
details.
Yes See
19.32.070 for
sign
standards by
sign type.
ft of the
longest
parcel
frontage. (2)
The total
area of all
signs on a
single bldg.
frontage
shall not
exceed the
number of
linear ft in
that
frontage. At
least 25 sf,
and no more
than 200 sf,
are allowed
for each
use.
Corner
parcels: 0.5
additional sf
for each
linear ft of
secondary
frontage.
Shopping
centers:
allowed an
additional
freestanding
identifcation
sign of 0.25
sf for each
ground foor
ft of primary
bldg.
frontage, to
200 sf. max.
--- --- --- --- --- --- ---
2. Second
foor, or
not visible
from a
Wall and/or
window,
awning,
canopy, or
projecting.
1 per
tenant
space.
12 sf for
each tenant.
1 directory
sign not to
exceed 12
Below edge
of roof.
Near main
entrance.
Shall not
cover doors,
windows, or
Yes
public
street
sf is also
allowed to
identify
upper foor
occupants.
architectural
details.
--- --- --- --- --- --- --- ---
3.
Temporary
window
signs
Window
only.
No
maximum
number.
Shall not
exceed 20%
of total
window
area.
Within
ground foor
windows
only.
Within the
building
windows
No

Notes:

(1)

These requirements do not apply within the Downtown Novato Specific Plan (D) overlay. See Section 19.32.060.C instead.

(2)

In calculations, freestanding signs shall be assigned to the frontage closest to the sign; or if equidistant from two frontages, the sign may be assigned to either.

(Ord. No. 1576, § 2 (Exh. A, amd.), 10-23-2012)

19.32.070 - Standards for Specific Types of Signs.

Proposed signs shall comply with the following standards where applicable, in addition to the sign area and height limitations, and other requirements of Section 19.32.060 (Zoning District Sign Standards), and all other applicable provisions of this Division:

A.

Awning Signs. The following standards apply to awning signs in all zoning districts where allowed by Section 19.32.060 (Zoning District Sign Standards):

General Requirements.

a.

Signs on awnings are limited to ground level and second story occupancies only.

b.

Awnings shall not be internally illuminated. Indirect lighting may be allowed. Translucent awning materials are prohibited.

2.

Downtown (D) Overlay District. The following standards apply to awning signs in the Downtown (D) overlay, in addition to the requirements in Subsection A.1.:

a.

A business may use either an awning sign or storefront (wall or projecting) sign, but not both.

b.

Sign letter height shall not exceed eight inches.

c.

The use of logos or symbols depicting the unique nature of a business are encouraged on the sloped face of awnings, provided that their area shall not exceed 10 percent of the total sloped awning face. Logo or symbol area is defined by the smallest continuous line rectangle that can be drawn around the logo or symbol. Sign copy other than logos or symbols is prohibited on the sloped face of awnings.

B.

Freestanding Signs. The following standards apply to freestanding signs in all zoning districts where allowed by Section 19.32.060 (Zoning District Sign Standards):

1.

General Requirements.

a.

Sign height shall not exceed six feet. (See Section 19.32.050.B for measurement.).

b.

A sign may be placed only on a site frontage adjoining a public street.

c.

Multiple signs shall be separated by a minimum of 75 feet to ensure adequate visibility for all signs. The Director may waive this requirement where the locations of existing signs on adjacent properties would make the 75-foot separation impractical.

d.

The signs shall not project over public property, vehicular easements, or rights-of-way. Signs shall not obstruct traffic safety sight areas, as determined by the Director.

e.

To assist emergency response personnel in locating the site, freestanding signs should contain an illuminated street address plate. Numbers should be a minimum of six inches in height. Address plates shall not be calculated as part of the allowed sign area.

2.

Downtown (D) Overlay District. Freestanding signs are not allowed within the Downtown (D) overlay district except in the General Commercial (CG) zoning district.

C.

Murals. Murals may be permitted only within the Downtown (D) overlay district, on public structures, subject to review by the Novato Recreation Cultural & Community Services Commission and approval by the City Council, or in private structures by the Design Review Commission.

1.

Where allowed, murals are in addition to (not counted as part of) the sign area allowed by Section 19.32.060.C (Downtown (D) Overlay District Sign Standards).

2.

Murals that illustrate Novato history and the local setting as sources of inspiration are encouraged.

3.

The approval of a mural shall require that the Review Authority first find that the size, colors, and placement of the mural are visually compatible with the building architecture, and that the mural will serve to enhance the aesthetics of the downtown area.

D.

Projecting Signs. Projecting signs are allowed as follows:

1.

The maximum projection of a sign from a building wall over a public right-of-way shall not exceed 36 inches over a sidewalk, and 24 inches over a traffic way (e.g., an alley).

2.

The maximum height of a projecting sign shall not exceed 14 feet, eave height, parapet height, or sill height of a second floor window, whichever is less. No portion of the sign shall project above the eave line of a sloped roof or the top of the parapet on a flat roof.

A projecting sign shall be installed to maintain a minimum clearance of eight feet from the bottom of the sign to the finished grade below.

4.

Icon signs using shapes or symbols uniquely suited to the business, creative shapes and three-dimensional signs are encouraged.

5.

The sign shall be graphically designed for pedestrians, with a maximum area of nine square feet on each sign face, regardless of the length of the building frontage.

6.

Sign supports shall be well-designed and compatible with the design of the sign.

7.

Interior illuminated boxed display signs ("can" signs) are prohibited.

E.

Temporary Signs. Temporary signs are allowed subject to the following requirements, in addition to meeting the sight visibility requirements of Section 19.20.070D.:

1.

Construction Signs. Construction identification signs may be allowed in all zoning districts with Sign Permit approval, in compliance with the following standards:

a.

Only one sign, located on-site, shall be allowed;

b.

The area of the sign shall not exceed 32 square feet;

c.

Sign height shall not exceed six feet;

d.

The sign shall not be illuminated;

e.

A construction sign shall not be allowed if an on-site subdivision sign is approved.

f.

Construction signs shall be removed within 30 days after completion of construction.

2.

Off-Site Directional Signs. Because of the City's compelling interest in ensuring traffic safety, and the City's interest in improving public convenience, off-site directional signs may be allowed in compliance with the requirements of this Subsection, and subject to the approval of a Sign Permit.

a.

Where Allowed. Directional signs may be approved within the commercial zoning districts, only on sites where:

(1)

The Review Authority determines that a property owner has taken advantage of all permanent signs allowed by this Division, and site visibility remains seriously impaired; and

(2)

The structure to which directions are being provided is on a lot that is located more than 150 feet from a predominant public street frontage, the site is developed with all other signs allowed by this Division, and the business entry and the other exterior signs allowed for the site by this Division are not visible from the predominant public street. The "predominant public street" shall mean the major vehicular route that provides access to the site and surrounding area.

b.

Sign Standards. An approved directional sign shall comply with all the following requirements:

(1)

Number, size, and height limitations. Only one off-site directional sign shall be allowed. The sign shall not exceed an area of 4 square feet, and the height shall not exceed 6 feet.

(2)

Design and construction standards. The appearance of the sign, including any graphics and/or text, will reflect attractive, professional design, and that the sign will be durable and stable when in place.

(3)

Placement requirements. The sign shall be placed only on private property, at the location specified by the Sign Permit.

3.

Real Estate Signs. Real estate signs are allowed without a Sign Permit in compliance with California Civil Code Section 713, and subject to the following requirements:

a.

Commercial, Industrial, and Other Non-Residential Zoning Districts. Properties within commercial, industrial, and other non-residential zoning districts shall be allowed one real estate sign of no more than 6 square feet, with a maximum height for freestanding signs of 6 feet, for each parcel frontage.

b.

Residential Zoning Districts.

(1)

On-site Signs. One residential real estate sign not more than 6 square feet in area, advertising the sale or lease of a parcel or structure, may be located on the property it advertises.

(2)

Off-site Directional Signs. Off-site real estate directional signs not more than 6 square feet in area may be located on private property, provided that they do not obstruct or impede safe pedestrian or vehicular movement and are not secured to prevent removal. No real estate sign shall be permitted within the public right-of-way.

4.

Subdivision Directional Signs, Off-Site. Off-site signs providing directions to a new subdivision may be allowed with Sign Permit approval, and shall comply with the following standards:

a.

A maximum of two off-site signs may be located on private property (not within any public right-of-way).

b.

The total area of each sign shall not exceed 24 square feet;

c.

The height of each sign shall not exceed 6 feet;

d.

The signs shall not be illuminated;

e.

The signs may be displayed only during the two years following date of recordation of the final map, or until all of the units have been sold, whichever occurs first; and

f.

The signs shall not affect pedestrian or vehicular safety.

Subdivision Signs, On-Site. On-site subdivision identification signs may be allowed with Sign Permit approval, in compliance with the following standards:

a.

A maximum of two on-site signs may be located within the project boundaries, provided that no more than one sign per street frontage is allowed, and multiple signs shall be separated by a minimum of 75 feet.

b.

The area of each sign shall not exceed 32 square feet;

c.

Sign height shall not exceed 6 feet;

d.

The signs shall not be illuminated; and

e.

The signs may be displayed only during the two years following the date of recordation of the final map, or until all of the units have been sold, whichever occurs first.

6.

Temporary Signs Within Commercial Zoning Districts. Temporary on-site signs are allowed within commercial zoning districts without a Sign Permit for a maximum of 30 days after the opening of a new business, provided that the area of the temporary signs shall not exceed 50 percent of the total sign area allowed on the site by Section 19.32.060 (Zoning District Sign Standards).

7.

Community Event Signs. Temporary community event signs or banners (see Section 19.60.020 Sign - Civic Event Sign) may be located in the public right-of-way in accordance with the sight visibility area requirements of Section 19.20.070D and the following standards: Community event signs shall not exceed 24 square feet each or be more than six (6) feet in height. Community event signs are allowed for the duration of the event, but not more than 60 days, and shall be removed within 14 days after the event.

F.

Wall Signs. The following standards apply to wall signs in all zoning districts where allowed by Section 19.32.060 (Zoning District Sign Standards):

1.

General Requirements.

a.

Wall signs may be located on any primary or secondary building frontage.

b.

The area of the largest wall sign shall not exceed seven percent of the area of the building facade on which the sign is mounted or painted, including the area of windows, doors, and recesses.

c.

The signs shall not project from the surface upon which they are attached more than required for construction purposes and in no case more than 12 inches.

d.

The signs shall not project above the eave line or the edge of the roof of a building.

e.

The signs shall not be placed so as to interfere with the operation of a door or window.

2.

Downtown (D) Overlay District. Wall signs within the Downtown (D) overlay district shall comply with the following requirements, in addition to those in Subsection F.1 above:

a.

Location of Signs. Any building with exterior wall frontage on a street, alley, or off-street parking area may have a wall sign in each of those locations, subject to the sign area limitations of Section 19.32.060 (Zoning District Sign Standards). Wall signs facing alleys shall be allowed only when a business opens onto the alley.

b.

Maximum Letter Height. Wall sign letters shall not exceed a height of 12 inches.

c.

Maximum Sign Area. All wall signing shall fit within an area that is an architecturally consistent wall surface uninterrupted by doors, windows, or architectural details, and shall not exceed 15 percent of the surface area of the building facade, provided that:

(1)

The height of individual letters, an attached board sign or boxed sign shall not exceed 2/3 the height of the signable area;

(2)

Wall signing facing streets and off-site parking lots shall not exceed 40 percent of the signable area;

(3)

For individual letters, the area of the sign shall be calculated by drawing a box around each word of the display;

(4)

For boxed display graphics or board signs, the area of the sign shall be calculated as the total area of the display including lettering, background, and sign frame; and

(5)

An allowed wall sign facing an alley shall not exceed 10 square feet, which shall be allowed in addition to the maximum sign area allowed by Section 19.32.060.

G.

Window Signs. The following standards apply to window signs in all zoning districts where allowed:

1.

Maximum Sign Area. Permanent and temporary window signs shall not occupy more than 20 percent of the total window area.

2.

Permanent Window Signs.

a.

Signs shall be allowed only on windows located on the ground level and second story of a building frontage.

b.

Signage shall consist of individual letters, logos, or symbols applied to the glass surface; however, neon signs with transparent backgrounds may be hung inside the window glass line.

3.

Temporary Window Signs. Temporary window signs may be allowed provided that the signs:

a.

May be displayed inside a window for a maximum of 10 days.

b.

Shall only be located within the ground-floor windows of the structure.

(Ord. No. 1576, § 2 (Exh. A, amd.), 10-23-2012)

19.32.080 - Exceptions to Sign Area Standards.

The Director or other applicable Review Authority may grant exceptions to the allowed area of a sign if it is first determined that:

A.

The position or setback of the building on the site requires additional area for effective signing. The exception may increase the allowed sign area by up to 25 percent; or

B.

The exceptional size of the structures, uses, or site requires additional sign area for effective identification from major approaches to the site. The exception may increase the allowed sign area by up to 25 percent; or

C.

The name of the business or use to be identified is exceptionally long, so that sign readability would be impaired by crowding words into the allowable sign area. The exception may increase the allowed sign area by up to 25 percent; or

D.

Signing proposed is indistinguishable from the architecture itself (supergraphic design) or achieves the level of sculptural art.

(Ord. No. 1576, § 2 (Exh. A, amd.), 10-23-2012)

19.32.090 - Nonconforming Signs.

A nonconforming sign is any permanent or temporary sign that was legally established and maintained in compliance with the provisions of all applicable laws in effect at the time of original installation but that does not now comply with the provisions of this Zoning Ordinance.

A.

General Requirements. A nonconforming sign may not be:

1.

Changed to another nonconforming sign;

2.

Structurally altered to extend its useful life;

3.

Expanded;

4.

Reestablished after a business is discontinued for 30 days; or

5.

Reestablished after damage or destruction to 50 percent or more of the value of the sign, or its components, as determined by the Building Official.

B.

Abatement. After the expiration of the time period provided in Subsection D., signs not conforming to the provisions of this Chapter shall be brought into compliance or removed.

C.

Maintenance and Changes. During the time period provided in Subsection D., copy and face changes, nonstructural modifications and nonstructural maintenance (i.e., painting, rust removal) are allowed without a Sign Permit up to a maximum of 25 percent of the existing total area of the sign. Copy and face changes, and any nonstructural modifications exceeding 25 percent of the existing total area of the sign, and any structural changes must conform to all applicable standards of this Division.

D.

Amortization. Any nonconforming sign, regardless of material, that is designed and constructed to have a useful life 15 years or longer, shall be brought into compliance with the provisions applicable to the zoning district within 15 years of the effective date of this Section, except as follows:

1.

Abandonment. Notwithstanding the above, any discontinuance or abandonment of a nonconforming sign for 30 days or more shall result in a loss of legal nonconforming status of the sign.

2.

Annexed Areas. Signs in areas annexed to the City after the date of adoption of this Division that do not conform to the provisions of this Division, shall be regarded as nonconforming signs which may remain for the remaining amortization period provided by this Subsection.

3.

Extensions of Time. The owner of a nonconforming sign may apply under the provisions of this Section to the Director for an extension of time within which to terminate the nonconforming sign.

a.

Time and Manner of Application. An application for an extension of time within which to terminate a use made nonconforming by the provisions of this Section may be filed by the owner of the sign. The application shall be filed with the Director at least 90 days but no more than 180 days prior to the time established by this Subsection termination of the sign.

b.

Content of Application, Fees. The application shall state the grounds for requesting an extension of time. The filing fee for the application shall be the same as that for a Variance as is set forth in the schedule of fees established by resolution from time to time by the City Council.

c.

Hearing Procedure. The Director shall hear the application, and shall set the matter for hearing within 45 days of receipt of the application. All parties involved shall have the right to offer testimonial, documentary and tangible evidence bearing on the issues; may be represented by counsel; and shall have the right to confront

and cross-examine witnesses. Any relevant evidence may be admitted that is the sort of evidence upon which reasonable persons are accustomed to rely in the conduct of serious affairs. Any hearing under this section may be continued for a reasonable time for the convenience of a party or a witness. The decision of the hearing officer shall be final and subject to judicial review pursuant to Code of Civil Procedure section 1094.6.

d.

Approval of Extension, Findings. An extension under the provisions of this section shall be for a reasonable period of time commensurate with the investment involved, and shall be approved only if the Director makes all of the following findings, or other findings required by law:

(1)

The applicant has made a substantial investment (including but not limited to lease obligations) in the property or structure on or in which the nonconforming sign is located; the property or structure cannot be readily converted to another use; and the investment was made prior to the effective date of this Division.

(2)

The applicant will be unable to recoup their investment as of the date established for termination of the use.

(3)

The applicant has made good faith efforts to recoup the investment and to eliminate the sign or bring the sign into conformity with this Division.

E.

Nonconforming Sign Inventory. Within 120 days of the effective date of this Section, the City shall commence the identification and inventory of all signs within the City that are determined to be illegal or abandoned pursuant to the law that is in effect prior to the effective date of this Section. The inventory shall be completed, and amortization, and sign correction or removal, shall then occur in compliance with this Section, and Business and Professions Code Sections 5490 et seq.

(Ord. No. 1576, § 2 (Exh. A, amd.), 10-23-2012)

19.32.100 - Violations and Abatement.

A.

Public Nuisance Declared by Director. Any sign erected or maintained contrary to the provisions of this Division or that has exceeded the amortization period of Section 19.32.090D may be declared to be a public nuisance by the Director and proceedings for its removal may take place in compliance with Division 19.60 (Enforcement of Zoning Ordinance Provisions).

B.

Public Nuisance Declared by Council. The Director may ask the Council to declare a sign a public nuisance under the following conditions:

The sign is significantly damaged either in support structure or sign face, as determined by the Building Official.

2.

The sign is illegible either through fading, rusting, or erosion of the sign face or through faulty or missing illumination; or

3.

The sign is unsafe for vehicles or pedestrians.

C.

Removal of Abandoned Sign. A sign shall be removed by the owner or lessee of the premises upon which the sign is located when the business that it advertises is no longer conducted on the premises. If the owner or lessee fails to remove the sign, the Director shall give the owner 30 days written notice to remove it. Upon failure to comply with the notice, the Director may have the sign removed at the owner's expense. Proceedings for the removal of signs and/or support structures shall comply with Division 19.59 (Enforcement of Zoning Ordinance Provisions).

(Ord. No. 1576, § 2 (Exh. A, amd.), 10-23-2012)

19.32.110 - Appeal.

After denial of an application for a Sign Permit, the applicant may appeal the administrative action in compliance with Division 19.54 (Appeals). The Review Authority shall act to grant or deny the appeal within 60 days of receipt of the request for review/appeal.

(Ord. No. 1576, § 2 (Exh. A, amd.), 10-23-2012)

19.32.120 - Judicial Review.

Any permit issued or denied in compliance with this Division shall be subject to expedited judicial review in accordance with the time limits set forth in Code of Civil Procedure Sections 1094.8 et seq.

(Ord. No. 1576, § 2 (Exh. A, amd.), 10-23-2012)

DIVISION 19.34 - STANDARDS FOR SPECIFIC LAND USES

19.34.010 - Purpose of Division.

This Division provides site planning and development standards for land uses that are allowed by Article 2 (Zoning Districts, Allowable Land Uses, and Zone-Specific Standards) in individual or multiple zoning districts, and for activities that require special standards to mitigate their potential adverse impacts.

(Ord. No. 1576, § 2 (Exh. A, amd.), 10-23-2012)

19.34.020 - Applicability.

Land uses and activities covered by this Division shall comply with the provisions of the Sections applicable to the specific use, in addition to all other applicable provisions of this Zoning Ordinance.

A.

Where Allowed. The uses that are subject to the standards in this Division shall be located in compliance with the requirements of Article 2 (Zoning Districts, Allowable Land Uses, and Zone-Specific Standards).

B.

Land Use Permit Requirements. The uses that are subject to the standards in this Division shall be authorized by the Land Use Permit required by Article 2, except where a Land Use Permit requirement is established by this Division for a specific use.

(Ord. No. 1576, § 2 (Exh. A, amd.), 10-23-2012)

19.34.029 - Senate Bill 9 Development.

This Section provides the definitions, permit requirements, processing procedures, and standards for the establishment of a Senate Bill 9 Dwelling Unit proposed in compliance with California Government Code Section 65852.21 and Article 2 (Zoning Districts, Allowable Land Uses, and Zone Specific Standards) of this Title.

A.

Definitions. For the purposes of this section, terms used herein that are identical to the terms used in California Government Code Section 65852.21 shall have the same meaning as those terms defined in said Government Code Section. Where terms used herein are identical to the terms used in Section 19.60.020 (Definitions of Specialized Terms and Phrases), the definitions provided in this Section shall control, unless otherwise specified in this Section. Notwithstanding the foregoing, the definitions below shall apply to the following terms as used in this Section:

1.

Accessory Dwelling Unit (ADU). As defined in Section 19.34.030 (Accessory Dwelling Units).

2.

Car Share Vehicle. A vehicle available for sharing located in a Car Share Vehicle Facility approved by the City.

3.

Car Share Vehicle Facility. A facility of fixed location approved by the City to permit the storage, pick-up, and drop off of a Car Share Vehicle.

4.

Efficiency Unit. As defined in Section 17958.1 of the California Health and Safety Code.

5.

Existing Structure. An existing permitted or otherwise legal single-family dwelling.

Floor Area, Gross. As defined in Section 19.60.020 (Definitions of Specialized Terms and Phrases).

7.

Garage. As defined in Section 19.60.020 (Definitions of Specialized Terms and Phrases).

8.

High-Quality Transit Corridor. As defined in California Public Resources Code Section 21155.

9.

Living Area. The interior area of a dwelling unit, including basements and attics, but does not include a garage or any accessory structure.

10.

Lot, or Parcel. As defined in Section 19.60.020 (Definitions of Specialized Terms and Phrases).

11.

Major Transit Stop. As defined in California Public Resources Code Section 21064.3.

12.

Nonconforming Zoning Condition. A physical improvement on a parcel that does not conform with current zoning standards.

13.

Primary Dwelling Unit (or "primary unit," "primary dwelling," "primary single-family dwelling," "primary unit single-family dwelling," or "primary residence"). A permitted or otherwise legal single-family dwelling unit that is the main residential unit on a lot.

14.

Single-Family Dwelling. As defined in Section 19.60.020 (Definitions of Specialized Terms and Phrases).

15.

Senate Bill 9 (SB 9) Development. A proposed housing development containing no more than two residential units within a single-family zone, subject to the qualifying criteria and provisions contained in this Section and the provisions identified in California Government Code Section 65852.21.

16.

SB 9 Dwelling Unit. A dwelling unit that is developed using the provisions in this Section and the provisions identified in California Government Code Section 65852.21.

B.

Land Use, Zoning, Density & Eligibility. A SB 9 Development:

Represents a residential land use;

2.

Is allowed on lots zoned Rural Residential (RR), Very Low Density Residential (RVL), Low Density Residential (R1), and Medium Density Detached Residential (R4) as well as those properties zoned Planned District (PD) and assigned the Rural Residential (RR), Very Low Density Residential (RVL), Low Density Residential (R1) or Medium Density Detached Residential (R4) land use designations of the Novato General Plan;

3.

Is not subject to the density requirements of the Novato General Plan, or Novato Municipal Code, or the maximum density or unit count stipulated in any master plan and/or precise development plan;

4.

Shall only be allowed on parcels located in the single-family zones listed above under subsection B.2, provided that the parcel or the SB 9 Development meets all of the requirements set forth in Government Code Section 65852.21(a)(1)—(5).

C.

Maximum Number of Units. A SB 9 Development shall include no more than two dwelling units.

D.

Nonconforming Zoning Condition. Notwithstanding the provisions of Division 19.52 (Nonconforming Uses, Structure, and Parcels), the construction of a SB 9 Development satisfying the requirements of this Section and Government Code Section 65852.21 shall not be contingent on the correction of any existing Nonconforming Zoning Condition(s).

E.

Separate Sale or Conveyance. A SB 9 Dwelling Unit shall not be separately sold or conveyed from each other unless the dwelling units are subsequently located on separate parcels created under the provisions of Section 9-8 of Chapter IX (Land Subdivision) and Government Code Section 66411.7.

F.

Building Code. All local and state building code provisions applicable to dwelling units shall apply to SB 9 Developments. A SB 9 Dwelling Unit shall meet all building code provisions necessary to allow separate conveyance of the subject dwelling units. Compliance with such provisions will be determined at the time construction detail plans are submitted for a building permit, subject to review and approval by the Chief Building Official or their designee.

G.

Review Procedure. The City shall render a ministerial decision without a public hearing on a SB 9 Development application in accordance with the review procedures stipulated in Government Code Section 65852.21.

Notwithstanding the foregoing, the City may deny a SB 9 Development application if the Chief Building Official makes a written finding, based upon a preponderance of the evidence, that the proposed SB 9 Development project would have a specific, adverse impact upon public health and safety for which there is no feasible method to satisfactorily mitigate or avoid the specific, adverse impact.

H.

Appeal. The City's action to approve or deny a SB 9 Development is final and not subject to appeal.

I.

Easements. A SB 9 Dwelling Unit shall not encroach on any recorded or judicially decided easement.

J.

Effect of Other Ordinances, Policies, & Regulations. Unless otherwise specified by this Section, a SB 9 Development shall comply with all applicable ordinances, policies, and regulations of this Title. Accordingly, an applicant for a SB 9 Dwelling Unit is not entitled to construct such a development in any form of their choosing but rather must accept the development configuration meeting all applicable standards. If no form of an SB 9 Dwelling Unit can conform to all applicable ordinances, policies, and regulations of Novato Municipal Code then a property owner shall be entitled to deviate from applicable ordinances, policies, and regulations, in accordance with Government Code Section 65852.21(b)(2)(A).

K.

Rental Period. A SB 9 Dwelling Unit shall be rented to the same person or persons for a term longer than 30 days.

L.

Street Address Required. Street addresses shall be assigned to each dwelling unit in a SB 9 Development proposal to assist in emergency response. The street address shall match the primary dwelling unit followed by a unique alphabetical identifier.

M.

Development Standards & Permit Requirements. SB 9 Developments shall require the approval of both a Planning application approved by the Community Development Director and building permit(s) from the Building Division. Approval of a Planning application is required prior to the issuance of any building permit.

Development standards for SB 9 Developments are provided as follows:

1.

Minimum Unit Size. The minimum gross floor area shall be that which is required for an efficiency unit.

2.

Maximum Floor Area Ratio. The maximum floor area ratio shall be as required by the zoning district in which the SB 9 Development will be located, as specified in Article 2 of this Title.

Maximum Lot Coverage. The maximum lot coverage shall be as required by the zoning district in which the SB 9 Development will be located, as specified in Article 2 of this Title.

4.

Maximum Height. The maximum height shall be as required by the zoning district in which the SB 9 Development will be located, as specified in Article 2 of this Title. The height of a dwelling unit shall be measured in accordance with NMC Section 19.20.070.B. (Height Measurement).

5.

Setbacks. The setbacks applicable to a SB 9 Development project shall be as follows:

a.

Minimum side and rear setbacks of 4 feet.

b.

Minimum front setback as required by the zoning district in which the SB 9 Development will be located, as specified in Article 2 of this Title.

c.

Notwithstanding subsections a and b above, no setback shall be required for an existing structure or a SB 9 Dwelling Unit constructed in the same location and to the same dimensions as an existing structure.

6.

Fire Building Separation Requirement. A detached SB 9 Dwelling Unit shall maintain a minimum building separation distance of 3 feet from any other building(s) on the lot. Notwithstanding the foregoing, an SB 9 Dwelling Unit may be attached to another SB 9 Dwelling Unit.

N.

Architecture. A proposed SB 9 Development shall meet all applicable architecture standards provided by Division 19.27 (Residential Objective Architecture Standards). New additions to create an SB 9 Dwelling Unit shall be constructed using the same building material(s) and color(s) as the existing single-family dwelling to which the addition will be attached for the following architectural elements:

1.

Siding material(s);

2.

Roof pitch and material; and

3.

Doors, windows, and trim.

O.

Required Parking. One (1) off-street parking space per unit is required for a SB 9 Development, except as exempt pursuant to subsection 3 below, subject to the following design standards:

1.

Off-street parking for a SB 9 Dwelling Unit shall be made permanently available and independently accessible as described in Section 19.30.030 (General Parking Regulations).

2.

Off-street parking shall comply with applicable standards in Section 5-17.008.e of Chapter V (Development Standards), Subsection 19.20.070.D. (Sight Visibility Area Required), Subsection 19.20.100.E.4. (Pavement), and Section 19.30.070 (Parking Design Standards).

3.

Off-street parking is not required for a SB 9 Dwelling Unit in any of the following instances:

a.

The subject parcel is located within one-half mile walking distance of either:

(1)

a High-Quality Transit Corridor, as defined in this Section; or

(2)

a Major Transit Stop, as defined in this Section.

b.

When there is a Car Share Vehicle Facility, as defined in this Section, located within one block of the subject parcel.

P.

Noticing. The City's Planning Division shall prepare and issue a courtesy notice for a SB 9 Development in compliance with the provisions of Division 19.58.

Q.

Deed Restriction. A deed restriction, signed by the property owner(s) of record and the Community Development Director or designee, shall be recorded with the Marin County Recorder's office, listing the restrictions and limitations applicable to a SB 9 Dwelling Unit as identified below. Said deed restriction shall be recorded prior to the issuance of a certificate of occupancy for an SB 9 Dwelling Unit, shall run with the land, and shall be binding upon any future owners, heirs, or assigns. The deed restriction shall state:

1.

The SB 9 Dwelling Units shall not be individually sold separately from each other unless an urban lot split is approved pursuant to Government Code Section 66411.7 and other state and local laws and regulations

applicable thereto;

2.

A SB 9 Dwelling Unit shall be rented to the same person or persons for a term of 31 consecutive calendar days or longer;

3.

The restrictions shall be binding upon any successor in ownership of the property and lack of compliance with any provisions of applicable state and local law can result in legal action against the property owner, including revocation of any right to maintain a SB 9 Dwelling Unit on the property.

R.

Development Impact Fees. A SB 9 Dwelling Unit shall be subject to the development impact fees applicable to single-family residential development as defined by Novato City Council resolution, as may be amended or repealed and replaced from time to time.

S.

Time Limits & Extensions. A SB 9 Dwelling Unit permit granted pursuant to this Ordinance shall be subject to the time limits and extensions of time specified in Section 19.44.040.

T.

Preemption. In the event of an inconsistency between the provisions of this Section and Government Code Section 65852.21, as may be amended or renumbered from time to time, the latter shall prevail.

(Ord. No. 1725, § 5(Exh. A), 7-22-2025)

19.34.030 - Accessory Dwelling Units.

This section provides the definitions, permit requirements, processing procedures, and standards for the establishment of accessory dwelling units in compliance with California Government Code sections 66310— 66342 and article 2 (zoning districts, allowable land uses, and zone-specific standards) of this title.

A.

Definitions. For purposes of this section, terms used herein that are identical to the terms used in California Government Code sections 66310—66342 shall have the same meaning as those terms are defined in said Government Code section. Where terms used herein are identical to the terms used in section 19.60.020 (definitions of specialized terms and phrases), the definitions provided in this section shall control, unless otherwise specified in this section. Notwithstanding the foregoing, the definitions below shall apply to the following terms as used in this Section:

1.

Accessory Dwelling Unit (ADU). An attached or a detached residential dwelling unit that provides complete independent living facilities for one or more persons and is located on a lot with a proposed or existing primary residence. It shall include permanent provisions for living, sleeping, eating, cooking, and sanitation on the same

parcel as the single-family or multi-family dwelling is or will be situated. An accessory dwelling unit also includes the following:

a.

Efficiency Unit. As defined in section 17958.1 of the California Health and Safety Code.

b.

Manufactured Home. As defined in section 18007 of the Health and Safety Code.

c.

Attached Accessory Dwelling Unit. A new residential dwelling unit that is constructed as a physical expansion (e.g., building addition) of an existing primary residence by way of one or more common walls or included as an attached component of a proposed primary residence.

d.

Detached Accessory Dwelling Unit. A new residential dwelling unit that is located on the same lot as a primary residence and is not physically attached (e.g., no common wall or roof, etc.) to a primary residence.

e.

Conversion Accessory Dwelling Unit. A dwelling unit created within existing walls of a primary dwelling unit or accessory structure.

2.

Accessory Structure. A structure that is accessory and incidental to a primary dwelling located on the same lot.

3.

Car Share Vehicle. A vehicle available for sharing located in a car share vehicle facility approved by the city.

4.

Car Share Vehicle Facility. A facility of fixed location approved by the city to permit the storage, pick-up, and drop-off of a car share vehicle.

5.

Existing Structure. An existing permitted or otherwise legal single-family dwelling, multi-family dwelling, or accessory structure.

6.

Junior Accessory Dwelling Unit. As defined in section 19.34.031 (junior accessory dwelling unit).

7.

High-Quality Transit Corridor. As defined in California Public Resources Code section 21155.

8.

Livable Space. Space in a dwelling intended for human habitation, including living, sleeping, eating, cooking, or sanitation.

9.

Living Area. The interior habitable area of a dwelling unit, including basements and attics, but does not include a garage or any accessory structure.

10.

Lot, or Parcel. As defined in section 19.60.020 (definitions of specialized terms and phrases).

11.

Major Transit Stop. As defined in California Public Resources Code section 21155.

12.

Multi-Family Dwelling. A building with two or more attached dwelling units located in a residential or mixed-use zoning district. This definition includes, but is not limited to duplexes, triplexes, apartments, and condominiums under common ownership.

13.

Nonconforming Zoning Condition. A physical improvement on a property that does not conform with current zoning standards.

14.

Passageway. A pathway that is unobstructed clear to the sky and extends from a street to one entrance of the accessory dwelling unit.

15.

Primary Dwelling Unit (or "primary unit," "primary dwelling," "primary single-family dwelling," "primary unit single-family dwelling," or "primary residence"): A permitted or otherwise legal single-family dwelling that is the main residential unit on a lot and is larger than any proposed ADU; or a permitted or otherwise legal multifamily dwelling unit on a lot zoned for residential or mixed-use. For any lot with an existing residential unit, the existing residential unit shall be the primary dwelling unit and any proposed new accessory dwelling unit(s) shall be required to qualify under this code as one of the permitted types of accessory dwelling units.

16.

Proposed Dwelling. A new single-family or multi-family dwelling that is the subject of a permit application and that meets the requirements for permitting.

17.

Public Transit. A location, including, but not limited to, a bus stop or train station, where the public may access buses, trains, subways, and other forms of transportation that charge set fares, run on fixed routes, and are

available to the public.

18.

Single-Family Dwelling. As defined in division 19.60 (definitions/glossary).

19.

Story. As defined in division 19.60 (definitions/glossary).

20.

Tandem Parking. Two or more automobiles parked on a driveway or in any other location on a lot, lined up one behind the other.

B.

Land Use, Zoning and Density. An accessory dwelling unit:

1.

Represents a residential land use;

2.

Is not subject to the density requirements of the Novato General Plan or this title;

3.

Is allowed on any lot when combined with an existing permitted, otherwise legal, or proposed single-family or multi-family dwelling in a residential or mixed-use zone as specified in the land use tables of Article 2; and

4.

Is allowed on any lot zoned planned district (PD) when combined with an existing or proposed single-family or multi-family dwelling, where such primary dwelling types are a permitted use in an adopted master plan or precise development plan.

C.

Maximum Number of Units.

1.

Single-Family Dwellings. A maximum of one accessory dwelling unit shall be allowed on a lot with an existing or a proposed primary single-family dwelling. Only one accessory dwelling unit shall be permitted per lot regardless of there being multiple, existing detached single-family dwellings on a given lot. An accessory dwelling unit may also be constructed on a lot with a junior accessory dwelling unit subject to the provisions of this section.

2.

Multi-family Dwellings. As specified in subsections 19.34.030.N.2.c. and 19.34.030.N.2.d.

D.

Nonconforming Zoning Condition. Notwithstanding the provisions of division 19.52 (nonconforming uses, structures, and parcels), the construction of an accessory dwelling unit pursuant to this section shall not be contingent on the correction of any existing nonconforming zoning condition as defined by this section.

E.

Nonconforming Single-Family Dwelling (Land Use Conformity). An accessory dwelling unit shall be allowed on lots where an existing single-family dwelling maintains a legal nonconforming land use status in accordance with NMC section 19.52.020 (restrictions on nonconforming uses and structures). Such a non-conforming single-family dwelling shall only be eligible to have an accessory dwelling unit created from conversion of a portion of the existing, legal nonconforming single-family dwelling or existing, legal nonconforming residential accessory structure associated with the single-family dwelling in accordance with the development standards specified in subsection 19.34.030.N.2.b. and all other applicable provisions of this section.

F.

Separate Sale or Conveyance. Except as provided by Government Code section 66314, an accessory dwelling unit shall not be sold or conveyed separately from the primary dwelling unit on a qualifying a lot for development of an accessory dwelling unit. An accessory dwelling unit may be rented separately from the primary dwelling unit.

G.

Building Code. All local and state building code provisions applicable to dwelling units shall apply to accessory dwelling units, except as modified by this section in accordance with state law.

H.

Fire Sprinklers. Fire sprinklers shall not be required for an accessory dwelling unit if not required for the primary dwelling unit. The construction of an accessory dwelling unit shall not trigger a requirement for fire sprinklers to be installed in an existing primary dwelling.

I.

Easements. Accessory dwelling units shall not be permitted to encroach on any recorded or judicially decided easement.

J.

Effect of Other Ordinances, Policies, and Regulations. Unless otherwise specified by this section, accessory dwelling units shall comply with all applicable ordinances, policies, and regulations of this title. Accordingly, an applicant for an accessory dwelling unit shall modify a proposed accessory dwelling unit or select another of the herein listed accessory dwelling unit types (e.g., attached, detached or conversion) in order to comply with all applicable ordinances, policies, and regulations of this title.

K.

Rental Period. An accessory dwelling unit shall be rented to the same person or persons for a term of 30 days or longer.

L.

Certificate of Occupancy. A certificate of occupancy for an accessory dwelling unit shall not be issued before a certificate of occupancy is issued for a primary dwelling unit.

M.

Street Address Required. Street addresses shall be assigned to an accessory dwelling unit to assist in emergency response. The street address shall match that of the primary dwelling unit followed by a unique alphabetical identifier (e.g., 1000A Main Street for an ADU associated with a primary dwelling unit of 1000 Main Street).

N.

Development Standards and Permit Requirements for Specific Accessory Dwelling Units. California Government Code sections 66310—66342 establishes different accessory dwelling unit categories and applicable development standards for each accessory dwelling unit category, including those that must be permitted solely by building permit pursuant to compliance with prescribed objective development standards and others subject to all applicable objective development standards.

Accessory dwelling units shall only require a building permit and are subject to development standards as described below. If a building permit application to create an accessory dwelling unit is submitted concurrently with a permit application to create a new primary dwelling unit on the same lot, a decision on the accessory dwelling unit will be deferred until an action is taken on the permit application to create the new primary dwelling unit. If the application for the primary dwelling unit is approved, then the proposed accessory dwelling unit shall be ministerially approved if it meets the requirements of this section and applicable state law. Development standards for each category of accessory dwelling unit, as addressed by California Government Code sections 66310—66342, are provided as follows.

1.

Accessory Dwelling Unit Development Standards. A proposed accessory dwelling unit that complies with the following development standards and all applicable objective standards contained in ordinances, policies, and regulations of this title, shall be approved ministerially and shall only be subject to the issuance of a building permit.

a.

Attached Accessory Dwelling Unit.

(1)

Unit Size.

i.

The maximum gross floor area shall be 50 percent of the living area of the existing or proposed primary dwelling unit up to a maximum floor area of 850 square feet for a studio or one bedroom unit or 1,000 square feet for a unit of two or more bedrooms. A minimum of two bedrooms are required for any unit over 850 square feet in floor area.

(2)

Maximum Floor Area Ratio. As specified in article 2 based on applicable zoning district.

(3)

Maximum Building Coverage. As specified in article 2 based on applicable zoning district.

(4)

Setbacks:

i.

Minimum side and rear setbacks of 4 feet.

ii.

Minimum front setback as required by the zoning district applicable to the primary dwelling as specified in article 2 of this title.

(5)

Fire Protection Building Separation Requirement. An attached accessory dwelling unit shall maintain a minimum building separation distance of 3 feet from any other building(s) on the lot.

(6)

Height Limit. Maximum height of 25 feet or the height limitation in the underlying zone, whichever is lower. The height of an accessory dwelling unit shall be measured in accordance with subsection 19.20.070.B (height measurement). Architectural, decorative, and other roof elements (i.e., mechanical equipment, roof vents, chimney etc.) attached to the accessory dwelling unit shall not exceed this height limit. An attached ADU shall not exceed two stories.

(7)

Separate Entry. A separate exterior entryway shall be required independent of the primary dwelling unit's entry.

(8)

Interior Connection. An attached accessory dwelling unit shall not have any interior passageway (e.g., doorway, pass-through, etc.) connecting to the interior space of the primary dwelling unit.

b.

Detached Accessory Dwelling Unit.

(1)

Unit Size.

i.

The maximum gross floor area shall be 50 percent of the living area of the existing or proposed primary dwelling unit up to a maximum floor area of 850 square feet for a studio or one bedroom unit or 1,000 square feet for a unit of two or more bedrooms. A minimum of two bedrooms are required for any unit over 850 square feet in floor area.

(2)

Maximum Floor Area Ratio. As specified by the zoning district applicable to the primary dwelling as specified in article 2 of this title.

(3)

Maximum Building Coverage. As specified by the zoning district applicable to the primary dwelling as specified in article 2 of this title.

(4)

Setbacks.

i.

Minimum side and rear setbacks of 4 feet.

ii.

Minimum front setback as required by the zoning district applicable to the primary dwelling as specified in article 2 of this title.

(5)

Fire Protection Building Separation Requirement. A detached accessory dwelling unit shall maintain a minimum building separation distance of 3 feet from any other building(s) on the lot.

(6)

Height Limit. Maximum height of 16 feet or; maximum height of 18 feet for a detached accessory dwelling unit that is within one-half mile walking distance of a major transit stop or high-quality transit corridor and an additional 2 feet is allowed only to the extent that it is necessary to accommodate a roof pitch aligned with that of the primary dwelling unit. The height of an accessory dwelling unit shall be measured in accordance with subsection 19.20.070.B (height measurement). Architectural, decorative, and other roof elements (i.e., mechanical equipment, roof vents, chimney etc.) attached to the accessory dwelling unit shall not exceed this height limit.

c.

Statewide Default Accessory Dwelling Unit. Notwithstanding the maximum unit size based on living area percentage, floor area ratio, open space, front setbacks, minimum lot size, and/or lot coverage standards provided above, an applicant shall be entitled to construct a detached or attached accessory dwelling unit of up to a maximum gross floor area of 800 square feet, 16-feet in height, with 4-foot side and rear setbacks. The height of an accessory dwelling unit shall be measured in accordance with subsection 19.20.070.B (height measurement). Notwithstanding the provisions of subsection 19.20.070.C (exceptions to height limits),

architectural, decorative, and other roof elements (i.e., mechanical equipment, roof vents, chimney etc.) attached to the accessory dwelling unit may not exceed this height limit.

2.

Limited Standards Accessory Dwelling Units. The following types of ADUs shall only be subject to the development standards of this subsection as required by and consistent with California Government Code section 66323. An ADU meeting the development standards of this section shall only be subject to securing a building permit.

a.

Detached Accessory Dwelling Unit—On Lots With Existing or Proposed Primary Unit Single-Family Dwellings.

(1)

Unit Size.

i.

The maximum gross floor area permitted shall be 800 square feet.

(2)

Setbacks.

i.

Minimum side and rear setbacks of 4 feet.

(3)

Fire Protection Building Separation Requirement. A detached accessory dwelling unit shall maintain a minimum building separation distance that is sufficient for fire and safety.

(4)

Height Limit. Maximum height of 16 feet or; maximum height of 18 feet for a detached accessory dwelling unit that is within one-half mile walking distance of a major transit stop or high-quality transit corridor and an additional 2 feet is allowed only to the extent that it is necessary to accommodate a roof pitch aligned with that of the primary dwelling unit.

b.

Conversion Accessory Dwelling Units—Within Existing Primary Unit Single-Family Dwellings, Proposed Primary Unit Single-Family Dwellings and Existing Accessory Structures.

(1)

Unit Size.

i.

An accessory dwelling unit is not subject to a maximum floor area limit when created within the walls of an existing or proposed primary unit single-family dwelling or existing accessory structure. However, an addition of up to 150 square feet for the sole purpose of accommodating ingress and egress is allowed for an existing accessory structure being converted to an accessory dwelling unit.

(2)

Setbacks.

i.

An accessory dwelling unit being created within the walls of an existing single-family dwelling or existing accessory structure shall not expand the footprint of the existing primary unit dwelling or accessory structure. However, an addition of up to 150 square feet for the sole purpose of accommodating ingress and egress is allowed for an existing accessory structure being converted to an accessory dwelling unit.

ii.

Minimum side and rear setbacks sufficient to provide for fire and safety shall be required where an addition of up to 150 square feet is proposed.

(3)

Height Limit. An accessory dwelling unit created within the living area of an existing single-family dwelling or within the area of an existing accessory structure shall maintain the height of the existing dwelling or accessory structure. An accessory dwelling unit created within the floor area of a proposed primary unit single-family residence shall be subject to the height limit of the zoning district applicable to the primary dwelling as specified in article 2 of this title.

(4)

Separate Entry. A separate exterior accessible entryway shall be required independent of the primary dwelling unit's entryway.

c.

Conversion Accessory Dwelling Units—Existing Multi-Family Dwellings.

(1)

Location. Accessory dwelling units shall only be allowed through the conversion of existing multi-family building space that is not used as livable space (e.g., storage rooms, boiler rooms, passageways, attics, basements, or garages) and only when the proposed unit(s) complies with state building standards for dwellings.

(2)

Number of Multi-Family Dwelling Conversion Accessory Dwelling Units. A minimum of one (1) conversion accessory dwelling unit shall be permitted and up to a maximum number not exceeding 25 percent of the existing multi-family dwelling units. Any fractional/decimal result of a calculation to determine the number of

accessory dwelling units in a multi-family unit shall be rounded down to the next whole unit (e.g., 7 multi-family units allows a maximum of 1 accessory dwelling unit).

(3)

Unit Size.

i.

The maximum gross floor area shall be equal to the area of the existing multi-family building space that is not used as livable space (e.g., storage rooms, boiler rooms, passageways, attics, basements, or garages) and is being converted to accessory dwelling unit(s).

(4)

Setbacks. Not applicable. A multi-family dwelling conversion accessory dwelling unit(s) shall not expand the existing multi-family building footprint.

(5)

Maximum Height. The multi-family dwelling conversion accessory dwelling units shall not exceed the height of the existing building area being converted to an accessory dwelling unit.

(6)

Separate Entry. A separate entryway shall be provided for each accessory dwelling unit.

d.

Detached Accessory Dwelling Unit—Multi-Family Dwellings.

(1)

Number of Detached Accessory Dwelling Units. A maximum of two detached accessory dwelling units shall be allowed on a lot with a proposed multi-family dwelling, and up to a maximum of eight (8) detached accessory dwelling units shall be allowed on a lot with an existing multi-family dwelling unit, provided that the number of accessory dwelling units does not exceed the number of existing units on the lot.

(2)

Setbacks.

i.

Minimum side and rear setbacks of 4 feet.

(3)

Height Limit. Maximum height of 16 feet or; maximum height of 18 feet for a detached accessory dwelling unit that is within one-half mile walking distance of a major transit stop or high-quality transit corridor and an additional 2 feet is allowed only to the extent that it is necessary to accommodate a roof pitch aligned with that

of the primary dwelling unit; or maximum height of 18 feet for a detached accessory dwelling unit on a lot with an existing or proposed multi-story multi-family dwelling.

O.

Architecture.

1.

A proposed accessory dwelling unit(s) and proposed primary dwelling shall meet all applicable architecture standards provided by division 19.27 (residential objective architecture standards).

2.

An accessory dwelling unit combined with an existing primary dwelling and located within a required front and/or street side setback area, shall be constructed and painted to match the primary dwelling, using the same:

a.

Paint color(s);

b.

Siding material(s) and style(s);

c.

Roof pitch, material(s), and color(s); and

d.

Door(s), window(s), and trim.

3.

The provisions of this subsection shall not apply to the accessory dwelling unit types addressed in subsection 19.34.030.N.2.

P.

Historic Resources. The following criteria shall apply to accessory dwelling units on properties listed in the California Register of Historic Resources or designated as a local historic resource. The provisions of this subsection shall not apply to the accessory dwelling unit types addressed in subsection 19.34.030.N.2.

1.

The applicant shall submit a historic resource survey prepared by a qualified professional addressing whether the proposed accessory dwelling unit will negatively impact historic resource(s) and is consistent with the Secretary of the Interior's Standards for the Treatment of Historic Properties.

The accessory dwelling unit shall not be a replica of the architectural style of the historic structure(s) on the property;

3.

The accessory dwelling unit shall be consistent with the Secretary of the Interior's Standards for the Treatment of Historic Properties.

Q.

Required Parking.

1.

Off-Street Parking. In addition to required parking for the primary dwelling unit, one (1) off-street parking space is required for an accessory dwelling unit, except as exempt pursuant to subsection d. below, subject to the following design standards:

a.

Off-street parking for an accessory dwelling unit is allowed via installation of a new independent parking stall or by tandem parking on a driveway within a required setback area, unless findings are made that such parking is infeasible based on site specific topographical, fire, and/or life safety conditions.

b.

Off-street parking shall comply with applicable standards in subsection 5-17.008.e of chapter V (development standards), subsection 19.20.070.D. (sight visibility area required), subsection 19.20.100.E.4. (pavement), and subsection 19.30.070 (parking design standards) of the Novato Municipal Code.

c.

Off-Street parking is not required for an accessory dwelling unit in any of the following instances:

(1)

The accessory dwelling unit is located within one-half mile walking distance of public transit as defined in this section.

(2)

The accessory dwelling unit is located within an architecturally and historically significant historic district.

(3)

The accessory dwelling unit is part of a proposed or existing primary residence or existing accessory structure converted to accommodate an accessory dwelling unit.

(4)

When on-street parking permits are required but not offered to the occupant of the accessory dwelling unit.

(5)

When there is a car share vehicle facility, as defined in this section, located within one block of the accessory dwelling unit.

(6)

When a permit application for an accessory dwelling unit is submitted with a permit application to create a new primary dwelling unit on the same lot, provided that the accessory dwelling unit or the parcel satisfies any other criteria listed in this paragraph.

d.

Primary Dwelling Parking. Where an existing garage, carport, uncovered parking space, or covered parking structure is demolished or converted to create an accessory dwelling unit then those off-street parking spaces are not required to be replaced.

2.

The provisions of this subsection shall not apply to the accessory dwelling unit types addressed in subsection 19.34.030.N.2.

R.

Submittal Requirements. The submittal requirements for accessory dwelling units are those required by the community development department for a building permit.

S.

Noticing. The city's planning division shall prepare, and issue a courtesy notice for an accessory dwelling unit in compliance with the provisions of division 19.58.

T.

Deed Restriction. A deed restriction, signed by the property owner(s) of record and the community development director or designee, shall be recorded with the Marin County Recorder's office, listing the restrictions and limitations of an accessory dwelling unit as identified below. Said deed restriction shall be recorded prior to the final occupancy of an accessory dwelling unit and run with the land, and shall be binding upon any future owners, heirs, or assigns. The deed restriction shall state:

1.

The accessory dwelling unit shall not be sold separately from the primary dwelling unit, except as provided by Government Code section 66341;

2.

The accessory dwelling unit shall be rented to the same person or persons for a term of 30 consecutive calendar days or longer;

3.

The restrictions shall be binding upon any successor in ownership of the property and lack of compliance with any provisions of section 19.34.030 can result in legal action against the property owner, including revocation

of any right to maintain an accessory dwelling unit on the property.

The provisions of this subsection shall not apply to the accessory dwelling unit types addressed in subsection 19.34.030.N.2.

U.

Development Impact Fees. Accessory dwelling units that are less than 750 square feet in floor area are not subject to paying development impact fees. Accessory dwelling units that are 750 square feet or larger in floor area shall pay development impact fees charged proportionally in relation to the square footage of the primary dwelling unit.

V.

Unpermitted Accessory Dwelling Unit. An unpermitted ADU that was constructed before January 1, 2020, can be permitted pursuant to the provisions of Government Code section 66332.

(Ord. No. 1576, § 2 (Exh. A, amd.), 10-23-2012; Ord. No. 1595, § 2(Exh. A), 12-16-2014; Ord. No. 1637, § 3(Exh. A), 2-27-2018; Ord. No. 1676, Exh. A, 3-8-2022; Ord. No. 1721, § 4(Exh. A), 1-28-2025)

19.34.031 - Junior Accessory Dwelling Units.

This Section provides standards for the establishment of junior accessory dwelling units in compliance with California Government Code §65852.22 and Article 2 (Zoning Districts, Allowable Land Uses, and ZoneSpecific Standards) of this Title.

A.

Definitions. The definitions below shall apply to the following terms as used in this Section:

1.

Efficiency Kitchen. A kitchen with the minimum following components:

a.

A sink with a minimum width and length of 16-inches and a waste line diameter of 1.5 inches;

b.

A cooking facility or appliance that uses electrical service, natural gas, or propane gas; and

c.

A food preparation counter and storage cabinets that are 6-feet in length.

2.

Junior Accessory Dwelling Unit (JADU). A dwelling unit that is accessory to and located within the walls of a legal primary single-family dwelling on the same site. A junior accessory dwelling unit provides independent living facilities for one or more persons, including permanent provisions for living, sleeping, eating, and cooking. Cooking and food preparation facilities shall meet the minimum definition of an "Efficiency Kitchen" as

defined by A.1. above. Bathroom facilities may be independently provided for the junior accessory dwelling unit or may be shared with occupants of the primary dwelling.

3.

Nonconforming Zoning Condition. A physical improvement on a property that does not conform with current zoning standards.

4.

Proposed Dwelling. A new single-family dwelling that is the subject of a permit application and that meets the requirements for permitting.

5.

Single-Family Dwelling. As defined in Division 19.60 (Definitions/Glossary).

B.

Land Use. Junior accessory dwelling units represent a residential land use and are not required to meet the density requirements of the Novato General Plan or this Title. Junior accessory dwelling units are an allowed land use where single-family dwellings are permitted by zoning as listed in the land use tables of Article 2 subject to meeting the provisions of this section, as well as on lots where an existing single-family dwelling maintains legal nonconforming land use status in accordance with NMC Section 19.52.020 (Restrictions on Nonconforming Uses and Structures).

C.

Maximum Number of Units. A maximum of one junior accessory dwelling unit shall be allowed on a lot within the walls of an existing or a proposed primary single-family dwelling unit.

D.

Accessory Dwelling Unit Combined. An accessory dwelling unit may also be constructed on a lot with a junior accessory dwelling unit subject to the provisions of Section 19.34.030 of this Title.

E.

Nonconforming Zoning Condition. Notwithstanding the provisions of Division 19.52 (Nonconforming Uses, Structures, and Parcels), the construction of a junior accessory dwelling unit shall not be contingent on the correction of any existing nonconforming zoning condition as defined herein.

F.

Separate Sale or Conveyance. A junior accessory dwelling unit shall not be sold or conveyed separately from the single-family dwelling in which it is located.

G.

Building Code. All local and state building code provisions applicable to dwelling units shall apply to junior accessory dwelling units.

H.

Rental Period. A junior accessory dwelling unit shall not be rented for a period of less than 30-days. A junior accessory dwelling unit shall not be used as a short-term rental.

I.

Certificate of Occupancy. A certificate of occupancy for a junior accessory dwelling unit shall not be issued before a certificate of occupancy is issued for a new primary single-family dwelling within which the junior accessory dwelling unit will be located.

J.

Street Address Required. Street addresses shall be assigned to all junior accessory dwellings to assist in emergency response. The street address shall match the primary dwelling followed by a unique alphabetical identifier (e.g., 1000A Main Street for a JADU associated with a primary dwelling of 1000 Main Street).

K.

Owner Occupancy. The owner of a parcel proposed for a junior accessory dwelling unit shall occupy the primary dwelling unit or junior accessory dwelling unit as their principal residence. Owner occupancy shall not be required if the owner is another governmental agency, land trust, or non-profit housing organization as defined by Government Code section 65589.5.

L.

Development Standards. Junior accessory dwelling units shall comply with the following standards as addressed by California Government Code Section 65852.22.

1.

Unit Size: The maximum gross floor area allowed for a junior accessory dwelling unit is 500 square feet.

2.

Setbacks: A junior accessory dwelling unit shall be located entirely within the footprint of an existing or proposed single-family dwelling.

3.

Height Limit: Existing height of the area being converted to a junior accessory dwelling unit or the maximum height approved for a proposed single-family residence within which the junior accessory dwelling unit will be located.

4.

Efficiency Kitchen. A junior accessory dwelling unit shall include an efficiency kitchen.

5.

Separate Exterior Entry. A separate exterior entryway shall be provided independent of the primary dwelling unit's entryway.

Internal Doorway Connection. A common interior doorway shall be provided to connect a junior accessory dwelling unit to the living area of the primary single-family dwelling.

M.

Permit Requirement & Review Procedure. A junior accessory dwelling unit requires only a building permit. If a building permit application to create junior accessory dwelling unit is submitted concurrently with a permit application to create a new single-family dwelling on the same lot, action on the junior accessory dwelling unit will be deferred until an action is taken on the permit application to create the new single-family residence.

N.

Submittal Requirements. The submittal requirements for a building permit for a junior accessory dwelling unit are established by separate policy published by the Community Development Director.

O.

Deed Restriction. Prior to obtaining a certificate of occupancy for a junior accessory dwelling unit, a deed restriction, signed by the owner(s) of record and the Community Development Director or designee, shall be recorded with the County Recorder's office, which shall include the pertinent restrictions and limitations applicable to a junior accessory dwelling unit identified in this Section. Said deed restriction shall run with the land, and shall be binding upon any future owners, heirs, or assigns. The recorded deed restriction shall state that:

1.

The junior accessory dwelling unit shall not be sold separately from the primary dwelling unit;

2.

The junior accessory dwelling unit may not be rented for a period of less than 30 consecutive calendar days;

3.

The junior accessory dwelling unit is restricted to the maximum size allowed per the development standards in Novato Municipal Code Section 19.34.031 (Junior Accessory Dwelling Units).

4.

The junior accessory dwelling unit shall be considered legal only so long as the primary dwelling is occupied by the owner of record of the property, unless the owner is another governmental agency, land trust, or non-profit housing organization;

5.

The restrictions shall be binding upon any successor in ownership of the property and lack of compliance with any provisions of Section 19.34.031, may result in legal action against the property owner, including revocation of any right to maintain a junior accessory dwelling unit on the property.

P.

On-Site Parking. No on-site parking is required for a junior accessory dwelling unit.

Q.

Replacement Parking. Where an existing attached garage providing conforming parking for a single-family dwelling is converted to create a junior accessory dwelling unit then those off-street parking stalls shall be replaced on-site by providing uncovered parking stalls complying with the requirements of subsection 19.20.100.E.4., subsection 19.30.070.D.2.a., subsection 19.30.080.A. of this Title and subsection 5-17.008.e. of Novato Municipal Code chapter V. Notwithstanding subsection 19.20.100.E.3. of this title, replacement parking can be located in a required front yard setback. Notwithstanding the requirements of subsection 19.30.030.A, replacement parking can be provided in a tandem configuration.

tion 19.20.100.E.4., subsection 19.30.070.D.2.a., subsection 19.30.080.A. of this Title and subsection 5-17.008.e. of Novato Municipal Code chapter V. Notwithstanding subsection 19.20.100.E.3. of this title, replacement parking can be located in a required front yard setback. Notwithstanding the requirements of subsection 19.30.030.A, replacement parking can be provided in a tandem configuration.

R.

Noticing. A courtesy notice shall be issued for junior accessory dwelling unit in compliance with division 19.58.

S.

Unpermitted Junior Accessory Dwelling Unit. An unpermitted JADU that was constructed before January 1, 2020, can be permitted pursuant to the provisions of Government Code section 66332.

(Ord. No. 1595, § 2(Exh. A), 12-16-2014; Ord. No. 1637, § 3(Exh. A), 2-27-2018; Ord. No. 1676, Exh. A, 3-82022; Ord. No. 1721, § 4(Exh. A), 1-28-2025)

19.34.032 - Accessory Residential Uses and Structures.

Where allowed in the applicable zoning district by Article 2 (Zoning Districts, Allowable Land Uses, and ZoneSpecific Standards), accessory residential uses and structures shall comply with the following criteria and standards. Accessory dwellings are instead subject to the provisions of Section 19.34.030 (Accessory Dwelling Units).

A.

Relationship of Accessory Use or Structure to the Main Use. Accessory uses and structures shall be incidental to and not alter the main use or character of the site.

B.

Timing of Installation. An accessory structure shall be constructed concurrent with or subsequent to the construction of a main structure on the property unless a Use Permit is first obtained in compliance with Section 19.42.050 (Use Permits).

C.

Building Code. The location of all accessory structures shall comply with all applicable Building Code standards.

D.

Location.

A structure greater than 18 inches in height above finished grade and attached to a main structure shall comply with the setback requirements for the main structure.

2.

An accessory structure larger than 40 square feet shall not be located closer than 3 feet to a main structure or closer than 3 feet to any other accessory structure on the same property.

3.

An accessory structure shall not be located closer than 3 feet to a rear or side property line. An accessory structure that is 40 square feet or less in size may be allowed within 3 feet of a side or rear property line provided that it does not exceed 6 feet in height.

4.

A detached deck or patio greater than 18 inches in height measured from finished grade shall not be constructed in required yard areas unless design review approval is first obtained in accordance with Section 19.42.030 (Design Review).

5.

An accessory structure shall not be located in a required front yard, except that decorative garden structures (e.g., small trellis or archway) shall be allowed.

6.

Accessory structures may occupy up to a maximum of 25 percent of a required side yard and up to a maximum of 30 percent of a required rear yard.

7.

Guest houses shall comply with the setback requirements of the main structure.

8.

Mechanical equipment (i.e., air conditioning, heating unit, pool and spa pumps, etc.) located within 15 feet of a side property line shall be sound attenuated in a manner acceptable to the Director. Equipment enclosures shall not be included in the coverage and size limitations set forth in Section H. below (see 19.22.040 Electrical and Mechanical Equipment).

E.

Maximum Number of Accessory Structures. A maximum of two accessory structures shall be allowed unless design review approval is first obtained in compliance with Section 19.42.030 (Design Review).

F.

Height Limitations.

The height of an accessory structure shall not exceed 12 feet unless design review approval is first obtained in accordance with Section 19.42.030 (Design Review).

2.

An accessory structure located within a required side or rear yard shall not exceed eight feet in height unless design review approval is first obtained in accordance with Section 19.42.030 (Design Review).

3.

An accessory structure that is primarily a narrow, vertical element (e.g., flag pole, ham radio antenna, etc.) may be allowed to exceed the 12-foot height limit within the front or rear yard setback, provided that design review approval is first obtained in accordance with Section 19.42.030 (Design Review).

4.

A guest house shall not exceed 16 feet in height.

G.

Coverage and Size Limitations.

1.

The aggregate site coverage of accessory structures in residential districts shall not exceed the lesser of five percent of the lot area, 30 percent of the habitable floor area of the primary dwelling, or 500 square feet, unless design review approval is first obtained.

2.

The aggregate site coverage for all structures on a parcel shall not exceed the maximum allowed in the applicable specific zoning district by Section 19.10.040 (Residential Zoning District General Development Standards).

3.

The gross floor area of a guest house shall not exceed 400 square feet.

H.

Pools, Hot Tubs and Spas. In- and above-ground pools, hot tubs, and spas are subject to the following standards:

1.

May be located within rear or side yard areas. Any decking exceeding 18 inches above surrounding grade must comply with the standards contained in Section 19.34.032D4.

2.

Shall not count towards lot coverage limitations or the maximum number of accessory structures otherwise specified in this Section.

3.

Mechanical equipment shall comply with the requirements of Section 19.22.040 (Electrical and Mechanical Equipment).

4.

Shall comply with all other applicable requirements of this Chapter.

(Ord. No. 1576, § 2 (Exh. A, amd.), 10-23-2012)

19.34.034 - Accessory Retail and Service Uses.

Retail sales and services, including, but not limited to, restaurants, pharmacies, and the sale of retail merchandise, are allowed accessory to a primary use where authorized by Article 2 (Zoning Districts, Allowable Land Uses, and Zone-Specific Standards), as follows:

A.

General Standard. There shall be no external evidence of any commercial activity other than the primary use of the site (e.g., no signs, or windows with merchandise visible from adjoining streets), nor access to any space used for the accessory retail use other than from within the structure.

B.

Commercial Zoning Districts. Restaurants and retail sales are permitted in the commercial zoning districts incidental and accessory to offices, hospitals and other medical facilities; pharmacies are permitted accessory to hospitals and other medical facilities.

C.

Residential and Special Purpose Zoning Districts. Membership organizations, social or recreational establishments may engage in retail sales for guests only.

(Ord. No. 1576, § 2 (Exh. A, amd.), 10-23-2012)

19.34.050 - Alcoholic Beverage Establishments.

A.

Purpose. The provisions of this Section are intended to avoid or minimize the potential adverse effects (e.g., littering, loitering, and others) on the peace, health, safety and welfare of residents in nearby areas, that may arise from the undue proliferation and/or inappropriate location of establishments selling alcoholic beverages.

B.

Exemption from Use Permit Requirement. The Use Permit approval otherwise required by Article 2 (Zoning Districts and Allowable Land Uses) for alcoholic beverage establishments shall not be required for:

1.

The incidental sale and serving of alcohol beverages for on-premise consumption in conjunction with a restaurant. This exemption does not apply to uses classified as night clubs and bars.

2.

The retail sale of alcoholic beverages for off-premise consumption, when the alcoholic beverages are packaged with non-beverage items as a minor component of the product being sold (for example, food gift baskets including wine); or

3.

Wholesale-only operations (no direct sales to consumers).

These exemptions shall not apply where the State Department of Alcoholic Beverage Control (ABC) requires a Letter of Convenience and Necessity for the sales activity.

C.

Display of Permit Required. The Use Permit issued for the alcoholic beverage establishment and a copy of the conditions of approval for the permit shall be displayed on the premises of the establishment in a place where it may readily be viewed by any member of the general public.

D.

Findings for Approval. No alcoholic beverage establishment shall be approved unless the Review Authority first make the findings required for the approval of a Use Permit in Section 19.42.050, and the following additional findings:

1.

The proposed use will not adversely affect the welfare of the area residents, or result in an undue concentration of establishments dispensing alcoholic beverages in the area, as determined by the Review Authority.

2.

The proposed use is located at an appropriate distance from:

a.

Residential uses;

b.

Religious facilities, schools, public parks and playgrounds, and other similar uses; and

c.

Other establishments dispensing alcoholic beverages.

3.

The size and proposed activity level (i.e., music, entertainment activities, food service, arcade games, or other amusement activities, etc.) will be compatible with the uses in and/or character of, the surrounding area.

The signs and other advertising on the exterior of the premises will be compatible with the character of the area.

5.

The applicant has committed to voluntarily provide a beverage service training program, should one be made available locally on a no-charge basis for employees who sell or dispense alcoholic beverages, and would provide them with the knowledge and skills needed to comply with their responsibilities under State law, including the following topics:

a.

State laws relating to alcoholic beverages, particularly ABC regulations and penal provisions concerning sales to minors and intoxicated persons, driving under the influence, hours of legal operation, and penalties for violations of these laws;

b.

The potential legal liabilities of owners and employees of businesses dispensing alcoholic beverages to patrons who may subsequently injure, kill, or harm themselves or innocent victims as a result of the excessive consumption of alcoholic beverages;

c.

Alcohol as a drug and its effects on the body and behavior, including the operation of motor vehicles;

d.

Methods of dealing with intoxicated customers and recognizing underage customers;

e.

Methods to appropriately pace customer drinking to reduce the risk that the customer will leave the premises in an intoxicated manner; and

f.

Knowledge of mixology, including marketable alternatives to alcoholic beverages.

E.

Gas Stations Selling Alcoholic Beverages. Gas stations that sell alcoholic beverages shall be subject to Use Permit approval and the other requirements of this Section. In addition, no advertisement of alcoholic beverages shall be displayed at or located on motor fuel islands, and no self-illuminated advertising for alcoholic beverages shall be located on the exterior portion of the building or in the window area in a manner as to make it identifiable and readable from the closest adjacent roadway.

F.

Nonconforming Uses and Structures. Alcoholic beverage retail establishments which were legally operating prior to the adoption of this Section may continue to operate as nonconforming uses in compliance with the provisions of Chapter 19.52 (Nonconforming Uses, Structures, and Parcels). In addition to those provisions, nonconforming establishments shall be required to apply for a Use Permit in compliance with Section 19.42.050 (Use Permits), if any of the following occur after the effective date of this Section:

1.

The existing establishment requests permission from the ABC to allow the serving of distilled spirits in addition to its original license to sell or serve beer and wine only;

2.

The establishment's liquor license is revoked by the ABC;

3.

The establishment's liquor license is suspended for more than 45 days by the ABC; or

4.

There is a 20 percent or larger expansion of the area within the establishment that is designated for the sale or consumption of alcoholic beverages.

(Ord. No. 1576, § 2 (Exh. A, amd.), 10-23-2012)

19.34.060 - Animal Keeping.

The provisions of this Section are intended to ensure that the raising and maintenance of animals does not create adverse impacts on adjacent properties by reason of dust, noise, visual blight, odor, fumes, bright lights, or insect infestations.

A.

Where Allowed. Animal keeping shall be allowed in any residential zoning district subject to the provisions of this Section.

B.

Pre-existing Uses. Any legally established noncommercial animal keeping use that became nonconforming upon adoption of this Zoning Ordinance, shall be permitted to continue subject to Division 19.52 (Nonconforming Uses, Structures, and Parcels).

C.

Allowable Animal Keeping Activities and Permit Requirements. Animals shall be kept within residential zoning districts only in compliance with the limitations on use and permit requirements in Table 3-13.

Table 3-13

Allowable Animal-Keeping Activities and Permit Requirements

Type of animals Permit Requirement by Zoning District (2) Permit Requirement by Zoning District (2) Permit Requirement by Zoning District (2) Permit Requirement by Zoning District (2) Permit Requirement by Zoning District (2)
A RR RVL R1 R4/R5 R10 R20
Household pets - 5 or fewer total P P P P P P P
Kennel or boarding UP UP UP
Small animals - 12 or fewer total P P P P P P P
Small animals - 13 or more total P UP UP UP
Large animals UP (3) P P P (1)
Hogs & swine P
Fowl and poultry - 12 or fewer total (4) P P P P P/P UP UP
Fowl and poultry - 13 or more total P UP UP UP

Key to permit requirements:

P Permitted animal keeping only in accordance with standards of Table 3-14, no City approval required.
UP Use Permit approval required in compliance with Section
19.42.050.
Type of animal not allowed.

Notes:

(1)

Allowed in the R1 zoning district only where a lot contains 20,000 sq. ft. or more of land area that is not subject to restricted use, (e.g., private open space easement).

(2)

Animal keeping within the PD (Planned Development) District shall be allowed in accordance with the standards of the applicable Precise Development Plan. If the Precise Plan is silent on animal keeping, the standards from the most comparable zoning district shall apply. Private homeowners associations may also have animal-keeping restrictions.

(3)

UP required for large animal livestock operations, see Table 2-2, Section 19.08.030.

(4)

See Table 3-14 and 19.34.060 (E) for additional requirements.

D.

Animal keeping standards. All animal keeping shall comply with the standards in Table 3-14.

Table 3-14

Animal-Keeping Standards

Type of Animal or Facility Maximum Number of Animals
per Site (1)
Minimum Lot
Area (2)
Minimum
Setbacks (3)
Fowl and poultry - (Roosters, quacking
ducks, geese, guinea fowl, or peafowl are not
allowed)
12 or less 5,000 sf 10 feet
Hogs and swine 1 animal per 40,000 sf 80,000 sf 20 feet
Household pets - Including cats, dogs, pot
belly pigs (less than 80 pounds) and other
non-poisonous small animals.
5 or less where allowed in
compliance with Table 3-13
None None
Large animals - Horses, cows, goats, llamas,
sheep, and similar sized animals
1 animal per 20,000 sf 20,000 sf 20 feet
Small animals - Chinchilla, guinea pigs,
hamsters, rabbits, rodents, birds, and similar
small animals, not raised for commercial
purposes
12 or less None 10 feet

Notes:

(1)

Offspring allowed in addition to maximum number until weaned.

(2)

Minimum lot area required for the keeping of animals.

(3)

Minimum setbacks from all property lines for areas and structures where animals are kept. Animals shall not be kept in any required front yard setback.

E.

Maintenance and Operational Standards.

1.

Odor and Vector Control. All animal enclosures, including but not limited to pens, coops, cages and feed areas shall be maintained free from litter, garbage and the accumulation of manure, so as to discourage the

proliferation of flies, other disease vectors and offensive odors. Sites shall be maintained in a neat and sanitary manner.

2.

Waterway Protection. The keeping of horses or cattle within 50 feet of any waterway shall first require Director approval of a good housekeeping plan to protect the waterway from the polluting effects of runoff from the animal keeping area.

3.

Erosion and Sedimentation Control. In no case shall an animal keeping operation be managed or maintained so as to produce sedimentation on any public road, adjoining property, or in any drainage channel. In the event sedimentation occurs, the keeping of animals outdoors on the site shall be deemed a nuisance and may be subject to abatement in compliance with Division 19.59 (Zoning Ordinance Enforcement).

4.

Noise Control. Animal keeping shall comply with the noise standards established by Section 19.22.060 (Noise).

5.

Additional Standards Specific to Keeping of Chickens.

a.

A minimum separation of 25-feet must be maintained between the animal enclosure and any dwelling other than the keeper's dwelling.

b.

Both a henhouse and pen are required. Animals must be maintained within one of these enclosures at all times and may not roam freely on the property.

c.

Responsible, sanitary and humane conditions must be maintained at all times. Keeper shall not fail to provide proper food, water, shelter or sanitation. Henhouse and enclosure shall be roofed and sufficient to provide shelter from weather and protection from predators. Overcrowding is prohibited. The City generally considers overcrowding to be less than four sf/hen within the enclosure.

(Ord. No. 1576, § 2 (Exh. A, amd.), 10-23-2012; Ord. No. 1675, § V, 12-14-2021)

19.34.065 - Cannabis—Personal Cultivation.

A.

Purpose and Intent. The purpose of this section is to impose regulatory restrictions on the personal cultivation of cannabis pursuant to state law. Nothing in this section is intended to allow commercial cannabis activities as defined in section 19.60.020. This section is not intended to interfere with a patient's right to use medicinal cannabis pursuant to state law, as may be amended, nor does it criminalize cannabis possession or cultivation otherwise authorized by state law. This section is not intended to give any person or entity independent legal

authority to operate a cannabis business, as it is intended simply to impose regulatory restrictions regarding personal cultivation of cannabis in the City pursuant to this Code and state law.

B.

Applicability. Nothing in this section shall be construed to allow any conduct or activity relating to the cultivation, distribution, dispensing, sale, or consumption of cannabis that is otherwise illegal under local or state law, nor shall it be construed, to exempt any activity related to the cultivation of cannabis from any applicable electrical, plumbing, land use or other building or land use standards or permitting requirements. No provision of this section shall be deemed a defense or immunity to any action brought against any person by the Marin County District Attorney's office, the Attorney General of the State of California or the United States of America.

C.

Maximum limits.

1.

No indoor, mixed-light or outdoor cannabis cultivation may occur without full compliance with this section.

2.

No personal cultivation of cannabis may occur on a parcel of property unless a private residence is located on the same parcel.

3.

Notwithstanding any other provisions of this Code to the contrary, outdoor cultivation of cannabis (for any purpose) is prohibited.

4.

Except as may be permitted by state law with respect to qualified patients and/or primary caregivers, no more than six (6) cannabis plants may be cultivated inside a private residence and/or on the parcel on which that private residence is located.

D.

Medical Cannabis Cultivation. Medical cannabis shall only be cultivated by:

1.

A qualified patient exclusively for his or her own personal medical use but who does not provide, donate, sell, or distribute medical cannabis to any other person and who can provide a written doctor's recommendation to the City; or

2.

A primary caregiver who cultivates, possesses, stores, manufactures, transports, donates, or provides medical cannabis exclusively for the personal medical purposes of no more than five specified qualified patients for

whom he or she is the primary caregiver, but who does not receive remuneration for these activities except for compensation in full compliance with California Health and Safety Code Section 11362.765(c).

E.

Nonmedicinal Cannabis Cultivation. For persons other than qualified patients or primary caregivers, all personal cultivation of cannabis for nonmedicinal purposes shall be conducted by persons twenty-one (21) years of age or older.

F.

Indoor Cannabis Cultivation for Personal Use. Indoor cannabis cultivation for personal use is permitted within all private residences as defined in Health and Safety Code Section 11362.2 and Fully Enclosed and Secure Structures located on the same parcels as the private residences within all zoning districts, subject to all of the following minimum standards:

1)

All indoor cannabis cultivation for personal use, including by a qualified patient or primary caregiver, shall occur in a private residence or Fully Enclosed and Secure Structure located on the same parcel of property as that private residence, subject to the following restrictions:

a)

Structures and equipment used for indoor cannabis cultivation, such as indoor grow lights, shall comply with all applicable zoning, building, electrical and fire code regulations as adopted by the City;

b)

All Fully Enclosed and Secure Structures shall comply with all applicable requirements set forth in this Chapter and in addition shall be setback by a minimum of ten (10) feet from all parcel property lines;

c)

Personal cultivation of cannabis shall not interfere with the primary occupancy of the residence, building or structure, including regular use of kitchen(s) or bathroom(s);

d)

The use of generators to power any cultivation equipment is prohibited; may occur in the substance may occur in the cultivation natural gas) or ozone generators shall not be used in any he use of generators to power any cultivation equipment is prohibited, except as an emergency back-up system. The use of extension cords in the cultivation room is likewise prohibited;

e)

Indoor grow lights used for cultivation shall not exceed 1,200 watts per light, and shall comply with the California Building, Electrical and Fire Codes as adopted by the City;

f)

Any Fully Enclosed and Secure Structure or private residence used for the cultivation of indoor cannabis shall have a ventilation and filtration system installed that shall prevent cannabis plant odors from exiting the interior of the structure and that shall comply with the Building Codes as adopted and amended by Chapter 4 (Building and Housing) of the Novato Municipal Code;

g)

From the ground level of a street, public right-of-way or adjoining parcel, there shall be no visible evidence whatsoever of cannabis cultivation occurring anywhere on the parcel;

h)

Nothing in this section is intended, nor shall it be construed, to preclude any landlord from limiting or prohibiting personal cultivation of cannabis by tenants;

i)

Nothing in this section is intended, nor shall it be construed, to authorize commercial cultivation of cannabis;

j)

Nothing in this section is intended, nor shall it be construed, to authorize any public or private nuisance as specified in this Code;

k)

Except as may otherwise be permitted by state law with respect to the cultivation of medicinal cannabis by qualified patients and/or primary caregivers, the cultivation area shall not be accessible to minors; and

l)

Tenants and all other non-owners of property shall have written consent from the property owner in accordance with the following requirements:

1)

Written consent from the property owner to cultivate cannabis within the residence or in a Fully Enclosed and Secure Structure that otherwise meets the requirements of this section shall be obtained and shall be kept on the premises, and available for inspection by the chief of police or his/her designee;

2)

If there is more than one owner of the residence, all owners must have acknowledged, consented to and granted permission to the authorized grower for the cultivation. The written consent shall be dated and signed by the owner or owners of the residence.

3)

The written consent shall be valid for twelve (12) months from the signing of the written consent. If ownership of the residence changes during the twelve (12) months period after the previous owner or owners had granted permission for the cultivation, the authorized grower must obtain, with thirty (30) days of the change of ownership, a new permission statement from the new owner or owners of the residence; and

4)

Upon request, the authorized grower shall provide the written consent from the owner or owners of the residence as proof that the owner or owners have acknowledged, consented to and granted permission to the authorized grower.

5)

The area of cultivation shall not adversely affect the health or safety of the occupants of the private residence or the parcel on which the residence is located or any other property by creating dust, noise, noxious gasses, smoke, odors, vibration, mold, or other impacts, and shall not be maintained as to constitute a hazard due to use or storage of materials, processes, products or wastes.

6)

The area used for cultivation shall comply with all California Building, Electrical, Fire, Mechanical and Plumbing Codes as adopted and amended by Chapter 4 (Building and Housing) of the Novato Municipal Code; and (1) the private residence must have a permanent connection to a public water source drawing water, (2) the cultivator may not engage in unlawful or unpermitted surface drawing of water for such cultivation, (3) the cultivator may not permit illegal discharges of water from the parcel, and (4) the residence where the cultivation takes place shall be connected to a public sewer system.

7)

The cannabis plants shall be in a locked space so to prevent access by children (except as may otherwise be permitted by state law with respect to the cultivation of medicinal cannabis by qualified patients and/or primary caregivers), visitors, casual passersby, vandals, or anyone not authorized to possess cannabis.

8)

Adequate mechanical locking or electronic security systems must be installed as part of the Fully Enclosed and Secure Structure or the private residence prior to the commencement of cultivation.

9)

A portable fire extinguisher that complies with the regulations and standards adopted by the state fire marshal and applicable law shall be kept in the Fully Enclosed and Secure Structure used for cannabis cultivation. If cultivation occurs in a private residence, the portable fire extinguisher shall be kept in the same room as where the cultivation occurs.

G.

Outdoor cannabis cultivation—Personal Use. Outdoor cannabis cultivation is prohibited under this Section and shall constitute a public nuisance. No personal cultivation of cannabis may occur except within a private residence or Fully Enclosed and Secure Structure.

H.

Cannabis Cultivation Activities Prohibited Unless Specifically Authorized by this Section. Except as specifically authorized in this section, the cultivation of cannabis for personal use is expressly prohibited in the City of Novato.

I.

Enforcement.

1.

Nuisance. Any violation of this Section is declared to be a public nuisance and may be abated by the city pursuant to Section 1-6 of this Code.

2.

Penalty. A violation of this section is punishable as a criminal offense in accordance with Section 1-5 of this Code. However, notwithstanding anything in this code to the contrary, persons violating this section shall not be subject to criminal liability under this Code solely to the extent such conduct or condition is immune from criminal liability pursuant to state law, including the Compassionate Use Act of 1996 (Health and Safety Code Section 11362.5), the Medical Marijuana Program (Health and Safety Code Section 11362.7 et seq.), the Medicinal and Adult-Use Cannabis Regulation and Safety Act or the Control, Regulate and Tax Adult Use of Marijuana Act, as they may be amended. This section does not prohibit the city from abating violations of this section by any administrative, civil or other non-criminal means.

(Ord. No. 1643, § 3, 10-9-2018)

19.34.066 - Cannabis—Commercial Activities.

A.

Purpose and Intent. This section is not intended to give any person or entity authority to operate a commercial cannabis business. That authorization is granted through a licensing process, established in Section 8-11 of the Novato Municipal Code. The purpose of this section, together with Table 2-7 of Section 19.12.030 and Section 19.14.030(B), is to establish the allowable locations and operational limitations of commercial cannabis activities.

B.

Applicability. Nothing in this section shall be construed to allow any conduct or activity relating to the cultivation, manufacture, distribution, dispensing, sale, or consumption of cannabis that is otherwise illegal under local or state law, nor shall it be construed, to exempt any cannabis activity from any applicable electrical, plumbing, or other building permit or any land use standard or permitting requirements. No provision of this section shall be deemed a defense or immunity to any action brought against any person by the Marin County District Attorney's office, the Attorney General of the State of California or the United States of America.

C.

Limitations on Activities. Table 2-7 of Section 19.12.030 establishes the specific types of commercial cannabis activities which can be permitted through the licensing process established in Novato Municipal Code Section 8-11. Section 8-11 also establishes the maximum allowable number of each activity or license type.

D.

Approval Authorities. All newly established commercial cannabis activities must be approved by the City Council. Subsequent renewals may be granted by the City Manager or designee. A Zoning Clearance, signed by the Community Development Director or designee, is required prior to initiation of commercial cannabis activities. The City Council may adopt resolutions as well as administrative forms and procedures in order to establish operational requirements, standardize the approval process and for record keeping.

E.

Prohibited Activities. The following commercial cannabis activities are prohibited.

1.

No outdoor or mixed light cultivation is allowed.

2.

No storefront retail sales are allowed.

3.

Microbusinesses shall not include storefront retail sales.

F.

Location Standards. Commercial cannabis operations require distance separation from the potentially sensitive uses listed below. Distances are measured in a straight line from the nearest boundary of the commercial cannabis premises to the nearest boundary of the premises of the sensitive use. Separation requirements will be determined at the time the Conditional Certificate is issued and do not apply to sensitive uses established after a Conditional Certificate has been awarded by the licensing authority.

1.

Youth facilities including schools providing instruction in kindergarten or any grades 1 through 12, daycare centers or Youth Centers.

a.

Testing laboratories locating on a property carrying a Business & Professional Office zoning or general plan land use may be required to maintain a separation of 0-feet to 300-feet, depending upon specific location and as determined appropriate by the licensing authority.

b.

All other commercial cannabis uses in all other zone districts or land use categories where the use is allowed shall maintain a minimum separation of 600-feet.

2.

Residential. Non-storefront retailers locating on a property carrying a Business & Professional Office zoning or general plan land use designation shall maintain a minimum separation of 600-feet from any residentially zoned property.

(Ord. No. 1656, § V, 11-12-2019; Ord. No. 1674, § V, 12-14-2021)

19.34.070 - Child Day Care Facilities.

This Section provides location and operational standards for child day care facilities, in compliance with State law and in a manner that recognizes the needs of child care operators and minimizes effects on adjoining properties. These standards apply in addition to the other provisions of this Zoning Ordinance and the requirements of the California Department of Social Services. Licensing by the Department of Social Services is required for all facilities.

A.

Applicability. Child day care facilities shall be allowed as follows:

1.

Small Family Day Care Homes (8 or Fewer Children). Allowed within a single-family residence located in a residential zoning district.

2.

Large Family Day Care Homes (9 to 14 Children). Allowed within a single-family residence located in a residential zoning district.

3.

Child Day Care Centers (15 or More Children). Allowed in the zoning districts determined by Article 2 (Zoning Districts, Allowable Land Uses, and Zone-Specific Standards), subject to Use Permit approval, in compliance with Section 19.42.050, and the standards as follows:

a.

The minimum parcel size for a child day care center shall be 10,000 square feet;

b.

Off-street parking shall be as determined through Use Permit approval, but shall be a minimum of one space per employee on the largest shift.

c.

A safe area for picking up and dropping off children shall be provided. This activity shall only be allowed in a driveway, in an approved parking area, or in an area with direct access to the facility.

d.

Potential noise sources shall be identified during the Use Permit process, and noise attenuation and sound dampening shall be addressed. Noise levels shall comply with and Section 19.22.060 (Noise), and the Safety and Noise Chapter of the General Plan.

e.

Alternative Standards. Alternatives to the standards of this Section may be authorized through the Use Permit approval if the Review Authority determines that:

(1)

The intent of these standards is met; and

(2)

There will be no detriment to surrounding properties or residents.

(Ord. No. 1576, § 2 (Exh. A, amd.), 10-23-2012)

19.34.071 - Supportive Housing.

A.

Supportive Housing. Where allowed in the applicable zoning district by Article 2 (Zoning Districts, Allowable Land Uses, and Zone-Specific Standards), supportive housing shall satisfy the requirements of this section and satisfy the requirements of Sections 65650 through 65656 of California Government Code.

1.

Definitions. For the purposes of this Section 19.34.071, the term "supportive housing" shall have the same meaning as set forth in Section 65650 of the California Government Code.

2.

Application Submittal, Review, and Approval Process.

a.

Application Submittal. A Zoning Clearance Application shall be submitted to the Community Development Department for review, and shall include the Zoning Clearance fee, as detailed on the City's Master Fee Schedule; sufficient documentation that the use will comply with Sections 65651 and 65652 of California Government Code, and those submittal requirements established by the Community Development Department.

b.

Review Timelines. The City shall comply with the review timelines consistent with Section 65653 of California Government Code.

3.

Development Standards.

a.

New buildings. When new buildings are proposed to be constructed to house a supportive housing use, the building and site design shall comply with Division 19.27 of the Novato Municipal Code.

b.

Additions to existing buildings. When an addition to an existing building is proposed, and the addition does not exceed twenty-five (25) percent of the gross floor area of the existing building, the addition shall use the same building materials and colors of the existing building. When an addition to an existing building is proposed that exceeds twenty-five (25) percent of the gross floor area of the existing building, the entire building (existing building and proposed addition) shall comply with Division 19.27.

c.

Façade remodels. If a façade remodel is proposed, and the area of the façade remodel does not exceed twenty-five (25) percent of the wall area of the building elevation proposed to be altered, then the exposed building and siding materials and colors shall be the same as that of the existing façade proposed to be remodeled. If a façade remodel is proposed, and the area of the façade remodel exceeds twenty-five (25) percent of the wall area of the building elevation proposed to be altered, then the remodel shall comply with Division 19.27 of the Novato Municipal Code.

d.

Notwithstanding the requirements of subsections b. or c., immediately above, a Developer may voluntarily propose an addition or façade remodel that complies with Division 19.27 regardless of the size of the addition or façade remodel.

e.

A supportive housing center shall comply with all other applicable development and performance standards detailed in Article 2 and Article 3 of Chapter XIX (Zoning) of the Novato Municipal Code.

(Ord. No. 1718, § 3(Exh. B), 9-10-2024)

19.34.072 - Emergency Shelters.

A.

Emergency Shelters are permitted in the Novato Industrial Park within the Hamilton and Ignacio Industrial Parks as set forth and subject to the standards provided in the Novato Industrial Park Master and Precise Development Plan.

B.

Emergency Shelters. Where allowed in the applicable zoning district by Article 2 (Zoning Districts, Allowable Land Uses, and Zone-Specific Standards), emergency shelters shall comply with the requirements of subsections C. through E., inclusive. These subsections are not applicable to temporary emergency shelters established by the City in response to an emergency event.

C.

Application Submittal, Review, and Approval Process. A Zoning Clearance Application shall be submitted to the Community Development Department for review, and shall include the Zoning Clearance fee, as detailed on the City's Master Fee Schedule and documentation demonstrating that the use will comply with the Novato Municipal Code, applicable State regulations, and those submittal requirements established by the Community Development Department.

D.

Location of Emergency Shelters. Emergency shelters shall be located a minimum distance of 300 feet from any other emergency shelter.

E.

Emergency shelters shall comply with the following development and operational standards. In the event of a conflict between these standards and the underlying zoning district regulations, the provision of this section shall apply.

1.

Development and Operational Standards.

a.

Number of beds per facility. The maximum number of beds or clients permitted to be served nightly shall not exceed 50 persons or shall comply with a lower occupancy limit as determined by the California Building Code.

b.

Parking. Off-street parking shall be provided consistent with the objective requirements of Division 19.30, provided that an emergency shelter shall not be required to provide more parking than other residential or commercial uses within the same zone.

c.

An indoor onsite waiting area of no less than 275 square feet shall be provided.

d.

On-site management shall be provided during all hours when the emergency shelter is in operation.

e.

On-site security shall be provided during all hours when the emergency shelter is in operation.

f.

Limited Terms of Stay. The maximum overnight stays for each shelter visitor shall not exceed 180 days in any 12-month period. No individual or household may be denied emergency shelter because of an inability to pay for services.

g.

Exterior lighting shall be provided for security purposes. Exterior lighting shall consist of Dark Sky certified light fixtures providing a minimum average of 3-foot candles at ground level. The lighting shall be stationary and shielded to avoid spillover onto adjacent lots.

h.

Emergency shelters may provide one or more of the following specific common facilities for the exclusive use of the residents and staff:

i.

Central cooking and dining facilities.

ii.

Recreation room.

iii.

Counseling center.

iv.

Childcare facilities.

v.

Other support services that are beneficial to the shelter residents in seeking a permanent residence.

(Ord. No. 1587, § 7(Exh. G), 12-3-2013; Ord. No. 1723, § 3(Exh. A), 3-25-2025)

19.34.073 - Low Barrier Navigation Center.

A.

Where allowed in the applicable zoning district by Article 2 (Zoning Districts, Allowable Land Uses, and ZoneSpecific Standards), a low barrier navigation center shall satisfy the requirements of this section and satisfy the requirements of California Government Code Sections 65660 through 65668.

1.

Definitions. For the purposes of this Section 19.34.073, the term "low barrier navigation center" shall have the same meaning as set forth in Section 65660 of California Government Code.

2.

Application Submittal, Review, and Approval Process.

a.

Application Submittal. A Zoning Clearance Application shall be submitted to the Community Development Department for review, and shall include the Zoning Clearance fee, as detailed on the City's Master Fee Schedule; sufficient documentation that the use will comply with Section 65662 of California Government Code, and those submittal requirements established by the Community Development Department.

b.

Review Timelines. The City shall comply with the review timelines consistent with Section 65664 of the California Government Code.

Development Standards.

a.

New buildings. When new buildings are proposed to be constructed to house a low barrier navigation center use, the building and site design shall comply with Division 19.27 of the Novato Municipal Code.

b.

Additions to existing buildings. When an addition to an existing building is proposed, and the addition does not exceed twenty-five (25) percent of the gross floor area of the existing building, the addition shall use the same exposed building materials and siding and colors of the existing building. When an addition to an existing building is proposed that exceeds twenty-five (25) percent of the gross floor area of the existing building, the entire building (existing building and proposed addition) shall comply with Division 19.27.

c.

Façade remodels. If a façade remodel is proposed, and the area of the façade remodel does not exceed twenty-five (25) percent of the wall area of the building elevation proposed to be altered, then the exposed building materials and siding and colors shall be the same as the existing façade proposed to be remodeled. If a façade remodel is proposed, and the area of the façade remodel exceeds twenty-five (25) percent of the wall area of the building elevation proposed to be altered, then the remodel shall comply with Division 19.27 of the Novato Municipal Code.

d.

Notwithstanding the requirements of subsections b. or c., immediately above, a Developer may voluntarily propose an addition or façade remodel that complies with Division 19.27 regardless of the size of the addition or façade remodel.

e.

A low barrier navigation center shall comply with all other applicable development and performance standards detailed in Article 2 and Article 3 of Chapter XIX (Zoning) of the Novato Municipal Code.

(Ord. No. 1718, § 3(Exh. B), 9-10-2024)

19.34.074 - Heliports.

A.

Restrictions. It shall be unlawful for any person to cause a helicopter to take off or land within the City other than at a permitted heliport.

B.

Conditions of Approval. The Review Authority shall impose conditions as necessary to comply with the provisions of this Zoning Ordinance and other City regulations, but shall not impose any condition that would

conflict with Public Utilities Code Section 21662.4 pertaining to emergency aircraft flights for medical purposes.

C.

Exemptions. The provisions of this Zoning Ordinance shall not apply to any helicopter operated by the Federal government, or any State, County, or City agency engaged in law enforcement, fire suppression, or going to the aid of any person or the property thereof, provided that the helicopter is operated in compliance with applicable Federal and State regulations and by the authorized personnel of the applicable Federal, State, County, or City agency.

(Ord. No. 1576, § 2 (Exh. A, amd.), 10-23-2012)

19.34.080 - Home Occupations.

This Section provides location and operational standards for the establishment of home businesses, in compliance with Article 2 (Zoning Districts, Allowable Land Uses, and Zone-Specific Standards), which shall be subject to the following criteria and standards:

A.

Permit Requirement. The Director is authorized to approve a home occupation in conjunction with a City Business License.

B.

Limitations on Use. The following are examples of business activities that may be approved as home occupations, and uses that are prohibited as home occupations:

1.

Allowed Home Occupations. The following and other uses determined by the Director to be similar may be approved by the Director in compliance with this Section:

a.

Art and craft work (ceramics, painting, photography, sculpture, etc.);

b.

Tailors, sewing, etc.;

c.

Office-only uses, including an office for an architect, attorney, consultant, counselor, insurance agent, tutor, writer, etc., and electronic commerce.

2.

Uses Prohibited as Home Occupations. The following are examples of business activities that are not incidental to or compatible with residential activities, and are, therefore, prohibited as home occupations:

a.

Adult entertainment activities/businesses;

b.

Animal hospitals and grooming facilities;

c.

Automotive and other vehicle repair and service (body or mechanical), painting, storage, or upholstery, or the repair, reconditioning, servicing, or manufacture of any internal combustion or diesel engines, or of any motor vehicle, including automobiles, boats, motorcycles, or trucks;

d.

Commercial cabinet or furniture making;

e.

Contractor's storage yards;

f.

Dismantling, junk, or scrap yards;

g.

Exercise studios (not including one-on-one personal trainers);

h.

Medical clinics, laboratories, or doctor's offices;

i.

Personal services as defined in Article 6, but not including licensed massage therapists and physical therapists;

j.

On-site sales;

k.

Uses which require explosives or highly combustible or toxic materials;

l.

Welding and machine shop operations; or

m.

Other uses the Director determines to be similar to those listed above.

C.

Operating Standards. Home occupations shall comply with all of the following operating standards:

1.

Accessory Use. The home occupation shall be clearly secondary to the full-time use of the property as a residence.

2.

Location of Home Occupation Activities. All home occupation activities shall occur entirely within:

a.

The main dwelling and shall not exceed 25 percent of the gross floor area or one room, whichever is greater; or

b.

The garage or other approved accessory structure. Use of a garage shall not interfere with the ability to maintain the required number of off-street parking spaces within the garage.

3.

Visibility. The use shall not require any modification not customarily found in a dwelling, nor shall the home occupation activity be visible from the adjoining public right-of-way, or from neighboring residential properties.

4.

Display, Signs. There shall be no window display or advertising signs, other than one name plate not exceeding one square foot in area. There shall be no display of merchandise, equipment, stock-in-trade, or other identification of the home occupation activity on the premises.

5.

Parking. The use shall not negatively impact on-street parking in the neighborhood.

6.

Safety. Activities conducted and equipment or material used shall not change the fire safety or occupancy classifications of the premises. The use shall not employ the storage of flammable, explosive, or hazardous materials unless specifically approved by the Novato Fire Protection District.

7.

Off-site Effects. No home occupation activity shall create dust, electrical interference, fumes, gas, glare, light, noise, odor, smoke, toxic/hazardous materials, vibration, or other hazards or nuisances as determined by the Director.

8.

Employees. A home occupation shall have no on-site employees other than full-time residents of the dwelling.

9.

Customers or Deliveries. The frequency of visitors, customers, or deliveries shall not exceed that normally and reasonably occurring for a residence. On-site presence of clients shall be limited to one client or family at a time.

10.

Motor Vehicles. There shall be no motor vehicles used or kept on the premises, except residents' passenger vehicles, or pickup truck not exceeding one-ton carrying capacity. The keeping of vehicles on the site shall also comply with the provisions of Section 19.34.170 (Vehicle Parking in Residential Zones).

11.

Utility Services Modifications. The home occupation use shall not have utility services modifications, other than those required for normal residential use, that would be classed as commercial or industrial in load or design.

12.

Sale, Storage or Distribution of Goods. Articles stored for distribution or sale at off-premise locations shall be limited to those produced on the premise. Where the person conducting the home occupation serves as an agent or intermediary between off-site suppliers and off-site customers, all articles, except samples, shall be received, stored and sold to customer at off-premise locations.

D.

Revocation of Permit. Upon receipt of complaint regarding the operation of the home occupation or upon observation of a violation of City ordinances, the Director, or designated representative, shall determine whether the subject home occupation is in compliance with the provisions of the permit. If the use is found not to be in full compliance with the standards and conditions of approval, the Director shall have cause to suspend or revoke the permit or amend operational conditions. Once a zoning permit for a home occupation has been revoked, continued practice of the home occupation at that location is no longer permitted and subsequent applications shall not be filed within one (1) year from the date of revocation.

(Ord. No. 1576, § 2 (Exh. A, amd.), 10-23-2012)

19.34.090 - Live/Work Projects

This Section provides standards for the development of new live/work projects and for the reuse of existing commercial and industrial structures to accommodate live/work opportunities. Live/work facilities are intended to be occupied by business operators who live in the same structure that contains the commercial activity or industry.

A.

Limitation on Use. The non-residential component of a live/work project shall be a use allowed within the applicable zoning district by Article 2.

B.

Access. Access to individual live/work quarters shall be provided only from common access areas, corridors, or halls. The live/work quarters shall have an access clearly separate from other live/work quarters or other uses within the structure.

C.

Density. Density for live/work projects shall be consistent with the floor area (FAR) for the underlying zoning district.

D.

Minimum Floor Area. The minimum net floor area of a live/work space shall be 750 square feet. A minimum of 30 percent of the gross floor area shall be for studio/business use.

E.

Occupancy. Live/work quarters shall be occupied and used only by a business operator, or a family of which at least one member shall be the business operator.

F.

Residential Uses. All of the live/work quarters shall be used or arranged for residential purposes (e.g., bathroom, closet, kitchen, and sleeping area).

G.

Signs. There shall be no signs or advertising used in conjunction with a live/work facility other than allowable residential signs in compliance with Division 19.32 (Signs).

H.

Parking. Each live/work unit shall be provided with at least two off-street parking spaces. The Director may modify this requirement with regard to the use of existing structures with limited parking.

I.

Prohibited Uses. Live/work quarters shall not be established or used in conjunction with the following activities:

1.

Adult businesses;

2.

Vehicle maintenance or repair (e.g., body or mechanical work, including boats and recreational vehicles), vehicle detailing and painting, upholstery, etc.);

3.

Storage of flammable liquids or hazardous materials beyond that normally associated with a residential use;

Welding, machining, or any open flame work; and

5.

Any other uses, as determined by the Director to not be compatible with residential activities.

J.

Open Space. A minimum open outdoor space area of 150 square feet shall be required for each live/work unit in accordance with the standards in Section 19.34.124B.2.

(Ord. No. 1576, § 2 (Exh. A, amd.), 10-23-2012)

19.34.100 - Mixed-Use Projects.

This Section provides standards for the design of mixed-use projects.

A.

Design Considerations. Mixed use projects shall be designed to achieve the following objectives:

1.

The design of mixed-use projects shall provide for internal compatibility between the different uses.

2.

In order to properly mix residential and nonresidential uses on the same site, potential noise, odors, glare, pedestrian traffic, and other potentially significant impacts on residents shall be minimized.

3.

The design of the mixed use project shall take into consideration potential impacts on adjacent properties and shall include specific design features to minimize potential impacts.

4.

The design of a mixed-use project shall ensure that the residential units are of a residential character, and that privacy between residential units and between other uses on the site are maximized.

5.

The design of the structures and site planning shall encourage integration of the street pedestrian environment with the nonresidential uses through the use of plazas, courtyards, walkways, and street furniture.

6.

Site planning and building design shall be compatible with and enhance the adjacent and surrounding residential neighborhood in terms of scale, building design, color, exterior materials, roof styles, lighting, landscaping, and signage.

B.

Preferred Mix of Uses. Mixed-use projects that provide commercial and/or office space on the ground floor with residential units above (vertical mix) are encouraged over projects that provide commercial structures on the front portion of the lot with residential uses placed at the rear of the lot (horizontal mix).

C.

Floor Area Ratio (FAR). The FAR allowed by the applicable zoning district may be increased within the Downtown Core Retail, Downtown Core Business and Neighborhood Commercial districts pursuant to Section 19.12.040, Table 2-8, and for projects in the Mixed Use district pursuant to Section 19.14.040, Table 2-10, where the difference between the base FAR and up to the maximum FAR allowed by the applicable zoning district is entirely used for residential purposes.

D.

Location of Units. Within the CDR and CDB Zoning Districts, residential units shall only be allowed on upper floors or at the rear of the ground level, with ground floor street frontage reserved for retail, entertainment, and personal service uses.

E.

Setbacks. Structures with heights greater than 20 feet shall set back the upper portions of the structure a minimum of 10 feet from the side property lines for each additional story above two.

F.

Loading Areas. Commercial loading areas shall be located as far as possible from residential units and shall be completely screened from view from the residential portion of the project.

G.

Refuse and Recycling Areas. Areas for the collection and storage of refuse and recyclable materials shall be located on the site in locations that are convenient for both the residential and non-residential uses.

H.

Lighting. Lighting for the commercial uses shall be appropriately shielded to not negatively impact the residential units.

I.

Noise. All residential units shall be designed to minimize adverse impacts from non-residential project noise, in compliance with Section 19.22.060 (Noise).

J.

Hours of Operation. The Review Authority may restrict the hours of operation of nonresidential to mitigate adverse impacts on residential uses.

K.

Open Space. A minimum outdoor open space area of 150 square feet shall be required for each live/work unit in accordance with the standards in Section 19.34.124B.

(Ord. No. 1576, § 2 (Exh. A, amd.), 10-23-2012)

19.34.110 - Mobile Homes.

This Section provides requirements and development standards for the use of mobile homes as single-family dwellings outside of mobile home parks.

A.

Site and Coach Requirements. A mobile home may be located on a parcel outside of a mobile home park if the mobile home and the parcel comply with the following standards:

1.

The parcel is within a zoning district which allows single-family dwellings;

2.

The site and coach shall comply with all zoning, subdivision, and development standards applicable to a conventional single-family residential dwelling on the same parcel;

3.

The mobile home shall be placed on a permanent foundation system;

4.

The mobile home is certified under the National Mobile Home Construction and Safety Standards Act of 1974, and has been constructed after January 1, 1989;

B.

Design and Development Standards. The use of a mobile home for a single-family dwelling or an accessory dwelling unit shall comply with the following standards:

1.

The exterior siding and trim shall be of materials and treatment found in conventionally built residential structures in the surrounding area.

2.

The roofing material shall be of a material and treatment found on conventionally built residential structures in the surrounding area.

3.

The exterior roofing and siding materials and treatment, including trim, of the mobile home and the required garage shall be compatible.

The roof shall have eave and gable overhangs of not less than 12 inches measured from the vertical side of the home.

(Ord. No. 1576, § 2 (Exh. A, amd.), 10-23-2012)

19.34.120 - Mobile Home Parks and Mobile Home Subdivisions.

New mobile home parks and mobile home subdivisions shall comply with the following minimum standards. The Review Authority may impose other, more restrictive, requirements in the interest of public health, safety, and welfare.

A.

Minimum Site Area: 20 acres.

B.

Minimum Mobile Home Site Area. Individual mobile home sites and contiguous public walkway and greenbelt, but excluding slopes in excess of 15 percent, shall contain a minimum of 3,000 square feet of area for a singlewide mobile home unit and 4,000 square feet for a double-wide mobile home unit.

C.

Maximum Density. Seven units per acre, excluding slopes in excess of 15 percent.

D.

Setbacks. Minimum setbacks for individual sites within the park shall be five feet on all sides, including front and rear, except for any side or rear abutting the project property line, in which case the minimum setback shall be 20 feet.

E.

Parcel Dimensions. Individual mobile home parcels shall be a minimum of 40 feet in width and 70 feet in length.

F.

Parcel Coverage. Maximum site coverage shall comply with the requirements of the applicable zoning district.

G.

Boundary Greenbelt Building Setback. Each park shall provide a building setback and a greenbelt planting strip of at least ten feet in width where trees shall be planted and where general screening and/or a fence shall be provided. Where any portion of the park fronts on a public street, the setback shall be 25 feet.

H.

Parking. Parking shall be provided in compliance with Division 19.30 (Parking and Loading).

I.

Recreational Vehicle Parking. Supplemental parking areas for recreational vehicles if these are allowed to be kept within the mobile home park.

J.

Carport Facilities. Individual carport facilities for each mobile home site shall be provided as part of the development. The location and design shall be approved as part of the total plan.

K.

Community Center Area. A minimum of 500 square feet of net useable area per unit shall be provided for a combination of both indoor and outdoor community recreation and service facilities. The minimum amount of indoor facilities shall be provided on the basis of 50 square feet per unit for the first 150 units and ten square feet for each additional unit.

L.

Accessory Uses Allowed. A mobile home park may contain accessory uses for the convenience of the residents provided that these uses shall be located within the park interior.

M.

Perimeter Wall/Fence Required. A six-foot high solid masonry wall, or a solid wood fence with masonry posts spaced at intervals not less than 30 feet apart shall be provided around the entire perimeter of the mobile home park subject to compliance with the setback requirements of this Section.

N.

Individual Site Design. Individual mobile home sites shall be so designed as to conceal the wheel assemblies and to provide grade entrances for all mobile home units. Concealment shall not be by "skirting" alone, but, may be a combination of grading and "skirting." Where mobile home sites are graded into stepped pads, there shall be no more than a three-foot vertical elevation difference between pads.

O.

Completion of Community Facilities. Prior to occupancy of the mobile home park, not less than 50 mobile home lots and the entire planned community recreation and service areas, both indoor and outdoor, shall be completely prepared and ready for use. The development of the community recreation and service areas may be accomplished in stages provided it has been approved in the conditions of the Use Permit.

(Ord. No. 1576, § 2 (Exh. A, amd.), 10-23-2012)

19.34.124 - Multi-Family Dwellings.

Multi-family dwellings within the R10 and R20 zoning district shall be designed in compliance with the standards of this Section.

A.

Exterior Wall Requirements. Each dwelling unit within a multi-family project shall be designed to have at least two exterior walls that are not common to any other enclosed space. Each of the required exterior walls shall have no dimension less than eight feet.

B.

Open Space Requirements.

1.

Area Required. A multi-family project shall provide usable open space as follows:

Zoning District Minimum Open Space Area
per Unit
R10-4.5 500 sf
R10-3.5 400 sf
R10-2.5 and 2.2 300 sf
R20-2.0 200 sf
R20-1.5 and 1.8 150 sf

2.

Standards for Required Open Space.

a.

The minimum open space area required by this Section shall have no other primary use.

b.

At least one-half of the required open space shall be immediately available to and private for the occupants of each dwelling unit, while the remainder may be combined in common areas available to other residents of the project.

c.

The open space area may include a deck or balcony having no dimension less than six feet.

d.

Front yard setbacks may be used only as common open space areas, except for allowable deck projections.

(Ord. No. 1576, § 2 (Exh. A, amd.), 10-23-2012)

19.34.126 - Single-room Occupancy (SRO) Facility.

A.

Where allowed in the applicable zoning district by Article 2 (Zoning Districts, Allowable Land Uses, and ZoneSpecific Standards), a Single-room Occupancy (SRO) Facility shall satisfy the requirements of this section.

B.

Development Standards.

Single-room Occupancy Facilities.

a.

Density. An SRO Facility shall meet the density standards of the General Plan.

b.

Common Area. Four square feet of common area per SRO dwelling unit shall be provided, with at least 200 square feet in area of interior common space, excluding janitorial storage, laundry facilities, and common hallways. The common area shall not be used for any other use.

c.

Laundry Facilities. Laundry facilities shall be provided in a separate room at the ratio of one washer and one dryer for every 10 SRO living units or fractional number thereof, with at least one washer and one dryer on each floor that includes SRO dwelling units.

d.

Cleaning Supply Room. A cleaning supply room or utility closet with a wash tub with hot and cold running water shall be provided on each floor of the SRO facility with SRO dwelling units.

2.

Single-room Occupancy Dwelling Units.

a.

Unit Size. An SRO dwelling unit shall have a minimum floor area of 150 square feet and a maximum floor area of 400 square feet.

b.

Occupancy. An SRO dwelling unit shall accommodate a maximum of two persons.

c.

An SRO dwelling unit is not required to but may contain partial or full bathroom facilities. A partial bathroom facility shall have at least a toilet and sink; a full facility shall have a toilet, sink and bathtub, shower, or bathtub/shower combination. If a full bathroom facility is not provided, common bathroom facilities shall be provided in accordance with the California Building Code for congregate residences with at least one full bathroom per floor.

d.

Kitchen. An SRO dwelling unit is not required to but may contain partial or full kitchen facilities. A full kitchen includes a sink, a refrigerator and a stove, range top or oven. A partial kitchen is missing at least one of these appliances. If a full kitchen is not provided, common kitchen facilities shall be provided with at least one full kitchen on each floor of the SRO Facility with SRO dwelling units.

e.

Closet. Each SRO dwelling unit shall have at least one separate closet.

f.

Code Compliance. SRO dwelling units shall comply with all requirements of the California Building Code and Chapter IV of the Novato Municipal Code.

C.

Accessibility. All SRO dwelling units shall comply with all applicable accessibility and adaptability requirements. All common areas shall be fully accessible.

D.

Management.

1.

Facility Management. An SRO Facility with ten (10) or more units shall provide a manager that resides on-site. An SRO Facility with less than ten (10) units shall provide an on-site management office. Facility management shall have weekly office hours of at least twenty-four (24) hours per week, and a minimum of three (3) days per week. Office hours shall be within the time range of 7:00 AM and 8:00 PM.

2.

Management Agreement and Plan. A management agreement and plan shall be submitted with the Zoning Clearance application for an SRO Facility and shall be approved by the City. The management agreement and plan shall include the items listed in Section 4-15.03.

E.

Parking. Off-street parking shall be provided at a rate of 0.5 spaces per SRO dwelling unit and comply with the parking design standards detailed in Section 19.30.070. Secure bicycle parking shall be provided at a rate of 1.0 spaces per SRO dwelling unit and comply with the parking design standards detailed in Section 19.30.090.B.

F.

Tenancy. Tenancy of SRO shall be limited to thirty (30) or more days. Short-term rentals are not permitted.

G.

Existing Structures. An existing structure may be converted to an SRO Facility, consistent with the provisions of this section.

H.

Periodic Housing Inspection Program. An SRO Facility shall be subject to the requirements of Section 4-14.

I.

Development Standards.

1.

New buildings. When new buildings are proposed to be constructed, the building and site design shall comply with Division 19.27 of the Novato Municipal Code.

2.

Additions to existing buildings. When an addition to an existing building is proposed, and the addition does not exceed twenty-five (25) percent of the gross floor area of the existing building, the addition shall use the same exposed building materials and siding and colors of the existing building. When an addition to an existing building is proposed that exceeds twenty-five (25) percent of the gross floor area of the existing building, the entire building (existing building and proposed addition) shall comply with Division 19.27.

3.

Façade remodels. If a façade remodel is proposed, and the area of the façade remodel does not exceed twenty-five (25) percent of the wall area of the building elevation proposed to be altered, then the exposed building materials and siding and colors shall be the same as that of the existing façade proposed to be remodeled. If a façade remodel is proposed, and the area of the façade remodel exceeds twenty-five (25) percent of the wall area of the building elevation proposed to be altered, then the remodel shall comply with Division 19.27 of the Novato Municipal Code.

4.

Notwithstanding the requirements of subsections 2. or 3., immediately above, a Developer may voluntarily propose an addition or façade remodel that complies with Division 19.27 regardless of the size of the addition or façade remodel.

5.

A Single-room Occupancy Facility shall comply with all other applicable development and performance standards detailed in Article 2 and Article 3 of Chapter XIX (Zoning) of the Novato Municipal Code.

J.

Application Submittal, Review, and Approval Process.

1.

Application Submittal. A Zoning Clearance Application shall be submitted to the Community Development Department for review, and shall include the Zoning Clearance fee, as detailed on the City's Master Fee Schedule; plans and documents sufficient to demonstrate compliance with the development standards, design standards, and management requirement of this section; and those submittal requirements established by the Community Development Department.

2.

Review Timelines. An application shall be reviewed for completeness pursuant to Section 65943 of the California Government Code. Once an application has been deemed complete pursuant to Section 65943 of

the California Government Code, a decision regarding the application shall be made pursuant to the timelines of Section 65950 of the California Government Code.

(Ord. No. 1718, § 3(Exh. D), 9-10-2024)

19.34.130 - Outdoor Dining, Display, and Sales.

This Section provides development and operational standards for outdoor uses, including temporary outdoor display and sales, permanent outdoor display and sales and outdoor dining and seating areas.

A.

Temporary Outdoor Displays and Sales. Temporary outdoor displays and sales are allowed only in accordance with the following standards:

1.

Commercial Industrial Zones. Except for sale of certain seasonal products permitted in accordance with Section 19.42.040.D.8, temporary outdoor displays and sales shall be allowed in commercial or industrial districts only if:

a.

The merchandise is regularly sold indoors on the same site.

b.

Merchandise displays shall be located immediately adjacent to the sidewalk or the primary structure where the items are sold indoors.

c.

Merchandise shall be displayed in a planned, orderly and attractive manner as an extension of the window display and shall not constitute an expansion of the retail floor area (such as clothing racks).

d.

Merchandise displays shall not interfere with adjacent business displays, storefront, access, on-street parking or visibility.

e.

Displayed merchandise shall occupy a fixed, specifically approved and defined location that does not disrupt pedestrian traffic or obstruct access to on-street parking areas or driveways or encroach on landscape areas.

f.

Display fixtures shall be of good quality, sturdy, durable materials and construction.

g.

Merchandise displays shall not exceed a height of 8 feet above the sidewalk.

h.

Types of merchandise shall be rotated or changed periodically.

i.

Displays shall be removed during non-business hours.

2.

Downtown Core. Temporary outdoor displays and sales in compliance with Section 19.34.130 A.1 above shall be permitted on the sidewalk in the Downtown Core Retail and Business districts with a license agreement pursuant to Section 15-4 of the Novato Municipal Code.

3.

Residential Zones. In residential districts, garage sales, yard sales, or estate sales are permitted for no more than three (3) consecutive days within a ninety (90) day period.

B.

Temporary Seasonal Outdoor Displays and Sales. Temporary Use Permit approval shall comply with Section 19.42.040 (Temporary Use Permits), and shall include conditions of approval addressing the following issues, where applicable:

1.

Regulation of nuisance factors (e.g., prevention of glare or direct illumination on adjoining parcels, dirt, dust, gases, heat, noise, odors, smoke, waste, and vibration);

2.

Regulation of operating hours and days, including limitation of the duration of the activity;

3.

Adequate temporary parking facilities, vehicular and pedestrian circulation, including vehicular ingress and egress, and public transportation, if applicable, in compliance with 19.30 (Parking and Loading);

4.

If applicable, performance security to ensure that any temporary facilities or structures used would be removed from the site within a reasonable time following the activity, the property would be cleaned of debris, litter, or any other evidence of the temporary event upon completion or removal of the event, and restored to the former condition;

5.

Sanitary facilities, as deemed appropriate;

6.

Security and safety measures, if applicable and as deemed appropriate;

7.

Appropriate setbacks to ensure adequate separation from adjoining land uses and a safe environment for vehicles and pedestrians;

8.

Provision for solid, hazardous, and toxic waste collection, recycling, and/or disposal; and

9.

Other conditions that would ensure the orderly and efficient operation of the proposed temporary activity.

C.

Permanent Outdoor Displays on Private Property. The permanent outdoor display/sale of merchandise is allowed subject to the approval of a Use Permit, and Design Review where in accordance with the following standards:

1.

The outdoor display of merchandise shall not exceed a height of 8 feet above finish grade, unless a greater height is allowed by a Use Permit.

2.

Outdoor sales areas shall not encroach into required setback areas. In zoning districts where no setback area is required, the outdoor sales area shall be set back a minimum of 10 feet from adjoining property lines unless otherwise allowed by a required Use Permit.

3.

Displayed merchandise shall occupy a fixed, specifically approved, and defined location that does not disrupt the normal function of the site or its circulation, and does not encroach upon driveways, landscaped areas, parking spaces, or pedestrian walkways. Displays shall not obstruct sight distance visibility areas or otherwise create hazards for vehicle or pedestrian traffic.

4.

The outdoor display and sales area shall be directly related to a business occupying a permanent structure on the subject parcel.

5.

Outdoor sales and activity areas other than those for auto display and sales shall be screened from adjoining public rights-of-way by decorative walls, fences, sight-obscuring mesh, and/or landscaping in compliance with 19.20.090 (Screening).

6.

Additional signs, beyond those normally allowed for the subject use, shall not be provided as a result of the outdoor display and sales area.

Security lighting and glare controls.

D.

Outdoor Dining and Seating Areas. Outdoor dining and seating areas on private property are allowed, subject to the approval of a Use Permit and Design Review where applicable, and the following standards:

1.

Parking shall be provided in compliance with Division 19.30 (Parking and Loading).

2.

Outdoor dining areas shall:

a.

Be cleaned on a continual basis for removal of litter and food items which would constitute a nuisance to the public health, safety, and general welfare of the patrons and the community; and

b.

Contain waste receptacles for use by the public and/or restaurant employees.

3.

The following standards are intended to ensure compatibility with surrounding uses and a high standard of quality:

a.

Outdoor dining and seating areas:

(1)

And associated structural elements, awnings, covers, furniture, umbrellas or other physical elements that are visible from public rights-of-way, shall be compatible with the character of the main structures;

(2)

That provide entertainment, or amplified music may require the preparation of a noise analysis with appropriate mitigation measures, including limited hours of operation;

(3)

Shall not obstruct vehicular or pedestrian traffic flow and shall not necessitate the removal of existing vehicular or pedestrian movement areas; and

(4)

Shall be designed to mitigate noise and odor impacts on nearby residential areas.

b.

The use of awnings, plants, umbrellas, and other human-scale elements is encouraged to enhance the pedestrian experience.

4.

Downtown Core Retail and Business Districts. Outdoor dining and seating areas may be permitted within the public right-of-way if a license agreement is issued pursuant to Section 15-4 of the Novato Municipal Code. The standards in Section 19.34.130D above shall be applicable to the establishment and use of the outdoor dining and seating areas.

(Ord. No. 1576, § 2 (Exh. A, amd.), 10-23-2012)

19.34.140 - Outdoor Storage.

This Section provides standards for the establishment of outdoor storage areas, in compliance with Article 2 (Zoning Districts, Allowable Land Uses, and Zone-Specific Standards):

A.

Screening Required. Where allowed by Article 2 (Zoning Districts, Allowable Land Uses, and Zone-Specific Standards), outdoor storage areas shall be entirely enclosed and screened by a solid fence or wall a minimum of 6 feet in height in conjunction with landscape screening.

B.

Outdoor Storage of Vehicles. Refer to Section 19.34.170 (Vehicle Parking in Residential Zones) and 19.34.180 (Vehicle Repair in Residential Zones).

C.

Review and Approval Process. Any use proposing outdoor merchandise display or other outdoor business activities shall be subject to review and approval in compliance with 19.34.130 (Outdoor Dining, Displays and Sales), above.

(Ord. No. 1576, § 2 (Exh. A, amd.), 10-23-2012)

19.34.150 - Recycling Facilities.

This Section provides locational and operational standards for the establishment of various types and sizes of commercial recycling facilities, in compliance with Article 2 (Zoning Districts, Allowable Land Uses, and ZoneSpecific Standards). Recycling facilities shall comply with the following standards:

A.

Reverse Vending Machines. Reverse vending machines shall comply with the following standards:

1.

Accessory Use Only. The machines shall be installed only as an accessory use to a primary permitted use in compliance with the applicable provisions of this Zoning Ordinance, and shall not require additional parking.

2.

Location Requirements. If located outside of a structure, the machines shall not occupy required parking spaces, and shall be constructed of durable waterproof and rustproof materials.

3.

Maximum Size. When located outdoors, the area occupied by the machines shall not exceed 50 square feet, nor eight feet in height, including any protective enclosure.

4.

Signs. Signs shall not exceed a maximum area of four square feet for each machine, exclusive of operating instructions.

5.

Hours of Operation. The machines shall have operating hours which are consistent with the operating hours of the primary use.

6.

Lighting. The machines shall be illuminated when needed to ensure comfortable and safe operation, in compliance with 19.22.080 (Outdoor Light and Glare).

B.

Small Collection Facilities. Small collection facilities shall comply with the following standards:

1.

Location Requirements. Small collection facilities shall:

a.

Not be located within 50 feet of any parcel zoned or occupied for residential use; and

b.

Be set back at least 10 feet from any public right-of-way, private street, or driveway and not obstruct vehicular or pedestrian circulation.

2.

Maximum Size. A small collection facility shall not occupy more than 350 square feet nor three parking spaces, not including space that would be periodically needed for the removal of materials or exchange of containers.

3.

Appearance of Facility. Collection containers and site fencing shall be of a color and design that is compatible and harmonious with the surrounding uses and neighborhoods.

Operating Standards. Small collection facilities shall:

a.

Not use power-driven processing equipment, except for reverse vending machines;

b.

Accept only glass, metal or plastic containers, paper, and reusable items; and

c.

Use containers that are constructed with durable waterproof and rustproof material(s), secured from unauthorized removal of material, and shall be of a capacity sufficient to accommodate materials collected and the collection schedule.

5.

Signs. Signs may be provided as follows:

a.

Identification signs are allowed with a maximum area of 15 percent for each side of the structure or 12 square feet, whichever is greater. In the case of a wheeled facility, the side shall be measured from the ground to the top of the container;

b.

Signs shall be both compatible and harmonious with the character of their location; and

c.

Directional signs consistent with Chapter 19.32 (Signs) may be approved by the Director if found necessary to facilitate traffic circulation, or if the facility is not visible from the public right-of-way.

6.

Parking Requirements.

a.

No additional parking space shall be required for customers of a small collection facility located in the established parking lot of the primary use. One additional space shall be provided for the attendant, if needed.

b.

Mobile recycling units shall have an area clearly marked to prohibit other vehicular parking during hours when the mobile unit is scheduled to be present; and

c.

Use of parking spaces by the patrons and the attendant shall not reduce available parking spaces below the minimum number required for the main use unless a parking study shows that existing capacity is not fully

utilized during the time the recycling facility would be on the site.

C.

Large Collection Facilities. A collection facility that is larger than 350 square feet, or on a separate parcel not accessory to a primary use, shall comply with the following standards:

1.

Location Requirements. The facility shall not abut a parcel zoned for residential use.

2.

Container Location. Any containers provided for "after hours" donation of recyclable materials shall be permanently located at least 100 feet from any residential zoning district, constructed of sturdy, rustproof material(s), have sufficient capacity to accommodate materials collected, and be secured from unauthorized entry or removal of materials; and

3.

Screening. The facility shall be screened from public rights-of-way, by solid masonry walls or located within an enclosed structure.

4.

Setbacks, Landscaping. Structure setbacks and landscaping shall be provided as required for the applicable zoning district.

5.

Outdoor Storage. Exterior storage of material shall be in sturdy containers that are secured and maintained in good condition. Storage shall not be visible above the height of the required solid masonry walls.

6.

Operating Standards.

a.

The site shall be maintained clean, sanitary, and free of litter and any other trash or rubbish, shall be cleaned of loose debris on a daily basis, and shall be maintained free from rodents and other disease vectors.

b.

Dust, fumes, odor, smoke, or vibration, above ambient levels, shall not be detectable on adjoining parcels.

D.

Processing Facilities. Processing facilities shall comply with the following standards:

1.

Location Requirements. The facility shall not abut a parcel zoned or occupied for residential use.

2.

Limitation on Activities. Allowed activities are limited to baling, briquetting, compacting, crushing, grinding, shredding, and sorting of source-separated recyclable materials and repairing of reusable materials. The facility shall not bale, compact, or shred ferrous metals, other than beverage and food containers. Outbound truck shipments from the site shall not exceed an average of two each day.

3.

Maximum Size. The facility shall not exceed 45,000 square feet of floor or ground area.

4.

Container Location. Containers provided for "after hours" donation of recyclable materials shall be permanently located at least 100 feet from any residential zoning district, constructed of sturdy, rustproof materials, have sufficient capacity to accommodate materials collected, and be secured from unauthorized entry or removal of the materials; and

5.

Screening. The facility shall be screened from public rights-of-way, by solid masonry walls or located within an enclosed structure;

6.

Outdoor Storage. Exterior storage of material shall be in sturdy containers or enclosures that are secured and maintained in good condition. Storage shall not be visible above the height of the required solid masonry walls;

7.

Operating Standards. Dust, fumes, odor, smoke, or vibration, above ambient levels, shall not be detectable on adjoining parcels.

(Ord. No. 1576, § 2 (Exh. A, amd.), 10-23-2012)

19.34.160 - Residential Care Facilities for the Elderly (RCFE).

A.

Purpose. This Section establishes zoning and physical standards for residential care facilities for the elderly (RCFE) serving seven (7) or more residents where allowed by Article 2 in certain zoning districts. These provisions are intended to enhance the public welfare and help attain the housing and human services goals, policies and programs of the General Plan.

B.

Limitation on facilities and services. If proposed as a Continuing Care Retirement Community pursuant to Health and Safety Code Section 1770 through 1793.91, the RCFE shall provide no more than twenty-five percent of the dwelling units for skilled nursing care.

C.

Physical Standards.

1.

Setbacks. Front, side and rear yard setbacks and setbacks between buildings shall be established by the applicable zoning district, and may be reduced with consideration of the site characteristics and compatibility with surrounding development as part of a Master Plan and Precise Development Plan approval, or by the approval of a Variance in accordance with Section 19.42.070, on a case-by-case basis.

2.

Site Coverage.

a.

Buildings. The total ground floor area of all buildings within an RCFE, other than open carports, shall not exceed 50 percent of the total lot area. Increases may be granted by the Review Authority on a case-by-case basis as part of a Master Plan and Precise Development Plan approval.

b.

Landscaping and Open Space. A minimum of 30 percent of the site shall be maintained as landscaping and open space.

3.

Floor Area Ratio (FAR). The total floor area of all buildings on the site shall not exceed 60 percent (0.6 FAR) of the total lot area or as otherwise provided by the General Plan.

4.

Height Limit. The maximum height of all structures shall be 35 feet. The Review Authority may grant increases in building height with consideration of the site characteristics and compatibility with surrounding development on a case-by-case basis as part of a Master Plan and Precise Development Plan approval.

5.

Parking. Off-street parking shall be provided at a ratio of one parking space for each three beds.

D.

Design Standards. An RCFE serving seven (7) or more residents shall be subject to Design Review. The following criteria shall be considered in addition to those listed in Section 19.42.030 (Design Review):

1.

New buildings. When new buildings are proposed to be constructed to house an RCFE, the building and site design shall comply with Division 19.27 of the Novato Municipal Code.

2.

Additions to existing buildings. When an addition to an existing building is proposed, and the addition does not exceed twenty-five (25) percent of the gross floor area of the existing building, the addition shall match the building materials and exterior colors of the existing building. When an addition to an existing building is proposed that exceeds twenty-five (25) percent of the gross floor area of the existing building, the entire building (existing building and proposed addition) shall comply with Division 19.27.

3.

Façade remodels. If a façade remodel is proposed, and the area of the façade remodel does not exceed twenty-five (25) percent of the wall area of the building elevation proposed to be altered, then the exposed building and siding materials and colors shall match that of the existing façade proposed to be remodeled. If a façade remodel is proposed, and the area of the façade remodel exceeds twenty-five (25) percent of the wall area of the building elevation proposed to be altered, then the remodel shall comply with Division 19.27 of the Novato Municipal Code.

4.

Notwithstanding the requirements of subsections 2. or 3., immediately above, an applicant may voluntarily propose an addition or façade remodel that complies with Division 19.27 regardless of the size of the addition or façade remodel.

5.

An RCFE shall comply with all other applicable development and performance standards detailed in Article 2 and Article 3 of Chapter XIX (Zoning) of the Novato Municipal Code.

E.

Building, Fire, Health, Safety and Occupancy Standards. Residential care facilities for the elderly shall meet all applicable building, fire, safety and health code requirements of the Federal Government (ADA - Americans with Disabilities Act of 1990), State of California, Marin County and the City of Novato. All permits issued by the City will be subject to initial and continuing compliance with all such applicable requirements.

F.

Affordable Unit Requirements.

1.

Number of Units Required. Projects of 10 or more units shall set aside 10 percent of the units for occupancy by persons of very low and low income. If an RCFE is a life care facility which includes a skilled nursing component, the affordable unit requirement shall be calculated excluding the portion of the project to be devoted to skilled nursing.

2.

Agreement with City Required. The property owner shall execute and record an agreement with the City agreeing to the requirements of this Section. The agreement shall be reviewed by the City Attorney's Office and approved by the final Review Authority for the project. The agreement shall include the following provisions:

a.

Identification of the number of affordable units;

b.

A minimum term of 30 years on the set aside units; and

c.

Compliance with the agreement shall be reviewed annually by the Director.

(Ord. No. 1576, § 2 (Exh. A, amd.), 10-23-2012; Ord. No. 1723, § 3(Exh. B), 3-25-2025)

19.34.164 - Residential Subdivision Architectural Design Standards.

Proposed residential subdivisions should be designed to avoid identical or similar facades on opposing or adjacent lots. Variation in roof styles, reversed building footprints, and changes in elevation for the same unit floor plan are encouraged.

(Ord. No. 1576, § 2 (Exh. A, amd.), 10-23-2012)

19.34.166 - Tobacco Product Shops.

A tobacco product shop business may be located only in a zoning district where allowed by Article 2 (Zoning Districts, Allowable Land Uses, and Zone-Specific Standards), and only on a site that also complies with the requirements of this Section.

A.

Separation from Incompatible Uses. A tobacco product shop business shall not be located within:

1.

1,000 feet from any school, public park or other land use accommodating or oriented to minors as determined by the Zoning Administrator (for example, video game arcades, skating rinks, pizza parlors, teen centers, etc.); or

2.

500 feet from any residential zoning district or conforming residential use (i.e., mixed use project)

(Ord. No. 1576, § 2 (Exh. A, amd.), 10-23-2012)

19.34.168 - Tattoo Parlors.

A tattoo parlor business may be located only in a zoning district where allowed by Article 2 (Zoning Districts, Allowable Land Uses, and Zone-Specific Standards), and only on a site that also complies with the requirements of this Section.

A.

Separation from Incompatible Uses. A tattoo parlor business shall not be located within:

1,000 feet from any school, public park or other land use accommodating or oriented to minors as determined by the Zoning Administrator (for example, video game arcades, skating rinks, pizza parlors, teen centers, etc.); or

2.

500 feet from any residential zoning district or conforming residential use (i.e., mixed use project).

(Ord. No. 1576, § 2 (Exh. A, amd.), 10-23-2012)

19.34.170 - Vehicle Parking and Storage in Residential Zones.

A.

Enclosed Areas. A person may park or store any number of operable or inoperable motor or recreational vehicles (including motorcycles, campers, snowmobiles, jet skis, off-road vehicles, boats or trailers) if completely confined within a building, garage or accessory structure that screens the vehicles from view from adjacent streets and properties and, the enclosed parking is maintained in compliance with Division 19.30 (Parking and Loading).

B.

Outdoors. A maximum of four vehicles including all types of operable or inoperable motor or recreational vehicles, motorcycles, campers, snowmobiles, jet skis, off-road vehicles, boats, and trailers may be parked or stored outdoors only under the following conditions:

1.

Only operable vehicles may be parked in the front yard area. The parking area shall be on a paved driveway in compliance with Division 19.30.070 (Parking Design Standards), Section 19.20.100E (Limitations on the Use of Setbacks), and where adequate sight distance is maintained in compliance with Section 19.20.070 D (Sight Visibility Area Required).

2.

Inoperable vehicles shall not be stored or parked within the required parking areas, front yard or street side yard areas. A person may park or store inoperable or non-operable vehicles only if completely confined within a building, garage or accessory structure; or, in a rear or side yard area where the vehicles are screened from view from adjacent streets and properties.

C.

Habitation Prohibited. Operable or inoperable motor or recreational vehicles, as described in 19.34.170A, stored or parked on a private parcel located in a residential parcel located in a residential zoning district, shall not be used as a temporary or permanent living quarters.

(Ord. No. 1576, § 2 (Exh. A, amd.), 10-23-2012)

19.34.180 - Vehicle Repair in Residential Zones.

A.

Repair of Vehicles. Non-commercial service, repair, assembly, modification, restoration, or other work on any motor or recreational vehicle, trailer, or boat may be allowed only under the following conditions:

1.

The vehicle or boat is owned by a person who resides on the parcel where the work is being done; and

2.

The property resident is doing the work (repair, assembly, etc.); and

3.

The work is completely confined within a garage or carport; or

4.

The work or materials are not located within a front or street side yard setback, and is screened from view from adjacent streets and properties.

B.

Storage of Vehicle Repair Materials, Parts, Etc. The non-commercial storage of tools, equipment, machinery, parts, or other vehicle repair materials may be allowed only under the following conditions:

1.

The tools, equipment, machinery, parts, or other related materials are owned by a person who resides on the parcel where they are stored; and

2.

The tools, equipment, machinery, parts, or other related materials are completely confined within a building; or

3.

The tools, equipment, machinery, parts, or other related materials are not located within a front or street side setback and are screened from view from adjacent streets and properties.

(Ord. No. 1576, § 2 (Exh. A, amd.), 10-23-2012)

19.34.190 - Massage Establishments.

This subsection provides the operational and permitting standards for massage establishments, in compliance with State law, Article 2 (Zoning Districts, Allowable Land Uses, and Zone-Specific Standards), and Article 4 (Land Use and Development Permit Procedures). In addition to the provisions of Article 2 and Article 4, all massage establishments shall comply with the requirements of Section 8-4.

A.

A massage establishment may be located only in a zoning district where allowed by Article 2 (Zoning Districts, Allowable Land Uses, and Zone-Specific Standards).

B.

Inspection Required. A massage establishment shall be inspected by the building division for conformance with building, fire and safety codes prior to issuance of a use permit.

C.

Pre-existing Uses. Any legally established massage establishments that became nonconforming upon adoption of this section may continue to operate as nonconforming uses in compliance with the provisions of Section 19.52 (Nonconforming Uses, Structures, and Parcels), provided, however, that all such nonconforming uses shall, upon the effective date thereof, be required to comply with the provisions of Section 8-4. In addition to those provisions, nonconforming establishments shall be required to apply for a use permit in compliance with subsection 19.42.050 (Use Permits) if any of the following occur after the effective date of this section:

1.

The Operator or any Massage Technician or employee of the massage establishment is found to have violated any of the applicable provisions of Section 8-4.

(Ord. No. 1611, § 7(Exh. F), 11-29-2016)

19.34.200 - Agricultural Worker Housing Center.

This subsection provides the operations and permitting standards for Agricultural Worker Housing Center. Where allowed in the applicable zoning district by Article 2 (Zoning Districts, Allowable Land Uses, and ZoneSpecific Standards), an Agricultural Worker Housing Center shall satisfy the requirements of this section and satisfy the requirements of Section 17021.6 of California Health and Safety Code.

A.

Application, Submittal, Review, and Approval Process.

1.

Application Submittal. A Zoning Clearance Application shall be submitted to the Community Development Department for review, and shall include the Zoning Clearance fee, as detailed on the City's Master Fee Schedule; sufficient documentation that the use will comply with Sections 17021.6 of California Health and Safety Code; and those submittal requirements established by the Community Development Department.

B.

Size. Agricultural housing units shall be clustered and shall occupy an area of no more than one-half (1/2) contiguous acre per parcel. No more than twelve (12) agricultural worker housing units or a single building that contains no more than thirty-six (36) beds, and other facilities associated with a residence, may be developed within the one-half (1/2) acre area.

C.

Occupancy. Agricultural worker housing shall be occupied by agricultural employees. The family members of an agricultural employee residing in agricultural worker housing are allowed occupants.

D.

Deed Restriction. Prior to the issuance of a building permit for an Agricultural Worker Housing Center, a covenant of restriction to run with the land shall be recorded which specifies that the agricultural worker housing center cannot be sold separately, that the housing shall only be used to house agricultural workers and their families, and that these restrictions shall be binding on successors in ownership.

E.

Development Standards.

1.

New buildings. When new buildings are proposed to be constructed, the building and site design shall comply with Division 19.27 of the Novato Municipal Code.

2.

Additions to existing buildings. When an addition to an existing building is proposed, and the addition does not exceed twenty-five (25) percent of the gross floor area of the existing building, the addition shall use the same exposed building materials and siding and colors as the existing building. When an addition to an existing building is proposed that exceeds twenty-five (25) percent of the gross floor area of the existing building, the entire building (existing building and proposed addition) shall comply with Division 19.27.

3.

Façade remodels. If a façade remodel is proposed, and the area of the façade remodel does not exceed twenty-five (25) percent of the wall area of the building elevation proposed to be altered, then the exposed building materials and siding and colors shall be the same as that of the existing façade proposed to be remodeled. If a façade remodel is proposed, and the area of the façade remodel exceeds twenty-five (25) percent of the wall area of the building elevation proposed to be altered, then the façade remodel shall comply with Division 19.27 of the Novato Municipal Code.

4.

Notwithstanding the requirements of subsections b. or c., immediately above, a Developer may voluntarily propose an addition or façade remodel that complies with Division 19.27 regardless of the size of the addition or façade remodel.

5.

An Agricultural Worker Housing Center shall comply with all other applicable development and performance standards detailed in Article 2 and Article 3 of Chapter XIX (Zoning) of the Novato Municipal Code.

(Ord. No. 1718, § 3(Exh. C), 9-10-2024)

DIVISION 19.35 - WATERWAY AND RIPARIAN PROTECTION

19.35.010 - Purpose of Division.

This Division provides standards for the protection, maintenance, enhancement and restoration of streams and waterways in a manner which preserves and enhances their ecological integrity and resource functions and value. The purpose of this Division is to establish adequate buffer areas along watercourses to avoid flood hazards and maintain or expand storage capacity for flood waters; protect water quality and in-stream habitat; preserve, enhance and restore riparian habitat and adjacent wetlands and upland buffers; and, provide for continuous wildlife migration corridors connecting habitat areas. The intent is to allow development, which is compatible with the important physical, habitat, aesthetic, and recreational functions of waterways, while ensuring that these functions and values are protected in perpetuity.

(Ord. No. 1576, § 2 (Exh. A, amd.), 10-23-2012)

19.35.020 - Applicability.

A.

Stream Protection Zone. The standards and requirements of this Division shall apply to all lands adjoining or encompassing watercourses shown on EN Map 1 of the General Plan and their significant tributaries as determined by the Director. A Stream Protection Zone shall be established, which shall include the stream bed, the stream banks, all riparian vegetation and an upland buffer zone at least 50 feet wide, measured from the top of the channel bank. The Stream Protection Zone shall be expanded based on individual site evaluations to encompass the existing riparian vegetation and adjacent habitat areas including upland buffers or may be reduced if physical conditions so warrant through the adoption of the Stream Management Plan.

B.

Waiver/Non-Applicability. In developed areas where the existing site and upstream and downstream conditions preclude the establishment the Stream Protection Zone or where the watercourse is owned, managed, and maintained by a qualified public agency and adequate stream buffer areas are provided, the Director may waive the required Use Permit and Stream Management Plan (SMP) and shall establish a minimum stream buffer area/setback requirement and/or development standard as a condition of approval. The Director may require the applicant to submit documentation to support the waiver and define an appropriate setback or development standard.

Routine stream management and maintenance activities authorized or carried out by qualified public agencies are exempt from these provisions.

C.

Additional Standards. Proposed development that is subject to the provisions of this Division shall also comply with the provisions of Municipal Code Section 7-4.11 (Watercourse Protection).

(Ord. No. 1576, § 2 (Exh. A, amd.), 10-23-2012)

19.35.030 - Permit Requirements.

Proposed development, land uses and activities including any proposed development application, land division, use permit, grading or building permit for any excavation, fill, grading, or paving; removal or planting of vegetation; construction, alteration, or removal of any structure; or alteration of any embankment within the Stream Protection Zone shall require Use Permit approval.

A.

Stream Management Plan. Use Permit review and approval shall include the review and approval of a SMP developed in compliance with the City's Stream Management Guidelines.

B.

Maintenance and Management Provisions. The Use Permit shall address annual maintenance requirements and management activities, which shall be included, reviewed and approved as part of the SMP and incorporated into the project.

C.

Action by Review Authority. The Zoning Administrator may approve a Use Permit and SMP subject to the findings contained in Section 19.35.070 for the minor activities, land uses or development in or near a stream or watercourse, including:

1.

Minor road crossings, driveways, pedestrian bridges and pathways, and utilities;

2.

Bank stabilization and erosion control projects involving less than 30 linear feet;

3.

Enhancement and restoration projects involving no mitigation of wetlands or riparian resources; and

4.

Single-family homes and accessory structures and any permitted land use on lots in existing developed areas.

The Commission shall review and approve or disapprove all other Use Permit applications within the Stream Protection Zone.

(Ord. No. 1576, § 2 (Exh. A, amd.), 10-23-2012)

19.35.040 - Application Requirements.

Applications for projects subject to the requirements of this Division shall include a SMP prepared by qualified persons experienced in the development and implementation of riparian restoration and enhancement plans. The SMP shall:

A.

Assess existing conditions and resources on the site and adjacent resources located upstream and downstream or adjacent to the project area. A written description and site plan drawn to scale shall be required illustrating existing topography and adjacent land uses, stream banks, vegetation, structures, paving, access roads and trails, fencing, accessory uses, utilities and easements.

B.

Define the boundaries of the Stream Protection Zone and identify site specific objectives for protection of the resources in compliance with the purpose of this Division. The SMP shall address water quality, flood management, vegetation, fishery, wildlife, and channel stability issues. The objectives may include public access or passive recreation and such other issues as may be required by the Director.

C.

Include measures to protect, enhance and restore native vegetation and wildlife habitat and shall define site preparation, exotic species removal, site grading, erosion control, channel stabilization, habitat preservation methods, fishery enhancement, and revegetation or enhancement plans, as appropriate and such other information as may be required by the Director.

D.

Specify an ongoing long-term management program to ensure the protection of riparian resources, wildlife and fisheries habitat and meet objectives for water quality and flood management. The management program shall specify annual maintenance requirements and the responsibility for implementation and funding. Maintenance responsibility and funding mechanism shall be established in a long-term maintenance agreement or other mechanism approved by the Director prior to final approval of any development permit, land division, or building or grading permit.

E.

If it includes a mitigation or restoration component, the SMP shall specify mitigation goals and define performance standards or success criteria and shall include a construction and minimum 10-year postconstruction monitoring program and funding mechanism (bond, trust fund or other method) to ensure that the project goals and performance standards are met. The monitoring period may be reduced if a finding is made that the performance standards and success criteria are met. Annual reports and a final report, prepared by a qualified expert, documenting the success of the mitigation project shall be submitted by the applicant to the City and other responsible or permitting agencies. The monitoring program shall include provision for remedial action as needed to correct deficiencies and shall be integrated with an annual maintenance program. If the performance standards or success criteria are not met, an additional period of correction and monitoring shall be specified until the performance standards or success criteria are met.

and other responsible or permitting agencies. The monitoring program shall include provision for remedial action as needed to correct deficiencies and shall be integrated with an annual maintenance program. If the performance standards or success criteria are not met, an additional period of correction and monitoring shall be specified until the performance standards or success criteria are met.

The SMP shall be referred to the California Department of Fish and Game for review and comment, prior to project approval.

(Ord. No. 1576, § 2 (Exh. A, amd.), 10-23-2012)

19.35.050 - Limitations on Land Use.

A.

Uses permitted within the Stream Protection Zone shall be limited to native landscaping, fencing, maintenance roads, utilities, storm drains, trails and passive (low-impact) recreation. Fencing and structures shall be set back to provide for unobstructed flow of flood waters and continuous wildlife migration corridors along the riparian areas.

B.

The area within the Stream Protection Zone may be used to calculate allowable residential densities or applied to the landscape area requirements for non-residential uses in accordance with provisions of the primary zoning district.

C.

Encroachments of parking areas, access roads, bridges, structures and other uses may be conditionally permitted by the Review Authority where the following findings are first made:

1.

The proposed use, structure or encroachment cannot be feasibly located outside the Stream Protection Zone or such location would have a more adverse effect on the stream environment; and

2.

Measures are included that provide adequate protection of wildlife habitat, water quality and in-stream habitat, and capacity for flood management; or

3.

The strict application of these limitations would result in a taking of the property without just compensation.

(Ord. No. 1576, § 2 (Exh. A, amd.), 10-23-2012)

19.35.060 - Watercourse Protection Standards and Design Criteria.

Proposed developments, uses, alterations or encroachments within or near watercourses shall comply with the following standards and design criteria:

A.

Stream Buffer Zone. A Stream Buffer Zone shall be established for preservation, restoration or enhancement of riparian vegetation and adjacent upland habitat. The Stream Buffer Zone shall include adjacent upland habitat for sensitive species and wildlife migration, as well as, providing for filtration of sediment and contaminants in storm runoff and allow infiltration of rainfall to maintain an adequate water budget to support the riparian and wetland habitat. Upland buffers shall consist of grasses and native shrubs to be maintained in a natural state.

1.

Removal of existing riparian vegetation shall be avoided to the maximum extent feasible and limited to the minimum amount necessary, except for exotic, invasive species or other vegetation identified on an approved SMP.

2.

Grading, fill, earthwork, or soil compaction, within the Stream Protection Zone shall be avoided or minimized to the maximum extent feasible. During construction, protective fencing shall be installed along existing riparian vegetation to include a buffer area extending beyond the dripline of the tree canopy to protect the root structure. The extent of the buffer area shall be determined based upon the tree species. If encroachment

within the root zones of significant trees cannot be avoided, then a certified arborist shall be retained to provide recommendations for less damaging construction practices and long-term maintenance.

3.

Root zone areas of native oaks and riparian vegetation shall be maintained in a natural state. All turf areas, irrigation and drainage shall be designed to drain away from valley oaks and creek corridors to avoid long-term impacts of irrigation and chemical use of pesticides and herbicides.

4.

In disturbed areas, the stream buffer zone shall include area for restoration or enhancement of riparian vegetation to provide for a continuous riparian corridor connecting habitat areas.

5.

Fencing may be required along the Stream Buffer Zone to separate public or private use areas from the creek corridor and prevent encroachment in habitat areas. Fencing shall be designed to permit emergency and maintenance access. Fencing shall not obstruct wildlife migration corridors and shall be designed 6-inches above the ground to allow for passage of small mammals and other species.

B.

Alterations of Stream Channel or Banks. The streambed and stream banks shall not be filled, graded, excavated, or obstructed by any development, construction, or activity associated with such development, nor shall vegetation in the streambed or on the stream banks be cut or removed, except for the following circumstances:

1.

Placement of City-approved storm drain and irrigation outflows. Such outflows and the associated drainage facilities shall be designed so as to eliminate or minimize increases in the rate and amount of storm or irrigation water discharge.

2.

Placement of public and non-public utility lines.

3.

Construction of bridges and their connecting roadways.

4.

Maintenance activities necessary to prevent flooding, reduce siltation, or otherwise provide for the public health and safety.

5.

Work identified in an approved SMP.

C.

Slope Protection and Bank Stabilization. In areas with bank failure or high scour potential, slope protection and biotechnical bank stabilization measures, designed by a qualified registered engineer, may be required and incorporated into the SMP.

D.

Alterations Within the Stream Buffer Zone. The stream protection zone shall not be filled, graded, excavated, or obstructed, nor shall vegetation in the riparian zone be cut or removed, except for the following circumstances:

1.

Construction of facilities for low intensity, passive recreation (e.g., pedestrian and bicycle trails and paths, and foot bridges), nature study or conservation uses approved by the Director.

2.

Restoration, enhancement and maintenance activities, including removal of debris when necessary to protect the public health and safety, or minor weed abatement activity necessary to protect life or property.

3.

Work identified in an approved SMP.

E.

Mitigation, Restoration and Enhancement. Any use or encroachment within the stream Protection Zone shall require mitigation in order to offset the intrusion of human use and limit flood hazards. Mitigation measures shall be incorporated into the SMP to address the existing site conditions and provide additional buffering of wildlife corridors, connect habitat areas and maintain adequate capacity for flood flows. Revegetation program and planting plans shall use indigenous plants in accordance with the City's Stream Management Guidelines.

F.

Erosion Control. All work within stream protection zones shall be kept to the minimum amount necessary to accomplish the goals of this Division. The SMP shall include erosion control and a Stormwater Pollution Prevention Plan utilizing the following best management practices:

1.

Earth work within the Stream Protection Zone shall be permitted only between April 15 and October 15. When necessary, extensions of this time period may be granted by the City Engineer on a case-by-case basis.

2.

Disturbed areas shall be revegetated by October 15. When necessary, extensions of this deadline may be granted by the City Engineer on a case-by-case basis.

3.

Where needed to prevent erosion, exposed soil surfaces shall be hydromulched or stabilized by other erosion control measures prior to October 15. When necessary, extensions of this deadline may be granted by the City Engineer on a case-by-case basis.

4.

Special care shall be taken to avoid removal of vegetation immediately adjacent to the stream banks except for exotic, invasive species or other vegetation identified in the approved SMP.

G.

Urban Runoff and Stormwater Discharges. Any project subject to the requirements of this Division shall incorporate best management practices into the SMP to address potential for long-term water quality impacts related to urban runoff and stormwater discharges including the following, as appropriate:

1.

Where practical, street runoff should be conveyed through vegetated swales or retained in small detention basin or landscape areas which serve to filter and absorb sediment and chemical constituents in urban runoff prior to entering a stream channel, wetland habitat or storm drain.

2.

Provision for vegetated streamside buffer areas separating formal landscape and developed areas from creek channels and drainageways shall be provided. The stream buffer zone shall be landscaped with grasses and native plant species to filter and absorb sediment and chemical constituents and provide a zone for rainfall infiltration next to the creek channel.

3.

Development of a program of parking lot sweeping should be provided for large parking or high volume traffic areas along with an appropriate funding mechanism. Alternatively, filters of oil and contaminants may be incorporated into the design of storm drain drop inlets where an annual maintenance program is provided.

4.

Pesticides and fertilizers shall not be applied to public landscape areas, or any creekside maintenance accessway during the rainy season (October 15 - April 30).

5.

All drainage improvement plans shall include installation of permanent signs (concrete stamps or equivalent) at each storm drain inlet. The sign at each inlet shall read "No Dumping, Flows To San Francisco Bay" or equivalent, and shall be installed at the time of construction and verified prior to acceptance of public improvements or issuance of a certificate of occupancy.

H.

Long-Term Maintenance/Management. As a condition of approval for any project subject to the requirements of this Division, provision for long-term management and maintenance shall be provided along with a funding mechanism. Long-term maintenance and management plans shall include annual inspections and provisions to maintain hydraulic capacity of the stream channel, as well as protect, restore and enhance aquatic and riparian habitat. Management plans may include provisions for debris and sediment removal, clearing of brush and other vegetation that trap sediment, and shall specify methods to preserve, enhance and restore riparian vegetation.

The City may allow dedication to the City, the Marin County Flood Control District, Marin County Open Space District or other appropriate public or private entity, of a conservation easement or fee interest for long-term preservation and management of the Stream Protection Zone as determined necessary for flood control, water quality, and wildlife habitat.

(Ord. No. 1576, § 2 (Exh. A, amd.), 10-23-2012)

19.35.070 - Findings for Approval.

The approval of any project subject to the requirements of this Division shall require that the Review Authority first find that a SMP has been prepared and incorporated into the project in accordance with this Division, including measures to:

A.

Preserve, enhance and/or restore wildlife habitat, riparian vegetation and adjacent upland buffers;

B.

Protect water quality and in-stream habitat including erosion and urban runoff controls; and

C.

Address potential flood hazards and define responsibility and funding mechanism for long-term maintenance of hydraulic capacity and floodplain management.

These findings shall be in addition to those required for Use Permit approval by Section 19.42.050 (Use Permits).

(Ord. No. 1576, § 2 (Exh. A, amd.), 10-23-2012)

19.35.080 - Conditions of Approval.

Prior to issuance of a grading or building permit or approval of any improvement plans for earthwork within any creek corridor or identified wetland site, proof of authorization from all applicable responsible agencies including, but not limited to, the U.S. Army Corps of Engineers, the California Regional Water Quality Control Board, and the California Department of Fish and Game, shall be submitted by the applicant.

(Ord. No. 1576, § 2 (Exh. A, amd.), 10-23-2012)

DIVISION 19.36 - WETLAND PROTECTION AND RESTORATION

19.36.010 - Purpose of Division.

This Division provides procedures and standards for identifying and protecting wetland resources, and permitting wetland restoration, enhancement, and mitigation projects.

(Ord. No. 1576, § 2 (Exh. A, amd.), 10-23-2012)

19.36.020 - Applicability.

The standards of this Division apply to all lands within the City that support wetlands as delineated by the U.S. Army Corps of Engineers (Corps) under provisions of the Clean Water Act. The delineation of wetlands is subject to the procedures specified in the "Federal Manual for Identifying and Delineating Jurisdictional Wetlands." The standards of this Division do not apply to treatment wetlands or drainage ways considered "other waters" under the Clean Water Act.

(Ord. No. 1576, § 2 (Exh. A, amd.), 10-23-2012)

19.36.030 - General Wetland Preservation and Enhancement Standards.

A.

Development shall be designed and constructed to avoid wetlands to the maximum extent feasible.

B.

Any permitted development, grading, fill, excavation, or shading within a wetland shall provide for the mitigation of wetland loss at a minimum replacement ratio of 2:1 or greater, and shall ensure that there is no net loss of wetland functions and values.

C.

Off-site mitigation of impacted wetlands may be considered where on-site mitigation is not possible. Off-site mitigation shall provide for a minimum mitigation ratio of 3:1 or greater and must be located within the Novato area watershed.

(Ord. No. 1576, § 2 (Exh. A, amd.), 10-23-2012)

19.36.040 - Permit Requirements.

Use Permit approval is required for any project within 50 feet of a wetland or requiring wetland protection measures or involving wetland fill/encroachment, or requiring wetland mitigation; and, for all wetland protection, restoration, enhancement and/or mitigation projects, in addition to compliance with Municipal Code Section 19.20.050 (Grading), and Chapter VI (Excavation and Fills).

(Ord. No. 1576, § 2 (Exh. A, amd.), 10-23-2012)

19.36.050 - Application Requirements—Wetland Management Plan.

The Use Permit application shall include a wetland delineation, and a Wetlands Management Plan prepared by a qualified wetlands expert. The Wetlands Management Plan shall comply with the City's Stream Management Guidelines, and the standards and design criteria in Section 19.36.070. The Wetlands Management Plan shall include all of the following, and any additional information deemed necessary by the Director:

A.

Goals and Objectives. These shall include a description of the functional relationship of the existing and proposed wetland areas, such as habitat area, type, topography and soil characteristics, water flow patterns and water levels, and upland buffers.

B.

Site Plan. A site plan of the restoration or mitigation area shall identify the location and size of wetland areas to be preserved, restored, or created, and shall include the following:

1.

Grading Plan. Show topography detailed at one-foot increments along with any grading, excavation and/or fill plan. Submit footprints of all improvements indicating heights of all structures as well as access routes for maintenance and monitoring and all uses/structures within 200 feet of the property.

2.

Drainage Plan. Indicate water flow and drainage patterns along with any estimated volume exchange rates.

3.

Planting Plan. Identify the location of flora and fauna habitat areas and types, and any planting plans.

C.

Proposed Techniques and Standards. The application shall include, as applicable, the following wetland preservation, restoration, and creation techniques and standards, indicating processes, practices and criteria used in identifying the wetlands and the adjoining upland buffer required by 19.36.070.

1.

Watershed area and hydrology, water sources, water depths, water-control structures, water-quality watershed area and hydrology parameters, including treatment of urban runoff and water-level maintenance practices needed to achieve the necessary ambient water conditions and characteristics along with a stormwater management plan which identifies potential pollutants and ensures that runoff is substantially free of debris, pollutants and silt. Stormwater runoff management systems may include treatment swales, retention ponds, and other natural treatment systems. Treatment wetlands shall not be considered as habitat mitigation, but may address water quality functions of the impacted wetlands.

2.

Planting plans which identify target wildlife species and specify plant species, quantities, locations, size, space, or density; source of plant materials or seeds; timing, season, water, and nutrient requirements for planting; and, plant protection measures.

3.

Site preparation grading elevations and specifications for, if needed, soil amendments, removal of unsuitable fill, and weed control.

4.

Measures for minimizing impacts to the wetland during grading and construction, and for minimizing disturbances to wildlife habitat.

Vector management, demonstrating ecological vector control developed in consultation with the MarinSonoma Mosquito and Vector Control District.

6.

Identification of disposal area for any excavated or dredged material.

D.

Implementation and Monitoring Plan. An implementation and monitoring plan shall provide:

1.

Specific criteria and identification of process and responsibility for evaluating whether or not the goals of the Wetland Management Plan are being achieved at various stages in the development;

2.

Specifications for irrigation as needed, removal of exotic and nuisance vegetation, and maintenance;

3.

Responsibility schedule and reporting requirements for monitoring the hydrology, vegetation, and wildlife of the wetland with a specified monitoring time frame (five years minimum for brackish or tidal marshes, and 10 years required for freshwater and seasonal wetlands);

4.

Procedures for the correction of deficiencies or problems in the Plan discovered after implementation, such as any needed plant substitutions, or modifications to site hydrology;

5.

Identification of methods to ensure that the wetland will be protected in perpetuity; and

6.

A schedule for grading, planting, and long-term maintenance.

E.

Cost Estimate. A cost estimate for implementing, monitoring, and maintaining the wetland. Performance security may be required in compliance with Section 19.44.030 to ensure proper installation, monitoring, and maintenance of the wetland.

F.

Management Plan. A management plan that addresses the long-term fiscal, administrative, and technical requirements to successfully execute and maintain the wetland restoration and enhancement project. The plan shall identify the project funding source and assign responsibilities for the long-term maintenance of the wetland, and the management of the necessary ongoing activities.

(Ord. No. 1576, § 2 (Exh. A, amd.), 10-23-2012)

19.36.060 - Limitations on Land Use Within Wetland Areas.

A.

Allowed Uses. Wetlands may fulfill the landscaping requirements of Section 19.28.030 (except that landscaping required in parking areas shall be provided), where the building and landscape design provides for the participation by residents and/or users of the site in passive outdoor recreational activities such as bird watching, fishing, and nature photography. Public access for passive recreational activities may be permitted and shall be encouraged where appropriate and consistent with the protection of habitat functions and values and adequate habitat protection measures are provided in the Wetland Management Plan.

B.

Allowed Structures. Any structure allowed in a wetland that is being created, preserved or enhanced, shall be designed to minimize its adverse impacts on the wetland. Measures to minimize adverse effects may include construction on pilings to allow unobstructed flow of water, preserving the natural contour of the wetland, and otherwise minimizing impairment, alteration, or loss of the wetland.

(Ord. No. 1576, § 2 (Exh. A, amd.), 10-23-2012)

19.36.070 - Development Standards and Design Criteria.

The Wetlands Management Plan required by Section 19.36.050 shall comply with the following standards. In the event of conflicts between applicable standards, the most restrictive shall apply.

A.

Wetland Buffer. A buffer area of a minimum of 50 feet in width shall be established to provide for undisturbed habitat adjacent to the wetland and to maintain sufficient watershed to support the wetland. The Review Authority may require additional width to protect high habitat values and/or provide adequate watershed area and hydrology.

The Review Authority may reduce the wetland buffer if a finding is made that:

1.

The proposed buffer provides adequate watershed hydrology to support the wetland and protects the resource value of the wetland; or

2.

The strict application of the buffer requirement would result in a taking of the property without just compensation.

B.

Protective Measures. Measures including protective fencing, landscaping, setbacks for roads and parking areas, shall be required to minimize adverse impacts on wetlands and wetland habitat. Facilities, structures, and pavement may be adjacent to, but not within, the wetland setback area. Retention ponds, swales, or water quality control features may be required in setback areas to prevent pollutants in urban runoff from discharging into wetland habitat.

C.

Landscaping. Wetland buffer areas shall be planted and maintained with native vegetation that is consistent with the maintenance of the adjacent wetland habitat values.

D.

Erosion and Sediment Control. Prior to issuance of a Grading Permit, an erosion control plan prepared by a registered professional engineer shall be submitted to the Department for approval, including bestmanagement practices to minimize siltation, sedimentation, and erosion (see Municipal Code Section 5- 23.008). During construction, temporary fencing shall be placed around the wetland/buffer area. To ensure that sediment remains on the site and is not transported into wetlands, erosion and sediment controls shall be left in place until the site is stabilized with permanent vegetation.

E.

Timing of Wetland Restoration or Creation. The restoration or creation of wetlands required as a condition of development approval shall be undertaken prior to completion of the development unless a security agreement is provided to the satisfaction of the City Attorney prior to issuance of a certificate of occupancy or acceptance of improvements that will ensure wetland restoration and monitoring of the effort.

(Ord. No. 1576, § 2 (Exh. A, amd.), 10-23-12)

19.36.080 - Prerequisites for Building or Grading Permit Issuance.

Prior to issuance of a Building or Grading Permit for work in or near a wetland, the applicant shall provide the Department with the following:

A.

Verification of Corps delineation of wetland boundaries; and/or a Section 404 or Section 10 permit (or its equivalent successor) from the U.S. Army Corps of Engineers;

B.

A Waiver or Certificate of Conformance with Water Quality Standards issued by the Regional Water Quality Control Board, if applicable;

C.

A consultation with the U.S. Fish and Wildlife Service and/or the California State Department of Fish and Game or National Marine Fisheries Service if any special status species or associated habitat are present; and

D.

If property is located in tidal areas, Bay Conservation and Development Commission (BCDC) approval, if applicable.

(Ord. No. 1576, § 2 (Exh. A, amd.), 10-23-2012)